UNITED STATES

SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

Washington, D.C. 20549

 

FORM 10-K

 

(Mark One)

 

ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

 

For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2021

 

or

 

TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

 

For the transition period from ____________to _____________

 

333-222094

Commission file number

 

TPT Global Tech, Inc.

(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)

 

Florida

 

81-3903357

State or other jurisdiction of incorporation or organization

 

(I.R.S. Employer Identification No.)

 

 

 

501 West Broadway, Suite 800 San Diego, CA

 

92101

(Address of principal executive offices)

 

(Zip Code)

 

(619) 301-4200

Registrant’s telephone number, including area code

 

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act: None 

 

Title of each Class

Trading Symbol

Name of each exchange on which registered

N/A

N/A

N/A

 

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act: None

 

_______________________

Title of each class

 

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act. ☐ Yes ☒ No

 

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act. ☐ Yes ☒ No

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days. ☒ Yes No ☐

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically every Interactive Data File required to be submitted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§ 232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit such files). ☒ Yes ☐ No

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, a smaller reporting company or an emerging growth company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer,” “smaller reporting company,” and “emerging growth company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.

 

Large accelerated filer

Accelerated filer

Non-accelerated Filer

Smaller reporting company

Emerging growth company

 

If an emerging growth company, indicate by check mark if the registrant has elected not to use the extended transition period for complying with any new or revised financial accounting standards provided pursuant to Section 13(a) of the Exchange Act.

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has filed a report on and attestation to its management’s assessment of the effectiveness of its internal control over financial reporting under Section 404(b) of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act (15 U.S.C. 7262(b)) by the registered public accounting firm that prepared or issued its audit report.   

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Act). Yes ☒ No

 

The aggregate market value of our common shares of voting stock held by non-affiliates of our Company at June 30, 2021, computed by reference to the price at which the common equity was last sold ($0.0152), as of the last business day of the registrant’s most recently completed second quarter (June 30, 2021), was $12,721,901.

 

As of April 6, 2022, there were approximately 923,029,038 common shares, $0.001 par value, issued and outstanding.

 

DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE

 

List hereunder the following documents if incorporated by reference and the Part of the Form 10-K into which the document is incorporated:

  

None.

   

 

 

 

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

 

 

 

Page

 

Item 1.

Business.

 

3

 

Item 1A.

Risk Factors.

 

33

 

Item 1B.

Unresolved Staff Comments.

 

53

 

Item 2.

Properties.

 

53

 

Item 3.

Legal Proceedings

 

53

 

Item 4.

Mine Safety Disclosure.

 

54

 

Item 5.

Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities.

 

55

 

Item 6.

Reserved

 

60

 

Item 7.

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations.

 

60

 

Item 7A.

Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk.

 

69

 

Item 8.

Financial Statements and Supplementary Data.

 

70

 

Item 9.

Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure.

 

71

 

Item 9A.

Controls and Procedures.

 

71

 

Item 9B.

Other Information.

 

72

 

Item 9C.

Disclosure Regarding Foreign Jurisdictions that Prevent Inspections.

 

72

 

Item 10.

Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance.

 

73

 

Item 11.

Executive Compensation.

 

77

 

Item 12.

Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters.

 

82

 

Item 13.

Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence.

 

85

 

Item 14.

Principal Accountant Fees and Services.

 

86

 

Item 15.

Exhibits, Financial Statement Schedules.

 

87

 

Item 16.

Form 10-K Summary

 

89

 

SIGNATURES

 

90

 

 
2

Table of Contants

 

PART I

 

FORWARD LOOKING STATEMENTS

 

This Form 10-K contains forward-looking statements. Forward-looking statements are projections of events, revenues, income, future economic performance or management’s plans and objectives for our future operations. In some cases, you can identify forward-looking statements by terminology such as “may,” “should,” “expects,” “plans,” “anticipates,” “believes,” “estimates,” “predicts,” “potential,” or “continue,” or the negative of these terms or other comparable terminology. These statements are only predictions and involve known and unknown risks, uncertainties and other factors, including the risks in the section entitled “Risk Factors” and the risks set out below, any of which may cause our or our industry’s actual results, levels of activity, performance or achievements to be materially different from any future results, levels of activity, performance or achievements expressed or implied by these forward-looking statements. These risks include, by way of example and not in limitation:

 

·

the uncertainty of profitability based upon our history of losses;

 

·

risks related to failure to obtain adequate financing on a timely basis and on acceptable terms to continue as going concern;

 

·

risks related to our operations; and

 

·

other risks and uncertainties related to our business plan and business strategy.

 

This list is not an exhaustive list of the factors that may affect any of our forward-looking statements. These and other factors should be considered carefully, and readers should not place undue reliance on our forward-looking statements. Forward looking statements are made based on management’s beliefs, estimates and opinions on the date the statements are made, and we undertake no obligation to update forward-looking statements if these beliefs, estimates and opinions or other circumstances should change. Although we believe that the expectations reflected in the forward-looking statements are reasonable, we cannot guarantee future results, levels of activity, performance or achievements. Except as required by applicable law, including the securities laws of the United States, we do not intend to update any of the forward-looking statements to conform these statements to actual results.

 

Our financial statements are stated in United States dollars (US$) and are prepared in accordance with United States Generally Accepted Accounting Principles. All references to “common stock” refer to the common shares in our capital stock.

 

ITEM 1. BUSINESS.

 

GENERAL

 

The following is a summary of some of the information contained in this document. Unless the context requires otherwise, references in this document to “our Company,” “us,” “we,” “our,” “TPT Global,” or the “Company” are to TPT Global Tech, Inc.

 

DESCRIPTION OF BUSINESS

 

We are based in San Diego, California, and operate as a technology-based company with divisions providing telecommunications, medical technology and product distribution, media content for domestic and international syndication as well as technology solutions. We operate as a Media Content Hub for Domestic and International syndication, Technology/Telecommunications company using our own proprietary Global Digital Media TV and Telecommunications infrastructure platform and also provide technology solutions to businesses domestically and worldwide.  We offer Software as a Service (SaaS), Technology Platform as a Service (PAAS), Cloud-based Unified Communication as a Service (UCaaS) and carrier-grade performance and support for businesses over our private IP MPLS fiber and wireless network in the United States. Our cloud-based UCaaS services allow businesses of any size to enjoy all the latest voice, data, media and collaboration features in today's global technology markets. We also operate as a Master Distributor for Nationwide Mobile Virtual Network Operators (MVNO) and Independent Sales Organization (ISO) as a Master Distributor for Pre-Paid Cellphone services, Mobile phones, Cellphone Accessories and Global Roaming Cellphones.

 

Jumpstart Our Business Startups Act

 

We qualify as an “emerging growth company” as defined in Section 101 of the Jumpstart our Business Startups Act (“JOBS Act”) as we did not have more than $1,000,000,000 in annual gross revenue and did not have such amount as of December 31, 2021, our last fiscal year.

 

 
3

Table of Contants

 

We may lose our status as an emerging growth company on the last day of our fiscal year during which (i) our annual gross revenue exceeds $1,000,000,000 or (ii) we issue more than $1,000,000,000 in non-convertible debt in a three-year period. We will lose our status as an emerging growth company if at any time we are deemed to be a large accelerated filer. We will lose our status as an emerging growth company on the last day of our fiscal year following the fifth anniversary of the date of the first sale of common equity securities pursuant to an effective registration statement.

 

As an emerging growth company, we may take advantage of specified reduced reporting and other burdens that are otherwise applicable to generally reporting companies. These provisions include:

 

 

-

A requirement to have only two years of audited financial statement and only two years of related Management Discussion and Analysis Disclosures;

 

 

-

Reduced disclosure about the emerging growth company’s executive compensation arrangements; and

 

 

-

No non-binding advisory votes on executive compensation or golden parachute arrangements.

 

As an emerging growth company, we are exempt from Section 404(b) of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 and Section 14A(a) and (b) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934. Such sections are provided below:

 

Section 404(b) of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 requires a public company’s auditor to attest to, and report on, management’s assessment of its internal controls.

 

Sections 14A(a) and (b) of the Securities and Exchange Act, implemented by Section 951 of the Dodd-Frank Act, require companies to hold shareholder advisory votes on executive compensation and golden parachute compensation.

 

We have already taken advantage of these reduced reporting burdens in this Form 10-K, which are also available to us as a smaller reporting company as defined under Rule 12b-2 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”).

 

As long as we qualify as an emerging growth company, we will not be required to comply with the requirements of Section 404(b) of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 and Section 14A(a) and (b) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.

 

In addition, Section 107 of the JOBS Act also provides that an emerging growth company can take advantage of the extended transition period provided in Section 7(a)(2)(B) of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”) for complying with new or revised accounting standards.  We are choosing to irrevocably opt into the extended transition period for complying with new or revised accounting standards under Section 102(b)(2) of the JOBS Act. 

 

HISTORY

 

We were originally incorporated in 1988 in the state of Florida. TPT Global, Inc., a Nevada corporation formed in June 2014, merged with Ally Pharma US, Inc., a Florida corporation, (“Ally Pharma,” formerly known as Gold Royalty Corporation) in a “reverse merger” wherein Ally Pharma issued 110,000,000 shares of Common Stock, or 80% ownership, to the owners of TPT Global, Inc. and Ally Pharma changed its name to TPT Global Tech, Inc. In 2014, we acquired all the assets of K Telecom and Wireless LLC (“K Telecom”) and Global Telecom International, LLC (“Global Telecom”). Effective January 31, 2015, we completed our acquisition of 100% of the outstanding stock of Copperhead Digital Holdings, Inc. (“Copperhead Digital”) and Subsidiaries, TruCom, LLC (“TruCom”), Nevada Utilities, Inc. (“Nevada Utilities”) and CityNet Arizona, LLC (“CityNet”). In October 2015, we acquired the assets of both Port2Port, Inc. (“Port2Port”) and Digithrive, Inc. (“Digithrive”). Effective September 30, 2016, we acquired 100% ownership in San Diego Media, Inc. (“SDM”). In December 2016, we acquired the Lion Phone technology. In October and November 2017, we entered into agreements to acquire Blue Collar, Inc. (“Blue Collar”), and certain assets of Matrixsites, Inc. (“Matrixsites”) which we have completed. On May 7, 2019 we completed the acquisition of a majority of the assets of SpeedConnect, LLC, which assets were conveyed into our wholly owned subsidiary TPT SpeedConnect, LLC (“TPT SC” or “TPT SpeedConnect”) which was formed on April 16, 2019. On January 8, 2020 we formed TPT Federal, LLC (“TPT Federal”), on March 7, 2020 we acquired 75% interest in Bridge Internet, LLC, which was later terminated on December 23, 2020 (“Bridge Internet” or “BIC”). On March 30, 2020, we formed TPT MedTech, LLC (“TPT MedTech”) and on June 6, 2020, we formed InnovaQor, Inc (“InnovaQor”). In July and August 2020, the Company formed Quiklab 1 LLC and QuikLAB 2, LLC where the Company owns 80% (as agreed per the operating agreement) of all outside equity investments.  Effective August 1, 2020, we closed on the acquisition of 75% of The Fitness Container, LLC (“Air Fitness”).  In July 2020, we invested in a Hong Kong company called TPT Global Tech Asia Limited of which we own 78%, and during 2020, InnovaQor did a reverse merger with Southern Plains of which there ended up being a non-controlling interest of 6% as of December 31, 2021.  The name of InnovaQor remained for the merged entities but was changed to TPT Strategic, Inc. on March 21, 2021.

 

 
4

Table of Contants

 

We are based in San Diego, California, and operate as a technology-based company with divisions providing telecommunications, medical technology and product distribution, media content for domestic and international syndication as well as technology solutions. We operate as a Media Content Hub for Domestic and International syndication, Technology/Telecommunications company using our own proprietary Global Digital Media TV and Telecommunications infrastructure platform and also provide technology solutions to businesses domestically and worldwide.  We offer Software as a Service (SaaS), Technology Platform as a Service (PAAS), Cloud-based Unified Communication as a Service (UCaaS) and carrier-grade performance and support for businesses over our private IP MPLS fiber and wireless network in the United States. Our cloud-based UCaaS services allow businesses of any size to enjoy all the latest voice, data, media and collaboration features in today's global technology markets. We also operate as a Master Distributor for Nationwide Mobile Virtual Network Operators (MVNO) and Independent Sales Organization (ISO) as a Master Distributor for Pre-Paid Cellphone services, Mobile phones, Cellphone Accessories and Global Roaming Cellphones.

 

We anticipate needing an estimated $38,000,000 in capital to continue our business operations and expansion. We do not have committed sources for these additional funds and will need to be obtained through debt or equity placements or a combination of those. As part of this $38,000,000, we will use approximately $7,000,000 in debt restructuring, approximately $14,000,000 in equipment purchases and approximately $11,000,000 for working capital.  We are in negotiations for certain sources to provide funding but at this time do not have a committed source of these funds.

 

Our executive offices are located at 501 West Broadway, Suite 800, San Diego, CA 92101 and the telephone number is (619) 400-4996. We maintain a website at www.tptglobaltech.com, and such website is not incorporated into or a part of this filing.

 

CORPORATE STRUCTURE

 

Our corporate structure is as follows:

 

tptw_10kimg7.jpg

CURRENT BUSINESS

 

Company Overview

 

Through key acquisitions in 2015, we launched wholesale and retail operations in the United States and Internationally. These first acquisitions with their customer bases, Distribution Channels and Technology are the base for our organic growth strategy opportunities to cross pollinate or sell our planned New Generation, New Media Technology products and services, Domestically and Internationally.

 

We, and our related companies and acquisitions, are seeking to be an innovative Telecom/CUBS (Cloud Unified Businesses Services) as one of the first to combine recurring Telecom, Mobile Banking, Media and Data/Cloud Services revenue under one roof, and then bring all relevant data from those services into a proprietary information matrix platform capable of delivering a “Daily and Intelligent Dashboard” to our Domestic and International customers. Such a cohesive combination of services and information from a single provider has been heretofore nonexistent. We intend to pioneer an integrated communication services and information technology suite, to empower companies with vital communications services technology, and highly relevant diagnostic information.

 

 
5

Table of Contants

 

To date we have generated revenues primarily through operating as a Competitive Local Exchange Carrier (“CLEC”) in Arizona and starting in 2019, as an Internet Service Provider. Our primary revenues in 2021 and 2020 are primarily from telecommunications services and products including internet sales, and from film production.

 

Our operating divisions historically have been those that sell telecommunications services and those that sale telecommunications products, including internet sales starting in 2019. Cloud based services assets were acquired in 2016 and are intended to be more of a contributing factor to revenues in 2022 and forward.  During 2020, we initiated our medical services division which we anticipate to also play a larger contributing factor to overall revenues in coming years from not only medical testing services but the use of our cloud based technologies.

 

Our Key Divisions:

 

TPT SpeedConnect: ISP and Telecom

 

The Company completed the acquisition of substantially all of the assets of SpeedConnect LLC (“SpeedConnect”) for $1.75 million, including the assumption of all contracts and liabilities pertinent to operations and conveyed them into a wholly-owned subsidiary TPT SpeedConnect.  SpeedConnect was founded in 2002 and operates as a national, predominantly rural, wireless telecommunications residential and commercial Internet Service Provider (ISP). TPT SpeedConnect’s primary business model is subscription based, monthly reoccurring revenues, from wireless delivered, high-speed Internet connections utilizing its company built and owned national network.  SpeedConnect also resells third-party satellite Internet, DSL Internet, IP telephony and DISH TV products. This Acquisition closed on May 7, 2019.

 

SpeedConnect was a privately-held Broadband Wireless Access (BWA) provider. Today, TPT SpeedConnect is one of the nation’s largest rural wireless broadband Internet providers which serves approximately 10,000 residential and commercial wireless broadband Internet customers, in Arizona, Idaho, Illinois, Iowa, Michigan, Montana, Nebraska, South Dakota and Texas.

 

SpeedConnect is a full-service ISP.  The company’s main back office is run by company employees, and includes, network management, network monitoring and maintenance, significant allocations of registered address in public IP4 and IP6 space, employee based customer service, installation services, automated resources and application based scheduling and tracking, paper, ACH, credit card, and email billing, warehousing, fulfillment, integrated customer premise provisioning, walled garden collections and customer self-restarts, bandwidth usage tracking, integrated, secure, and deep financial and operations dash board reporting, collections, accounting, payables, owned and licensed backhaul, intelligent bandwidth management, consumption rated billing, customer payment portals, and all wrapped in a mature, first hit on all search engines, Internet Brand. The company today services approximately 10,000 residential and commercial Internet customers over its approximately 220-cellular tower footprint across 10 Midwestern States. 

 

Today’s urban ISP landscape is highly competitive and dominated by some of the world’s largest going concerns.  Names like Comcast, AT&T, Cox, Charter and DISH are household words.  Home Internet service has become synonymous with Cable.  However, this is limited to the high-density top 100 markets.  Beyond that the competition becomes more small licensed free wireless providers and satellite.  Wire-line providers, unless backed with government subsidies, do not build beyond 15 homes per street mile.   SpeedConnect services both rural and non-rural areas, and historically has done well in both marketplaces, however the margins are improved in the more rural areas due to reduced voluntary and involuntary customer attrition.

 

TPT SpeedConnect’s key suppliers include but are not limited to; Juniper, ZTE, Huawei, Cisco, Sandvine, American Tower, SBA Tower, Crown Castle, CenturyLink, SuddenLink, South Dakota Networks, 123 dot net, Genesee Telephone, Air Advantage Fiber, Iron Mountain, ConVergence, CDW, Talley, Tessco, Bursma Electronics, DragonWave, Ceragon Networks, Telrad, Arris, AP, APD, Plante Morran, Fifth Third, Sprint and others.

 

Blue Collar Production Division

 

Our production division, Blue Collar Productions (formerly Blue Collar, Inc.), creates original live action and animated content productions and has produced hundreds of hours of material for the television, theatrical, home entertainment and new media markets. Mr. Rowen, our CEO of Blue Collar, works closely with major television networks, cable channels and film studios to produce home entertainment products.

 

 
6

Table of Contants

 

The Documentary film group at Blue Collar recently completed a film on the cultural impact of Goodfellas: 20 Years Later that featured Martin Scorsese, Robert DeNiro, Lorraine Bracco, Leonardo DiCaprio and many others. They have also produced a series of film anthologies for Turner Classic Movies. Blue Collar is currently in production on Built To Fail, which is a look at the history of street wear. The film features Tommy Hilfiger, Russell Simmons and a host of notable street wear designers. They are also in pre-production on The 29 Club, a look at notable musicians who all tragically died at age 29; Memories in Music, which is an in-depth study of the impact of memory through music on Alzheimer’s patients and Faces of Vegas, an exploration into the culture of Las Vegas, Nevada. 

 

Blue Collar Productions currently has the feature film Looking For Alaska, based on the John Green novel, producing for Paramount Pictures. The company produced for a pilot for MTV for a possible series, “My Jam” aired in the Fall of 2016. Blue Collar has also produced two seasons of “Caribbean’s Next Top Model Season.”

 

Blue Collar Productions designs branding and marketing campaigns and has had contracts with some of the world’s largest companies including PepsiCo, Intel, HP, WalMart and many other Fortune 500 companies. Additionally, they create motion picture, television and home entertainment marketing campaigns for studios including Sony, DreamWorks, Twentieth Century Fox, Universal Studios, Paramount Studios, and Warner Brothers.

 

The CEO of this division, Mr. Rowen, has worked with filmmakers including Steven Spielberg, Ron Howard, Brett Ratner and James Cameron. Mr. Rowen also has very close working relationships with actors including Tom Hanks, Brad Pitt, Julia Roberts, Robert Downey, Jr., Denzel Washington, Ryan Gosling, Sofia Vergara, Mariska Hargitay and many others.

 

Prior to starting Blue Collar Productions, Mr. Rowen functioned as the head of home entertainment production for DreamWorks SKG from 1997 to 2000. He also serves as the President of Long Leash Entertainment, an aggregator of entertainment based intellectual property and creator of high-end entertainment content.

 

TPT MedTech, LLC – Medical Division

 

TPT MedTech believes it is strategically positioned to take advantage of the current trend in Point of Care Testing (“POCT”) by aligning itself with the exponential growth of smart devices equipped with mobile healthcare (mH), which may revolutionize personalized healthcare monitoring and management, thereby paving the way for next-generation POCT.

 

The rapid turnaround times, improved decision times, and time-critical decision-making of TPT MedTech QuikLAB can result in total savings between 8-20% of laboratory costs for facilities that implement POC testing. The savings realized due to the decreased cost of waiting for results can be as much as $260 USD per patient. For those that use and implement POC testing, waiting can improve by as much as 46 minutes per patient real-time scenarios—and days in standard laboratory settings. Management believes TPT MedTech QuikLAB is uniquely positioned to serve this growing market.

 

SANIQuik is a decontamination and sanitizing unit that TPT MedTech intends to co-market with the QuikLAB mobile laboratory as an integrated solution to certain issues arising from the COVID-19 pandemic. SANIQuik uses hypochlorous acid as a spray mist. This chemical has been safely used on many food products for decades. Hypochlorous acid does not cause irritation to eyes and skin. Even if it were ingested it causes no harm. Because it is so safe, it is the ideal sanitizer for direct food sanitation and food contact surfaces. It is also ideal in healthcare where it is used for wound cleansing, eye drops, and patient room disinfection replacing toxic chemicals such as bleach and quaternary ammonium salts. Hypochlorous acid is FDA, USDA, and EPA approved to minimize microbial food safety hazards of fresh-cut fruits and vegetables. (See https://www.hypochlorousacid.com/about.)

 

TPT MedTech believes the SANIQuik external sanitation is safe, effective and flexible for its utilization with options for users. TPT MedTech intends to provide optional masks to users as they approach the SANIQuik. The mask provides a cover around inhalation of the mist. External sanitation is safe and effective, providing an additional routine to hand washing and facial coverings.

 

TPT MedTech has developed a business model which markets SANIQuik as a novel product within the Personal Protective Equipment (PPE) industry. This PPE distribution model is focused in the Federal procurement space (Veteran’s Administration, Department of Defense, Federal Emergency Management Agency, Centers for Disease Control, National Guard) as well as vendor to the top 20 National Hospital Group Purchasing Organizations (GPO).

 

TPT MedTech will be requesting Emergency Use Authorization (EUA) from the FDA for SANIQuik during the COVID-19 pandemic, which has been granted to other sanitizing units. SANIQuik already has the European CE mark. For attorney fees and consultants, we are estimating $50,000 for the EUA.

 

TPT MedTech developed its "QuikPASS™" Check and Verify passport system and Covid 19/vaccination monitoring platform for corporations, governmental organizations, schools, airlines, hospitals, sports venues & arenas, restaurants, hotels, and nightclubs. The all-in-one mobile system checks and verifies that an individual has been tested for Covid-19 or vaccinated, providing proof individuals are able to travel or gain access to venues with the idea that everyone inside that venue would be Covid free. The "QuikPASS" "Check and Verify" passport-style platform works with third-party testing labs and organizations that participate on the "QuikPASS" Network and will be offered FREE to US domestic and international business commerce and governmental organizations around the world.

 

 
7

Table of Contants

 

San Diego Media Division

 

San Diego Media, Inc. (“SDM”) is an established Southern California based software engineering and Internet e-commerce marketing services company that provides enterprise-class integrated solutions for manufacturers, retailers, and distributors focused on developing solutions for companies seeking online growth and profitability.

 

Founded in 1999, historically the primary market offering has been MaxEXP®, a proven stable, productivity-enabling proprietary eCommerce platform, built on open-standards technology that empowers companies to deploy and manage eCommerce offerings at lower cost and at less time than required to deploy more conventional high-end solutions — and, we believe, all without sacrificing the essential merchandising functionality, customizability, extensibility, scalability, security, and performance that much more expensive solutions provide. MaxEXP supports both B2B and B2C functionality simultaneously which few other eCommerce solutions will provide successfully out-of-the-box.

 

These early engagements have enabled SDM to solidify and refine the core SDM technology architecture and to enhance the platform with market-driven merchandising features and functionality. SDM has made significant R&D investments in operational infrastructure including sophisticated monitoring systems, comprehensive security, time-tracking, client management tools, and continuous compliance with the demanding payment card industry (PCI) standards.

 

SDM has complemented these systems with a full range of automated and enterprise-class capabilities for fully integrating with customer’s legacy systems, call centers, fulfillment houses, and other critical business process applications.

 

SDM has complimented its technologies with a wider range of professional internet and marketing services that enables client success, to create successful business relationships over long-term.

 

As the market has changed through the years SDM has continued to innovate and expand its strategic and technology development partnerships; these include, MIndTouch, BigCommerce, Avalara, CPC Strategies, eBridge, Imperva Incapsula, Chris Chase Design. SDM’s newest client is based in Singapore and it represents its most innovative use of technologies to date.

 

K Telecom and Global Telecom- GSM Distribution

 

K Telecom and Global Telecom are located in the Northwest of the United States and sell and distribute GSM Cell Phone and Prepaid GSM Services for MVNO’s (Mobile Virtual Network Operators) through approximately 100 brick and mortar retail store-front locations in Washington and Oregon.

 

Copperhead Digital: ISP - Telecom Revenue

 

Copperhead Digital operated as a regional internet and telecom services provider operating in Arizona under the trade name Trucom.  Although there are currently no customers and it will take capital to reopen this revenue stream, Copperhead Digital operated as a wireless telecommunications Internet Service Provider (“ISP”) facilitating both residential and commercial accounts. Copperhead Digital’s primary business model was subscription based, pre-paid monthly reoccurring revenues, from wireless delivered, high-speed internet connections. In addition, the company resold third-party satellite and DSL internet and IP telephony services.

 

Technology Company Overview

 

Our Company was formed as the successor of two US Corporations, Ally Pharma US, a Pharmaceutical technology research company founded in 1988 and TPT Global Inc. a Media Content, Voice and Data, Interconnect and International gateway provider. TPT Global Tech is headquartered in San Diego, California and operates as a holding company for its Media, Smartphone, Network, Content and SaaS (Software as a Services) domestic and international businesses.

 

Historically and through key acquisitions we launched Telecommunications wholesale and retail operations in the United States and Internationally. These first acquisitions with their Customer Bases, Distribution Channels and Technology are the base for our organic growth strategy and provide opportunities to cross sell our platforms and New Media Technology products and services Domestically and Internationally.

 

 
8

Table of Contants

 

We are based in San Diego, California and operate as a technology-based company with divisions providing telecommunications, medical technology and product distribution, media content for domestic and international syndication as well as technology solutions. We operate as a Media Content Hub for Domestic and International syndication, Technology/Telecommunications company using on our own proprietary Global Digital Media TV and Telecommunications infrastructure platform and we also provide technology solutions to businesses worldwide. We offer Software as a Service (SaaS), Technology Platform as a Service (PAAS), Cloud-based Unified Communication as a Service (UCaaS) and carrier-grade performance and support for businesses over our private IP MPLS fiber and wireless network in the United States. Our cloud-based UCaaS services allow businesses of any size to enjoy all the latest voice, data, media and collaboration features in today's global technology markets. We also operate as a Master Distributor for Nationwide Mobile Virtual Network Operators (MVNO) and Independent Sales Organization (ISO) as a Master Distributor for Pre-Paid Cellphone services, Mobile phones, Cellphone Accessories and Global Roaming Cellphones.

 

Our technologies “Gathers Big Data” to predict our customers’ viewing and spending habits. We then deliver Products and Services to support that estimated demand and share advertising revenues with our Content, Digital Media and Linear Broadcast Partners worldwide.

 

Each of our four divisions contributes to the launch of our global Content delivery platform “VuMe” formerly now as “ViewMe Live” and creates cross pollinating revenue opportunities and a closed Global E-commerce Eco environment which we believe will help us execute our short and long-term corporate objectives. Our Content Division which consists of Blue Collar Productions (our TV and Film content Production company) creates original content and in some cases third party content. Once Content has been produced we will then broadcast and deliver that content over our proprietary Mobile TV Platform domestically and internationally.

 

Our corporate goal is to work within our four in house divisions (Smartphone, Network, Content and SaaS) to launch hardware sales and build a viewer subscriber base domestically and internationally. This edge device deployment would deliver free Content, free Linear Broadcast feeds and Social Media features on our Free proprietary Mobile app platform with the anticipation to aggregate and showcase our original and third-party Content, Digital Media and Linear broadcast feeds from and too the four corners of the Globe.

 

All of the back technology or features for VuMe Live have been developed and we anticipate spending an additional $2,000,000 USD to complete the front-end features which we believe, depending on our funding event, will be three to six months.

 

We have generated revenues in 2021 and 2020, primarily through operating as a Broadband Internet provider. The Company can also operate its approximate 58 miles Fiber optic ring throughout the greater Phoenix valley offering such services as Basic Residential Phone service, Basic Business phone service, POT’s lines, Basic Fiber Broadband Internet services, Wireless Internet Services, Toll Free 800 services, EFax, Erate, Dedicated T-1 Services, Auto Attendant, SIP Trunks, Mobile and VoIP services. These offerings will continue for the foreseeable future weighted heavily towards offering more Wireless Internet services and the Fiber Ring will be transformed into a Private Test facility to be offered for rent to businesses needing a private network to test new products for proof of concept purposes.   Since the acquisition of the assets of SpeedConnect in 2019, we operate as a Broadband Wireless Access (BWA) provider and are considered one of the nation’s largest rural wireless broadband Internet providers serving approximately 10,000 residential and commercial wireless broadband Internet customers, in Arizona, Idaho, Illinois, Iowa, Michigan, Montana, Nebraska, South Dakota and Texas.

 

We, and our related acquired companies are seeking to be an innovative Media-Telecom/CUBS (Cloud Unified Businesses Services) company and one of the first to combine recurring Telecom, Media and Data/Cloud Services revenue under one roof, then bring all relevant data from those services into a proprietary telecom infrastructure and information matrix platform capable of delivering a “Daily and Intelligent Dashboard” to our Domestic and International customers. Such a planned cohesive combination of services and information from a single provider has been heretofore nonexistent. We intend to pioneer an integrate communication services and information technology suites to empower individuals and companies with vital communications, Smartphone, Network, Content, SaaS (Software as A Service), New Media Technology products and services, and valuable relevant diagnostic information both Domestically and Internationally. 

 

We are currently able to deliver a live Global TV Broadcast and Social Media Platform utilizing a Mobile App technology on our proprietary Content Delivery Network. We plan to expand our Cloud Unified Business Services (CUBS) technology-based business services unifying multiple services from the cloud including applications developed for our medical division.

 

CUBS (Cloud Unified Business Services) - We are a CUBS provider, acquiring customers and then cross selling additional products and services through our proprietary Wrap Around Relationship Marketing (WARM) system, intending to make the customers very sticky – prone to not leave as a customer.

 

Planned Activities

 

Big Data & Predictive Analytics - Our capability to utilize our proprietary aggregation platform to gather data from our hardware and software edge device (End Users) deployments positions the Company to be a leader in predictive analytics.

 

 
9

Table of Contants

 

tptw_10kimg2.jpg

 

 

 

Cross-Sales – Our growth strategy through complimentary acquisitions may create opportunities to cross and sell its New Generation, New Media technology products and services to a growing customer base across multiple distribution channels, both domestically and internationally.

 

Market Launch - Through our acquisition of VuMe Live from Matrixsites, we have acquired the live backend broadcast Network technology for our Global Mobile TV and Social Media platform. Subject to raising capital ($2,000,000) from our fund-raising activities we believe we are three to six months from completing the frontend development component to launch its “VuMe” Mobile APP delivery platform.

 

Liquidity and Capital Resource Needs 

 

We anticipate needing an estimated $38,000,000 in capital to continue our business operations and expansion. We do not have committed sources for these additional funds and will need to be obtained through debt or equity placements or a combination of those.

 

Estimate of Liquidity and Capital Resource Needs

 

Equipment purchases and manufacturing

 

$14,000,000

 

Product advancement

 

 

2,250,000

 

Acquisitions

 

 

500,000

 

Debt Restructuring

 

 

7,300,000

 

Working capital, including marketing

 

 

11,470,000

 

Brokerage commissions

 

 

2,280,000

 

Offering expenses

 

 

200,000

 

 

 

$38,000,000

 

 

Although the items set forth above indicate management’s present estimate of our liquidity and capital resource needs, we may reallocate the proceeds or utilize them for other corporate purposes. Our actual use proceeds may vary from these estimates because of a number of factors, including whether we are successful in completing future acquisitions, whether we obtain additional funding, what other obligations have been incurred by us, the operating results of our initial acquisition activities, and whether we are able to operate profitably. If our need for working capital increases, we may seek additional funds through loans or other financing. There are no current commitments for any such financing opportunity, and there can be no assurance that these funds may be obtained in the future if the need arises.

 

RECENT ACQUISITIONS/FORMATIONA OF OPERATING DIVISIONS/SUBSIDIARIES

 

TPT Strategic Merger with Southern Plains

 

On August 1, 2020, InnovaQor (name changed to TPT Strategic, Inc.), a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company, entered into a Merger Agreement with the publicly traded company Southern Plains Oil Corp. (OTC PINK: SPLN prior to Merger Agreement).

 

During 2020, TPT Strategic authorized a Series A Super Majority Preferred Stock valued at $350,000 by management and issued to a third party in exchange for legal services.  Effective September 30, 2020, the Series A Super Majority Preferred Stock was exchanged with TPT for a note payable of $350,000 payable in cash or common stock (see Note 5(2)).    As such, as of September 30, 2020, the Company, for accounting purposes, took control of the merged TPT Strategic and reflected in its consolidated balance sheet the non-controlling interest of $219,058 in the liabilities under a license agreement valued at $3,500,000.  This $3,500,000 was recorded as a Note Payable and expensed on InnovaQor’s books.  On March 30, 2021, the license agreement was cancelled and the non-controlling interest reversed.

 

 
10

Table of Contants

 

TPT Strategic Merger with Education System Management

 

On June 22, 2021, TPT Strategic and the Company signed a merger agreement with Education Systems Management, LLC (“EDSM”) to create a merged public entity. TPT Strategic will become a non-controlling interest to TPTW after the merger and after fund raising efforts at an estimated 28%.  Both TPT Strategic and the Company will enter into a software development agreement for the development of a standalone backend and front-end telemedicine technology platform which is not to exceed $3.5M in cost.  It is also the intent that current TPT shareholders will receive TPT Strategic stock of 2.5M common shares as a dividend after the merger is complete and appropriate shares are registered with the SEC under a registration rights agreement.  Closing was expected on or before August 1, 2021, or as agreed by all parties.  The parties have verbally agreed to close as soon as possible and are working towards this.

 

Our Business Methods

 

Centralized Platform and New Generation Network

 

We are now operating a next-generation broadband network reselling other companies’ networks on a wholesale arbitrage basis (buying and reselling other companies’ capacity) on our centralized VIVO Platform. We are interconnected to U.S. and International carriers to date. Once funded, we intend to deploy our own in-country networks in the targeted emerging markets. This will enable us to be able to provide better quality termination and increase our operating margins. We believe our platform will produce substantial operational cost savings. Because of our pricing advantage, we are able to offer our clients products and services at an attractive pricing structure, creating a strong competitive advantage. Based on our low network operating costs and low-cost infrastructure, we believe we may penetrate emerging markets with little network build-out and at a reasonable price. Management believes that our service offerings will be well received in emerging markets based on existing relationships and pricing structure, which will enable us to set the industry standard with little competition.

 

Once we establish in-country networks, we will be able to market Phones, Networks, Content and SaaS products targeted to specific subgroups that coincide with the country/region where we have a network in place or a strategic partnership network in place.

 

Use of Incumbent Networks

 

Under formal agreements we can privately brand and resell incumbent carriers’ underlying broadband networks, while deploying our own Wimax/Wi-Fi/GSM service plans and mobile handsets.

 

As a true value add, our VIVO billing platform allows us to manage the billing and routing, offering our customers a seamless, branded network from anywhere we maintain a relationship. By way of incumbent operator networks, we can sell and market to retail and wholesale customers without the high infrastructure costs associated with deploying our own network. If and when the revenues justify the cost of constructing our own network, we plan to investigate adding a wireless Broadband/ GSM network and transfer our customer base in a final step to reduce costs of goods sold long-term.

 

Wholesale Termination

 

Wholesale termination is the reselling of excess network capacity on a reciprocal basis to other telecom carriers both domestically and internationally. Due to the large number of carrier relationships we have in the US and abroad, we believe we can immediately increase our wholesale termination in each country in which we have a license to operate. This wholesale activity generates additional cash flow immediately if successfully implemented. Wholesale termination is a low risk, low margin business.

 

Service Description

 

Our next-generation wireless Broadband/GSM network relies on non-line-of-sight technology. This will provide a level of performance comparable to that delivered by evolving Worldwide Interoperability of Microwave Access (WiMAX) standards. The cost advantage equates to substantial reductions of fixed costs as compared to building traditional, legacy, and switched networks.

 

Our products and marketing strategy unifies the various features available in today’s telecommunication environment including:

 

 

·

Significant international broadband capacity

 

 

·

High quality VoIP communication

 

 
11

Table of Contants

 

 

·

Cellular/GSM and Wi-Fi wireless convergence

 

 

·

IPTV, Content Applications and Financial Services Products

 

 

·

Remote network management

 

 

·

Sophisticated Prepaid, Wholesale and Retail billing

 

 

·

CRM management; and Intranet Build-out, back office management and reporting.

 

Our Business Segments

 

Our business segment consists generally of providing strategic, legacy and data integration products and services to small, medium and enterprise business, wholesale and governmental customers, including other communication providers. Our strategic products and services offered to these customers include our collocation, hosting, broadband, VoIP, information technology and other ancillary services. Our services offered to these customers primarily include local and long-distance voice, inducing the sale of unbundled network elements (“UNEs”), switched access and other ancillary services. Our product offerings include the sale of telecommunications equipment located on customers’ premises and related products and professional services, all of which are described further below.

 

Our products and services include local and long-distance voice, broadband, Ethernet, collocation, hosting (including cloud hosting and managed hosting), data integration, video, network, public access, VoIP, information technology and other ancillary services.

 

We offer our customers the ability to bundle together several products and services. For example, we offer integrated and unlimited local and long-distance voice services. Our customers can also bundle two or more services such as broadband, video (including through our strategic partnerships), voice services. We believe our customers value the convenience and price discounts associated with receiving multiple services through a single company.

 

Most of our products and services are provided using our telecommunications network, which consists of voice and data switches, copper cables, fiber-optic cables and other equipment.

 

Described in greater detail previously are our key products and services are as follows.

 

TPT SpeedConnect: ISP and Telecom

 

On May 7, 2019, the Company completed the acquisition of substantially all of the assets of SpeedConnect LLC (“SpeedConnect”) for $1.75 million, including the assumption of all contracts and liabilities pertinent to operations and conveyed them into a wholly owned subsidiary TPT SpeedConnect. The Acquisition closed on May 7, 2019. SpeedConnect was founded in 2002 by its CEO John Arthur Ogren and is in its 17th year of operations as a national, predominantly rural, wireless telecommunications residential and commercial Internet Service Provider (ISP). TPT SpeedConnect’s primary business model is subscription based, monthly reoccurring revenues, from wireless delivered, high-speed Internet connections utilizing its company built and owned national network. SpeedConnect also resells third-party satellite Internet, DSL Internet, IP telephony and DISH TV products.

 

SpeedConnect is a privately-held Broadband Wireless Access (BWA) provider. Today, TPT SpeedConnect is one of the nation’s largest rural wireless broadband Internet providers which serves approximately 10,000 residential and commercial wireless broadband Internet customers, in Arizona, Idaho, Illinois, Iowa, Michigan, Montana, Nebraska, South Dakota and Texas.

 

TPT SpeedConnect is a full-service ISP.  The company’s back office is run by company employees, and includes, network management, network monitoring and maintenance, significant allocations of registered address in public IP4 and IP6 space, employee based customer service, installation services, automated resources and application based scheduling and tracking, paper, ACH, credit card, and email billing, warehousing, fulfillment, integrated customer premise provisioning, walled garden collections and customer self-restarts, bandwidth usage tracking, integrated, secure, and deep financial and operations dash board reporting, collections, accounting, payables, owned and licensed backhaul, intelligent bandwidth management, consumption rated billing, customer payment portals, and all wrapped in a mature, first hit on all search engines, Internet Brand. The company today services approximately 10,000 residential and commercial Internet customers over its approximately 220-cellular tower footprint across 10 Midwestern States. 

 

 
12

Table of Contants

 

Today’s urban ISP landscape is highly competitive and dominated by some of the world’s largest going concerns.  Names like Comcast, AT&T, Cox, Charter and DISH are household words.  Home Internet service has become synonymous with Cable.  However, this is limited to the high-density top 100 markets.  Beyond that the competition becomes more small licensed free wireless providers and satellite.  Wire-line providers, unless backed with government subsidies, do not build beyond 15 homes per street mile.   SpeedConnect services both rural and non-rural areas, and historically has done well in both marketplaces, however the margins are improved in the more rural areas due to reduced voluntary and involuntary customer attrition.

 

TPT SpeedConnect’s key suppliers include but are not limited to; Juniper, ZTE, Huawei, Cisco, Sandvine, American Tower, SBA Tower, Crown Castle, CenturyLink, SuddenLink, South Dakota Networks, 123 dot net, Genesee Telephone, Air Advantage Fiber, Iron Mountain, ConVergence, CDW, Talley, Tessco, Bursma Electronics, DragonWave, Ceragon Networks, Telrad, Arris, AP, APD, Plante Morran, Fifth Third, Sprint and others.

 

Blue Collar Production Division

 

Our production division, Blue Collar Productions (formerly Blue Collar, Inc.), creates original live action and animated content productions. Blue Collar creates original live action and animated content and has produced hundreds of hours of material for the television, theatrical, home entertainment and new media markets.

 

The Documentary film group at Blue Collar recently completed a film on the cultural impact of Goodfellas: 20 Years Later that featured Martin Scorsese, Robert DeNiro, Lorraine Bracco, Leonardo DiCaprio and many others. They have also produced a series of film anthologies for Turner Classic Movies. Blue Collar is currently in production on Built To Fail, which is a look at the history of street wear. The film features Tommy Hilfiger, Russell Simmons and a host of notable street wear designers. They are also in pre-production on The 29 Club, a look at notable musicians who all tragically died at age 29; Memories in Music, which is an in-depth study of the impact of memory through music on Alzheimer’s patients and Faces of Vegas, an exploration into the culture of Las Vegas, Nevada. 

 

Blue Collar Productions currently has the feature film Looking For Alaska, based on the John Green novel, producing for Paramount Pictures. The company produced for a pilot for MTV for a possible series, “My Jam” aired in the Fall of 2016. Blue Collar has also produced two seasons of “Caribbean’s Next Top Model Season.”

 

Blue Collar Productions designs branding and marketing campaigns and has had contracts with some of the world’s largest companies including PepsiCo, Intel, HP, WalMart and many other Fortune 500 companies. Additionally, they create motion picture, television and home entertainment marketing campaigns for studios including Sony, DreamWorks, Twentieth Century Fox, Universal Studios, Paramount Studios, and Warner Brothers.

 

The CEO of this division, Mr. Rowen, has worked with filmmakers including Steven Spielberg, Ron Howard, Brett Ratner and James Cameron. Mr. Rowen also has very close working relationships with actors including Tom Hanks, Brad Pitt, Julia Roberts, Robert Downey, Jr., Denzel Washington, Ryan Gosling, Sofia Vergara, Mariska Hargitay and many others.

 

Prior to starting Blue Collar Productions, Mr. Rowen functioned as the head of home entertainment production for DreamWorks SKG from 1997 to 2000. He also serves as the President of Long Leash Entertainment, an aggregator of entertainment based intellectual property and creator of high-end entertainment content.

 

TPT MedTech, LLC – Medical Division

 

TPT MedTech believes it is strategically positioned to take advantage of the current trend in Point of Care Testing (“POCT”) by aligning itself with the exponential growth of smart devices equipped with mobile healthcare (mH), which may revolutionize personalized healthcare monitoring and management, thereby paving the way for next-generation POCT.

 

The rapid turnaround times, improved decision times, and time-critical decision-making of TPT MedTech QuikLAB can result in total savings between 8-20% of laboratory costs for facilities that implement POC testing. The savings realized due to the decreased cost of waiting for results can be as much as $260 USD per patient. For those that use and implement POC testing, waiting can improve by as much as 46 minutes per patient real-time scenarios—and days in standard laboratory settings. Management believes TPT MedTech QuikLAB is uniquely positioned to serve this growing market.

 

SANIQuik is a decontamination and sanitizing unit that TPT MedTech intends to co-market with the QuikLAB mobile laboratory as an integrated solution to certain issues arising from the COVID-19 pandemic. SANIQuik uses hypochlorous acid as a spray mist. This chemical has been safely used on many food products for decades. Hypochlorous acid does not cause irritation to eyes and skin. Even if it were ingested it causes no harm. Because it is so safe, it is the ideal sanitizer for direct food sanitation and food contact surfaces. It is also ideal in healthcare where it is used for wound cleansing, eye drops, and patient room disinfection replacing toxic chemicals such as bleach and quaternary ammonium salts. Hypochlorous acid is FDA, USDA, and EPA approved to minimize microbial food safety hazards of fresh-cut fruits and vegetables. (See https://www.hypochlorousacid.com/about.)

 

 
13

Table of Contants

 

TPT MedTech believes the SANIQuik external sanitation is safe, effective and flexible for its utilization with options for users. TPT MedTech intends to provide optional masks to users as they approach the SANIQuik. The mask provides a cover around inhalation of the mist. External sanitation is safe and effective, providing an additional routine to hand washing and facial coverings.

 

TPT MedTech has developed a business model which markets SANIQuik as a novel product within the Personal Protective Equipment (PPE) industry. This PPE distribution model is focused in the Federal procurement space (Veteran’s Administration, Department of Defense, Federal Emergency Management Agency, Centers for Disease Control, National Guard) as well as vendor to the top 20 National Hospital Group Purchasing Organizations (GPO).

 

TPT MedTech will be requesting Emergency Use Authorization (EUA) from the FDA for SANIQuik during the COVID-19 pandemic, which has been granted to other sanitizing units. SANIQuik already has the European CE mark. For attorney fees and consultants, we are estimating $50,000 for the EUA.

 

TPT MedTech developed its "QuikPASS™" Check and Verify passport system and Covid 19/vaccination monitoring platform for corporations, governmental organizations, schools, airlines, hospitals, sports venues & arenas, restaurants, hotels, and nightclubs. The all-in-one mobile system checks and verifies that an individual has been tested for Covid-19 or vaccinated, providing proof individuals are able to travel or gain access to venues with the idea that everyone inside that venue would be Covid free. The "QuikPASS" "Check and Verify" passport-style platform works with third-party testing labs and organizations that participate on the "QuikPASS" Network and will be offered FREE to US domestic and international business commerce and governmental organizations around the world.

 

K Telecom and Global Telecom- GSM Distribution

 

K Telecom and Global Telecom are located in the Northwest of the United States and sell and distribute GSM Cell Phone and Prepaid GSM Services for MVNO’s (Mobile Virtual Network Operators) through approximately 100 brick and mortar retail store-front locations in Washington and Oregon.

 

San Diego Media Division

 

San Diego Media, Inc. (“SDM”) is an established Southern California based software engineering and Internet e-commerce marketing services company that provides enterprise-class integrated solutions for manufacturers, retailers, and distributors focused on developing solutions for companies seeking online growth and profitability. The primary market offering has been MaxEXP®, a proven stable, productivity-enabling proprietary eCommerce platform, built on open-standards technology that empowers companies to deploy and manage eCommerce offerings at lower cost and at less time than required to deploy more conventional high-end solutions.

 

Copperhead Digital Holdings, LLC/TruCom, LLC– CLEC–Phoenix, Arizona

 

Our TruCom division, a subsidiary of Copperhead Digital Holdings, LLC, is a Facilities Based Competitive Local Exchange Carrier (CLEC) headquartered in Phoenix, AZ. Founded in 2006 (as Copperhead Digital Carrier) for the purpose of operating a state-of-the-art Fiber Optic Network constructed by and acquired from Adelphia Communications, TruCom now operates its own carrier class Fiber Optic Network, state-of-the-art Wireless Point-to-Point network, and Patent Pending proprietary “Bulletproof” technology seamlessly integrating the two.

 

TruCom offers Phone, Internet, Fiber Optic, Wireless, Hosted PBX, Wi-Fi, Wi-Max, Engineering, Cabling, Wiring and Cloud services. TruCom offers hosted firewall and managed MPLS service technologies (SuperCore MPLS™). The company currently operates an approximate 58 miles Fiber optic ring throughout the greater Phoenix valley offering such services as Basic Residential Phone service, Basic Business phone service, POT’s lines, Basic Fiber Broadband Internet services, Wireless Internet Services, Toll Free 800 services, EFax, Erate, Dedicated T-1 Services, Auto Attendant, SIP Trunks, Mobile and VoIP services.

 

Media Content

 

We operate as a Media Content Hub for Domestic and International syndication, Technology/Telecommunications company using on our own proprietary Global Digital Media TV and Telecommunications infrastructure platform and we also provide technology solutions to businesses worldwide. We offer Software as a Service (SaaS), Technology Platform as a Service (PAAS), Cloud-based Unified Communication as a Service (UCaaS) and carrier-grade performance and support for businesses over our private IP MPLS fiber and wireless network in the United States. Our cloud-based UCaaS services allow businesses of any size to enjoy all the latest voice, data, media and collaboration features in today's global technology markets. We also operate as a Master Distributor for Nationwide Mobile Virtual Network Operators (MVNO) and Independent Sales Organization (ISO) as a Master Distributor for Pre-Paid Cellphone services, Mobile phones, Cellphone Accessories and Global Roaming Cellphones.

 

 
14

Table of Contants

 

Our technologies “Gathers Big Data” to predict our customers’ viewing and spending habits. We then deliver Products and Services to support that estimated demand and share advertising revenues with our Content, Digital Media and Linear Broadcast Partners worldwide.

 

Each of our four divisions contributes to the launch of our global Content delivery platform “ViewMe Live” and creates cross pollinating revenue opportunities and a closed Global E-commerce Eco environment which we believe will help us execute our short and long term corporate objectives. Our Content Division which consists of Blue Collar Productions (our TV and Film content Production company) creates original content and in some cases third party content. Once Content has been produced we will then broadcast and delivered that content over our proprietary Mobile TV Platform on our proprietary TruCom Telecommunication Network infrastructure domestically and internationally.

 

CUBS (Cloud Unified Business Services)

 

We are a CUBS provider (Cloud Unified Businesses Services) company and one of the first to combine recurring Telecom, Media and Data/Cloud Services revenue under one roof, then bring all relevant data from those services into a proprietary telecom infrastructure and information matrix platform capable of delivering a “Daily and Intelligent Dashboard” to our Domestic and International customers. Such a planned cohesive combination of services and information from a single provider has been heretofore nonexistent. We intend to pioneer an integrate communication services and information technology suites to empower individuals and companies with vital communications, Smartphone, Network, Content, SaaS (Software as A Service), New Media Technology products and services, and valuable relevant diagnostic information both Domestically and Internationally.

 

We are currently able to deliver a live Global TV Broadcast and Social Media Platform utilizing a Mobile App technology on our proprietary Content Delivery Network. We plan to expand our Cloud Unified Business Services (CUBS) technology-based business services unifying multiple services from the cloud.

 

RECENT DEVELOPMENTS

 

Financing Arrangements

 

Effective January 31, 2022, the Company consummated a Securities Purchase Agreement dated January 31, 2022, with Talos Victory Fund, LLC (Talos Victory) and Blue Lake Partners, LLC (“Blue Lake”) (all together referred to as “January 2022 Investors”) for the purchase of $543,500 convertible promissory notes (“Convertible Promissory Notes”).  These Convertible Promissory Notes are due twelve months from the issue date, have an original issue discount of 8% and interest rate at 10% per annum (default, as defined, at 16%). There is an optional conversion in the event a Nasdaq Listing prior to nine months from funding for which the Investors principal and interest balances will be converted at a price equal to 25% discount to the opening price on the first day the Company trades on Nasdaq. There is also a voluntary conversion of all principal and accrued interest at the discretion of the Investor at $0.0075. The Investors were given registration rights. The Convertible Promissory Notes may be prepaid in whole or in part of the outstanding balances at 100 % prior to maturity, unless the January 2022 Investors chose to convert their balances into common stock which they have three days to do so. 146,744,998 common shares of the Company have been reserved with the transfer agent for possible conversion. Warrants, expiring five years from issuance, were issued to exercise up to 18,116,666 warrants to purchase 18,226,666 common shares at $0.015, provided, however, that if the Company consummates an Uplist Offering on or before July 6, 2022 then the exercise price is 110% of the offering price at which the Uplist Offering is made.  The use of proceeds will be for working capital and to pay off existing debt.

 

On April 1, 2022, the Company entered into a Future Receivable Sale and Purchase Agreement (“Mr Advance Agreement”) with Mr. Advance LLC (”MR.A”). The balance to be purchased and sold is $411,000 for which the Company received $270,715, net of fees. Under the Mr Advance Agreement, the Company is to pay $8,935 per week for 46 weeks at an effective interest rate of approximately 36% annually.

    

On April 1, 2022, the Company entered into a Future Receipts Sale and Purchase Agreement (“CLOUDFUND Agreement”) with CLOUDFUND LLC (”CLOUDFUND”). The balance to be purchased and sold is $411,000 for which the Company received $272,954, net of fees. Under the CLOUDFUND Agreement, the Company is to pay $8,935 per week for 46 weeks at an effective interest rate of approximately 36% annually.

 

Amendments to Articles of Incorporation or Bylaws

 

On January 2, 2022, the Board of Directors of the Company also  in accordance with the provisions of the Certificate of Incorporation, as amended, and by-laws of the Company amended the Certificate of Incorporation to increase the authorized number of common shares by Two Hundred Fifty Million (250,000,000) which increase will then make the total authorized common shares to be One Billion Five Hundred Million (1,500,000,000) with all common shares having the then existing rights powers and privileges as per the existing amended Certificate of Incorporate and Bylaws of the Company. 

 

On February 11, 2022, the Board of Directors of the Company in accordance with the provisions of the Certificate of Incorporation, as amended, and by-laws of the Company amended the Certificate of Incorporation to increase the authorized number of common shares by one billion (1,000,000,000) which increase will then make the total authorized common shares to be two billion five hundred million (2,500,000,000) with all common shares having the then existing rights powers and privileges as per the existing amended Certificate of Incorporate and Bylaws of the Company.

 

Accounts Payable and Financing Arrangements Exchanged for Series E Preferred Stock

 

Subsequent to December 31, 2021, holders of financing arrangements with the Company totaling $10,417,602 agreed to either forgive their balances owing to them by the Company or exchange their financing amounts outstanding as of March 31, 2022 for shares of Series E Preferred Stock of the Company. As such, 1,929,566 shares of Series E Preferred Stock were issued in exchange for $9,647,832 in outstanding financing arrangements and $769,770 was forgiven and will be recognized as a contribution to Mezzanine Equity.  These amounts were calculated through March 31, 2022.

 

 
15

Table of Contants

 

 

 

CORPORATE MARKETING STRATEGY

 

Our corporate strategy in expanding our operations and potential product and service streams is as follows.

 

MARKETING OBJECTIVE:

Establish our brand as a competitive service and product provider in the communications industry.

 

ADVERTISING OBJECTIVE:

To create top of mind brand awareness and emotional relevance resulting: TPT Global Tech, Inc. being the preferred and requested product line of products in the industry.

 

SALES & MERCHANDISING OBJECTIVES:

Our distributor will use direct selling efforts. Their efforts will be supported with our marketing, advertising, and merchandising programs. The primary task will be to increase the sales through retail channels.

 

PURSUE BRAND RECOGNITION THROUGHOUT THE UNITED STATES

 

The first marketing objective must be to refine our brand and secure our place in the minds of the consumers. This will be accomplished through the execution of an integrated branding, identity and services marketing programs. The goals for this segment will be an enhanced brand identity, a brand applications and a digital assets suite.

 

MARKETING STRATEGY

 

Our plan includes a direct sales program targeting businesses, small business and home office users of communications. The direct sales efforts will be supported with third party marketing integration. To further enhance the sales process, we will offer an offering program including services and product sheets, coupons, point of sale materials (banners, shelf talkers, and end cap displays and danglers) and internet marketing programs.

 

Based on the above benefit scenarios, we plan to seize the following opportunities:

 

 

·

Build superior brand recognition and become recognized as a category leader.

 

 

 

 

·

Expand the US distribution into all states.

 

 

 

 

·

Establish distribution internationally.

 

 

 

 

·

Establish and manage a knowledgeable team of account executives with industry experience.

 

 

 

 

·

Create a retail merchandising program that will build a strong market share.

 

The purpose of our marketing efforts is to move the product sales from their current position into the rapid growing “popularity” stage. Our strategy includes the following marketing programs: Branding; Merchandising; Direct; Display Advertising; Media; Public Relations; Publicity; Events; Investor Relations; Metrics Dashboard; and, Personal Sales. Our objective is to gain the sales momentum required to reach the “brand preference” stage of product growth as soon as possible. This is the stage where we plan sales grow at a steady and stabilized pace.

 

 
16

Table of Contants

 

THE DIRECT MARKETING PROGRAM

 

A complete direct marketing program including direct mail, blast email and URLs may be used to introduce the products to new customers and secure leads for the sales team. We plan to employ the services of a database marketing company to leverage techniques to target prospective clients and reinforce product messages throughout the selling process. This process will commence with the modeling of our existing customer data and the analysis of the results using sophisticated analytic tools. Cross-channel marketing will be utilized in conjunction with the direct marketing including social marketing. Our focus of this marketing medium will be relevance and timing, which only this medium can provide full control over and the ability to fully quantify the results.

 

THE MEDIA MARKETING PROGRAM

 

We intend to test several media options to determine which, if any, effectively drive sales and sales leads. The mediums being consider include outdoor advertising, both static and mobile, magazine ads, and radio spots. Other media to be explored are direct mail post cards and emails to opt in viewers.

 

THE PUBLIC RELATIONS/PUBLICITY PROGRAM

 

We plan to employ the services of a public relations firm to build a corporate profile to keep the name and the services and products in front of consumers. A third-party PR firm will be responsible for writing and publishing press releases, coordinating event marketing and managing investor relations.

 

We employ marketing, sales and customer service personnel on an as needed basis for specific events to build brand awareness. We use a range of marketing strategies and tactics to build our brand and increase sales, including point-of-sale materials, event sponsorship, in-store and on-premise promotions, public relations, and a variety of other traditional and non-traditional marketing techniques to support the sales of all of our products.

 

We believe that a marketing mix of event promotions, social media, print advertising in local media and internet advertising providing information and samples of our products at social events is a strategy that may help increase sales.

 

TARGET CUSTOMER

 

We plan to profile our existing customers and create a sophisticated data model to mathematically and statistically identify our “ideal” customer. Further the model will be used to learn exactly how the target customer wishes to be communicated with and marketed to.

 

THE INTERNATIONAL MARKET

 

We plan to market our product internationally. Many of the current products offered by us have features for the international community. This will be a secondary but strong focus by our marketing team.

 

CORPORATE STRATEGY

 

Our Goals

 

Our primary goal is to continue to grow our business by improving value to our current customers and vendors. In providing a high-quality network we intend to continue to grow our business. Additionally, we intend to purchase established telecommunications and technology companies that will immediately generate and increase traffic (revenue) to our Company’s retail and wholesale network. Companies that we are strategically aligned with have in their core business synergistic retail products and services that include, but are not limited to, Telecom Cloud Services Media, Merchant Services/Mobile Banking, Cloud Services and Media (e.g. credit/debit card processing, check/ACH payment processing, ecommerce/merchant processing, web hosting, voice, data, GSM/Wi-Fi Mobile, Mobile Money Transfers, IPTV, VOD and Live Mobile Broadcasting, Prepaid Calling Card and PIN-less Prepaid services). If we acquire a strategic partner as a subsidiary, we believe we will have the ability to aggregate their analogous technology platforms onto our proprietary Software Access System operating platform for integration and efficiency.

 

We intend to work our media to accelerate cohesively in the mobile technology sectors: LIVE Broadcast, Video on Demand (VOD) Apps, and Digital Video Magazine (DVM) Apps. While “white labeling” our technologies as SaaS, our primary focus is what we believe is the first Global Cyber LIVE Mobile TV broadcast network, ViewMe Live. The ViewMe Live Network™ is a 24-hour LIVE worldwide mobile TV network, delivered via iOS and Android apps. The ViewMe Live Network™ presents a diversity of Linear Broadcast Channels (Domestically and International), coupled with Social Media Platforms with combined functions that compete with some of the largest and most powerful Digital Media platforms, to connected audiences who live a mobile-centric life.

 

 
17

Table of Contants

 

Network Services

 

Domestic and Global Telecommunications offerings include: Mobile TV, Phone, Internet, Fiber Optic, Wireless, Hosted PBX, Wi-Fi, Wi-Max, Engineering, Cabling, Wiring and Cloud services. Our telecommunications division has pioneered innovative, hosted firewall and managed MPLS service technologies (SuperCore MPLS) and was the industry’s first to engineer patent-pending Bulletproof™ failover services utilizing our own fiber optic and wireless networks to guarantee business continuity and service uptime.

 

As a retail and business media and telecommunications provider operating a high-speed Fiber Optic Network and Wireless Network in the USA at a cost competitive rate for new technologies, we are growing our operations through sales of our core voice & data connectivity products to small and midsized business clients. We have a growth strategy through acquisitions in order to increase regional operations and deploy more technologies to niche & underserved markets. Unified Cloud Services, Unified Communications (UC) or Unified Communications/Collaboration (UCC) has been a topic of interest to users looking to evolve from a disorderly combination of media, voice, email and message communications to something more structured. Our goal is to target existing and new small and medium businesses (“SMBs”) to transition their older voice system businesses, expand their software collaboration offerings, and most recently build cloud service offerings. Cloud solution gives our customers the flexibility to support a myriad of mobile devices as part of their hardware strategy, whether it's launching a bring-your-own-device initiative, implementing a one-to-one program or equipping SMBs with mobile computing carts full of tablets, netbooks, or notebooks in a secured environment.

 

Scalability and Cost Efficiency

 

Our proprietary Software Access System platform currently runs our global operations. In short, it does this by connecting our customer base with the most profitable vendor route while calculating least cost routing, analyzing route quality, and respecting “dipping” protocols. Based on the demand, we have the ability to scale to meet the needs of our customers. Comparable “off the shelf” software systems in the marketplace can cost in the hundreds of thousands of dollars just to purchase, not to mention expensive service contracts, which may continue in perpetuity after the original purchase. Our proprietary platform, in which we have invested and have developed over several years, allows us to operate a global network with better efficiency which we believe differentiates us from other competitors in the marketplace.

 

We believe our competitive advantages are:

 

 

·

We believe our ViewMe Live products and services are close to being ready to launch globally.

 

 

 

 

·

We offer 3-15 seconds latency Cellular – 1-5 on Wi-Fi.

 

 

 

 

·

We offer Proprietary Optimizing / Stabilizing software.

 

 

 

 

·

We offer Multi-Channel LIVE and Video on Demand worldwide.

 

 

 

 

·

We offer Patent Pending real time dynamic failover solution called Bulletproof™.

 

 

 

 

·

We offer our own proprietary voice switching and management platform running least cost routing and real time financial analytics.

 

 

 

 

·

We have over 175 existing USA and International Telephone companies already interconnected to our telecom switches. These customers and vendors are ready made strategic technology distribution partners for our Telecom, Media, and Cloud Services products.

 

Our Strategy

 

Our business, marketing, and sales strategy is structured around:

 

 

·

Pursuing selective, strategic, distribution relationships combined with cash positive acquisitions to build immediate revenue streams and increase our Company’s network footprint.

 

 

·

Utilize the expanded network to offer our Company’s service thereby increasing marginal revenues through the low risk offering of wholesale termination and prepaid services through existing distribution channels, retail stores and E-Commerce both domestically and internationally.

 

 
18

Table of Contants

 

 

·

Pursuing markets within countries where there is a lower concentration of communications services that will result in initial higher pricing and potential for gross profit.

 

 

·

Providing low cost, pricing leading VoIP/GSM value added services through our Company’s next-generation centralized software platform and network.

 

 

·

Partnering and developing joint ventures with incumbent networks or government agencies to penetrate local emerging markets in order to build and operate Intranet Network Infrastructures that would move data over a secured network servicing government buildings and agencies, including police, military, hospitals and schools.

 

Our Intended Marketing Plan and Product Roll Out for 2022 and 2023

 

 

·

Satellite radio syndication simulcast with over 25 million domestic U.S. listeners

 

·

Connected TV partner with over 18 million viewers worldwide.

 

·

Airline entertainment partnership with over 12 million international viewers.

 

·

Supported by an international public relations firm.

 

·

Comprehensive social media marketing campaign involving popular bloggers and podcasters

 

Our sales and marketing approach to our business and consumer customers emphasizes customer-oriented sales, marketing and service. Our marketing plans include marketing our products and services primarily through direct sales representatives, inbound call centers, local retail stores, telemarketing and third parties, including retailers, satellite television providers, door to door sales agents and digital marketing firms. We support our distribution with digital marketing, direct mail, bill inserts, newspaper and television advertising, website promotions, public relations activities and sponsorship of community events and sports venues.

 

Similarly, our sales and marketing approach to our business customers includes a commitment to provide comprehensive communications and IT solutions for business, wholesale and governmental customers of all sizes, ranging from small offices to select enterprise customers. We strive to offer our business customers stable, reliable, secure and trusted solutions. Our marketing plans include marketing our products and services primarily through digital advertising, direct sales representatives, inbound call centers, telemarketing and third parties, including telecommunications agents, system integrators, value-added resellers and other telecommunications firms. We support our distribution through digital advertising, events, television advertising, website promotions and public relations.

 

Marketing Designs

 

We have designed our services and products offered to be:

 

 

·

Portable. We offer the ability to access our network from anywhere within our coverage area without being restricted to a specific location.

 

 

·

Simple. Our services are easy to install. After connecting our modem to an ATA or computer and a power source, our wireless broadband service is immediately available and requires no software installation.

 

 

·

Fast. We offer speeds that typically exceed legacy cellular networks and are competitive with fixed broadband offerings.

 

 

·

A Good Value. We generally price our services competitively because our costs to build and operate our network are significantly lower than the networks operated by many of our competitors.

 

With the popularity of social media, people are demanding fast broadband connectivity on an increasingly mobile basis. We believe that our services meet this demand and will market this in our efforts to increase our subscriber growth rate.

 

 
19

Table of Contants

 

OUR COMPANY STRENGTHS

 

We believe the following competitive strengths enable us to meet the demand for simple, reliable and portable wireless broadband connectivity:

 

 

·

First mover. We are the first company we are aware of to launch a Global Cyber Mobile TV and Social Media Network that incorporates functional feature of the largest Digital Media companies in the world.

 

 

 

 

·

High barriers to entry. Our issued and pending patents, as well as our proprietary Media platforms and Naked Eye 3D technology trade secrets give us a strong intellectual property position that we believe creates a significant barrier to entry for potential competitors.

 

 

 

 

·

Broad range of applications for our platform. This allows us to build a deep new product pipeline that creates multiple paths to build a large and profitable business.

 

 

 

 

·

Multi-billion-dollar addressable market. U.S. digital advertising revenues rose to $26.2 billion in the third quarter of 2018, solidifying 2018’s claim as the highest-spending first three quarters on record, according to the latest IAB Internet Advertising Revenue Report released today by IAB and prepared by PwC US. Digital spend for Q3 2018 estimates increased 20.6 percent over Q3 2017. In total, marketers spent $75.8 billion during 2018’s first three quarters—22 percent more than they had spent during the same period a year ago. https://iab.com/wp-content/uploads/2019/02/IAB_Internet-Ad-Revenue-Report-Q3-2018_2019-02-14_FINAL-1.pdf

 

 

 

 

·

Diverse revenue streams including Digital Media partnerships. We anticipate generating significant revenue from our Digital Media platforms. Our Linear Broadcast partners will play a large part in generating revenues from the sale of mobile and social media advertising.

 

 

 

 

·

Strong senior leadership team. Our founders and senior leaders have experience in building and operating several companies in our business areas. We have phone, network, content, SaaS, product development, and commercialization experience that has enabled us to establish market leadership positions for the companies where we previously were employed.

 

 

 

 

·

Differentiated Services. We believe our service is unique because of our combination of our Worldwide Operational Platform, Worldwide Affiliates, Cutting Edge Technology, Portability, Simplicity and Speed to Market with a competitive domestic and International Price Structure. We believe this combination of factors differentiates our subscriber’s experience when compared to broadband services provided by DSL, cable modem, wireless third-generation or 3G, networks.

 

 

 

 

·

Strong Spectrum Position. We use unlicensed and licensed spectrum (in Arizona), which avoids radio frequency interference that hinders competitors using non-licensed spectrum, such as WiFi network operators. Access to spectrum is a fundamental barrier to entry for the delivery of high-quality wireless communications. Through our partnerships, we believe that we have access to the second largest spectrum position in our band within the United States.

 

 

 

 

·

Advanced, Scalable Technology. Because we intend to design our own software and equipment, we can refine our product development roadmap to meet our subscriber’s needs. We believe our NLOS, IP-based Ethernet architecture and compression technology confers competitive advantages since it simplifies both network deployment and customer use while supporting a broad range of potential premium services.

 

 

 

 

·

Efficient Economic Model. We believe our individual market economic model is characterized by low fixed capital and operating expenditures relative to other wireless and wire line broadband service providers. We believe our individual market model is highly scalable and replicable across our markets. As our capabilities evolve, we expect to generate incremental revenue streams from our subscriber base by developing and offering premium products and services.

 

 

 

 

·

Experienced Management Team. Stephen J. Thomas, our Founder, Chairman, and Chief Executive Officer, has been an active entrepreneur, operator and investor in the industry for more than 17 years in VoIP and wireless communications industry. He previously served as Director of Network Optimization/Validation for WorldxChange, Inc. and CEO and President of New Orbit Communications, Inc., which focused on International Operator Services in United States, Mexico, El Salvador and Guatemala.

 

FUTURE PLANS

 

Our VuMe Live Technology Plan

 

We offer VML technology for which we plan to expand marketing. We believe SaaS ViewMe Live (VML) could become a leading Digital Media Mobile TV technology platform in the business-to-business and business-to-consumer markets. Our proprietary software platform can reach a worldwide audience of approximately one billion mobile viewers. VML addresses global mobile distribution of LIVE and Video on Demand (“VOD”) content as a white label Software as a Service (“SaaS”).

 

 
20

Table of Contants

 

VML OTT live streaming technology is similar to what you see with satellite TV such as Dish Network and DirecTV, as well as cable companies. Almost all currently existing live streaming cannot do live broadcast streaming at this level and usually has anywhere from 1 minute to 10 minute delays or continuous buffering, never loading the video. With VML, there is the ability to have “worldwide” access for a live streaming event equal to standard television broadcasting with tens of millions of simultaneous users. We believe that VML is the first technology to be able to achieve this level of live streaming. In emerging countries that do not have fiber, cable and satellite TV, access to VML is simple and cost effective, as long as there is a cellular connection on a 3G network or higher (regardless of provider)[1]. VML aims to provide uninterrupted live streaming on mobile devices without buffering, crashes, pixilation, or audio and video syncing issues. One practical application of this technology is that a viewer can move from a Wi--Fi connection to a 3G connection without interruption. VML has a unique user interface with multi-channel access and built-in social media, and we believe it is unlike anything currently on the market. VML also has the capability to do a Live Linear Broadcast with VOD.VML’s technology has the potential to reduce web content pirating since high quality TV broadcast is now easily accessed worldwide on mobile devices.

 

[1] Subject to the laws and regulations of each country.

 

Currently, we believe we are the only company that does all the above in the industry and we believe VML has the potential to expand our technologies and applications even further.

 

The hottest technology in the over the top (“OTT”) market and the biggest challenge in the OTT market is “Live Linear Channel Broadcasting” and “Live Event Broadcasting” to equal standard television broadcasting on cable and satellite TV. This type of technology is superior to video on demand (VOD) streaming technology in both acquisition and delivery. The growth of OTT video delivery has been significant. In the past year alone, OTT has grown to $35 billion in global revenue, with $17 billion coming from emerging markets source Digital TV Research. ViewMe Live (“VML”) has many technology advantages including: Artificial Intelligence (“AI”); the ability to simultaneously access millions of users simultaneously with virtually no latency equivalent to standard television broadcasting; global distribution (without interruption) on cellular and Wi-Fi; and a fully interactive menu user interface and worldwide advertising brokers in place.

 

VML’s content delivery network (“CDN”) can potentially reach tens of millions of mobile devices (tablets and smartphones) and has the potential to scale to one billion video streams globally. It loads content within seconds, not only for Wi-Fi, but also more importantly, on cellular networks that are 3G and higher. VML’s core technology is fully developed and is able to support clients on a turnkey native mobile app in less than 60 days. We have already achieved major milestones as the world’s largest private conduit build out for global deployment of LIVE and VOD streaming content. Our OTT live streaming technology is unique and proprietary. Here are some highlights on how VML can help from telecommunication companies to TV station broadcasters to digital film libraries.

 

VML has the ability to create a “Master Network Mobile App” that can allow for a multiple channel build out, each with its own unique Pay Per View charge (optional). This means a company can have a live event channel per country with a different price per user based on the economics of that country. VML has unlimited channel build out (e.g. a company could have 50 channels or 1000 channels). Any telecommunications company can have professional looking displays and user interfaces for mobile with VML, similar to what the large telecommunications companies provide. A Master Network App also allows a network to expand into other categories by country (e.g. additional sports categories for various sports by country). Expansion can focus on audience aggregation for sports and other forms of entertainment categories. Pay-Per View is an option for these expanded categories as well. We have built-in worldwide ad brokers for pre---roll commercial ads so that revenue can be generated as soon as possible. There is also potential to upsell to existing advertisers and sponsors and it can be brand specific by country.

 

VOICOPS APP

 

Spurned from our VML technology, the Company will Beta launch its Gaming Social Media App “VOICOPS”. “VOICOPS” as the company’s first gaming-focused APP and will offer a REAL-TIME Looking-for-Group (LFG) function providing a speedy way for gamers to group-up live in games and with audio “Chat ROOMS”. The Gaming Social Media App also allows for unlimited users to join the audience mode to listen-in on the action from each team. “VOICOPS” features several built-in social media functions for gamers to post articles, videos of game-play, and links to YouTube videos.

 

The initial gaming-focused platform “VOICOPS” will feature during its Beta launch will be Amazon’s highly anticipated Med Evil New World video game. Amazon released its Beta version in 2021 and TPT is planning its “VOICOPS” Beta launch anticipated to be in early 2022. 

 

 
21

Table of Contants

 

tptw_10kimg3.jpg

 

 

The primary benefit of “VOICOPS” will be the ease of finding audio or chat GROUP featured LIVE and real-time gaming platforms around the world.  The Med Evil New World game currently does not have any features to handle this kind of in-game interaction. Most video game platforms do not offer this level of functionality. “VOICOPS” users will uniquely be able to open a public or private live audio room and show it in real time by server and LFG Looking For Group, Player VS Player, Dungeons, Questing, etc.

 

The “VOICOPS” app offers a live news feed where all the users can post articles, YouTube videos, photos about the games they enjoy and be a part of the Med Evil New World Community. YouTube content creators can also post YouTube video links and reach a larger viewing audience that are focused on the game’s content. Companies (Guilds) can set up a presence in the company’s “VOICOPS” app and offer recruiting, meetings with live audio, live presentations and plan large attacks on other factions.

 

TPT MedTech 

 

The point-of-care diagnostics or testing (POCD or POCT) market is projected to reach USD $46.7 billion by 2024 from USD $28.5 billion in 2019, at a CAGR of 10.4%. Factors such as the high prevalence of infectious diseases in developing countries, increasing incidence of target conditions, growing government support, and rising preference for home healthcare across the globe are driving the growth of the market. However, product recalls, a lack of alignment with test results obtained from laboratories, stringent & time-consuming approval policies, and a reluctance to change existing diagnostic practices are expected to restrain market growth. https://www.marketsandmarkets.com/Market-Reports/point-of-care-diagnostic-market-106829185.html

 

The global COVID-19 diagnostics market size was valued at USD $5.2 billion in 2020 and is expected to grow at a compound annual growth rate (CAGR) of 5.96% from 2021 to 2027. The COVID-19 diagnostic tests are critical in the management of the current pandemic for accurate diagnosis as well as to tackle the spread of the infection. As a result, with the growing demand, these tests are being made available with over 600 SARS-CoV-2 diagnostic tests either approved or in the development phase for clinical use. Therefore, an increase in need for developing diagnostic tests is anticipated to drive the market growth. For efficient and accurate COVID-19 diagnosis, clinicians need a portable or an on-site diagnostic test for real-time management of patients in minimal time. This has encouraged the adoption of Point-of-Care testing (POCT) for diagnosis, primarily aimed at reducing the assay duration from hours to a few minutes. https://www.grandviewresearch.com/industry-analysis/covid-19-diagnostics-market.https://www.marketwatch.com/press-release/covid-19-diagnostics-market-by-development-trends-investigation-2020-and-forecast-to-2027-2020-06-17

 

TPT MedTech believes it is strategically positioned to take advantage of the current trend in POCT by aligning itself with the exponential growth of smart devices equipped with mobile healthcare (mH), which may revolutionize personalized healthcare monitoring and management, thereby paving the way for next-generation POCT.

 

The rapid turnaround times, improved decision times, and time-critical decision-making of TPT MedTech QuikLAB can result in total savings between 8-20% of laboratory costs for facilities that implement POC testing. The savings realized due to the decreased cost of waiting for results can be as much as $260 USD per patient. For those that use and implement POC testing, waiting can improve by as much as 46 minutes per patient real-time scenarios—and days in standard laboratory settings. Management believes TPT MedTech QuikLAB is uniquely positioned to serve this growing market.

 

 
22

Table of Contants

 

SANIQuik is a decontamination and sanitizing unit that TPT MedTech intends to co-market with the QuikLAB mobile laboratory as an integrated solution to certain issues arising in the COVID-19 pandemic. SANIQuik uses hypochlorous acid as a spray mist. This chemical has been safely used on many food products for decades. Hypochlorous acid does not cause irritation to eyes and skin. Even if it were ingested it causes no harm. Because it is so safe, it is the ideal sanitizer for direct food sanitation and food contact surfaces. It is also ideal in healthcare where it is used for wound cleansing, eye drops, and patient room disinfection replacing toxic chemicals such as bleach and quaternary ammonium salts. Hypochlorous acid is FDA, USDA, and EPA approved to minimize microbial food safety hazards of fresh-cut fruits and vegetables. (See https://www.hypochlorousacid.com/about.)

 

TPT MedTech believes the SANIQuik external sanitation is safe, effective and flexible for its utilization with options for users. TPT MedTech intends to provide optional masks to users as they approach the SANIQuik. The mask provides a cover around inhalation of the mist. External sanitation is safe and effective, providing an additional routine to hand washing and facial coverings.

 

TPT MedTech has developed a business model which markets SANIQuik as a novel product within the Personal Protective Equipment (PPE) industry. This PPE distribution model is focused in the Federal procurement space (Veteran’s Administration, Department of Defense, Federal Emergency Management Agency, Centers for Disease Control, National Guard) as well as vendor to the top 20 National Hospital Group Purchasing Organizations (GPO).

 

TPT MedTech will be requesting Emergency Use Authorization (EUA) from the FDA for SANIQuik during the COVID-19 pandemic, which has been granted to other sanitizing units. SANIQuik already has the European CE mark. For attorney fees and consultants, we are estimating $50,000 for the EUA.

 

TPT MedTech developed its "QuikPASS™" Check and Verify passport system and Covid 19/vaccination monitoring platform for corporations, governmental organizations, schools, airlines, hospitals, sports venues & arenas, restaurants, hotels, and nightclubs. The all-in-one mobile system checks and verifies that an individual has been tested for Covid-19 or vaccinated, providing proof individuals are able to travel or gain access to venues with the idea that everyone inside that venue would be Covid free. The "QuikPASS" "Check and Verify" passport-style platform works with third-party testing labs and organizations that participate on the "QuikPASS" Network and will be offered FREE to US domestic and international business commerce and governmental organizations around the world.

 

Mobile Device Viewer Market Expansion

 

In general, viewers are consuming more content via mobile TV distribution, while rapidly abandoning expensive subscriptions from standard satellite TV and cable networks. The rise of high-quality content on low-cost platforms, such as mobile devices, continues to negatively impact the standard TV industry. The media business is being forced to evolve and adjust to massive disruptions in content distribution methods. Traditional media models are functionally broken and will continue to be disrupted by technology, which is driven by the needs of the younger generation. The future of media is dependent on new technology platforms. These platform models (e.g. smart TV, connected TV boxes, mobile TV devices) are the future of content distribution. Google, through YouTube, has changed the face of video content distribution. Amazon continues to disrupt the book industry. Apple has redefined music and application distribution. And Microsoft is continuing to change the engagement model and distribution of content through its Xbox TV game console.

 

We believe mobile delivery has a growing appeal to advertisers and subscribers. As brands continue to shift budgets to mobile advertising, they must reassess their approach to customer acquisition to ensure they continue to reach potential customers effectively. 

 

Digital ad spend grew 12% in 2020 despite hit from pandemic.  Source CNBC/IAB

 

The Interactive Advertising Bureau (IAB) said the top 10 companies held a 78.1% share of the revenues in 2020, with overall revenues of that group alone exceeding $109 billion. The top 10 companies accounted for a 75.9% share of revenues in 2018, rising to 76.6% in 2019. The IAB said companies ranked 11th to 25th account for just 6.2% of revenues, while smaller companies make up 15.7%. The IAB stated that spending during the third and fourth quarters of 2020 was up by 11.7% and 28.7% year-over-year, respectively.

 

Social media ad revenues reached $41.5 billion in 2020, the report said, making up nearly 30% of all internet ad revenue. Digital video saw 20.6% year-over-year growth, increasing its share of total internet ad revenue by 1.3% to reach 18.7%. Programmatic ad revenue also increased by 24.9% to reach $14.2 billion in 2020.

 

 
23

Table of Contants

 

 

tptw_10kimg5.jpg

 

 

Content Mining Plan

 

Once our planned SaaS media applications, smart phones and tablets are launched into the domestic and international markets, content analytics or marketing data will be gathered from these devices. The data generated from these applications and devices will give us an advantage insight into our subscribers viewing and buying habits. Once data has been scrubbed of personally identifying information, we plan to be able to create original or lease content from broadcast partners to service what our analytics are telling us to produce (or license), with the intent on moving us closer towards predictive analytics. Predictive analytics is being able to predict what our customer likes based on their viewing habits and then produce that content targeted to our subscriber and then “push” that new (or licensed) content to them.

 

Lion Smart Phone Product

 

We are currently seeking a manufacturer for our Lion Smart Phone. Our Management believes our patent pending Lion smart phone is the first Full HD Naked Eye 3D smart phone ever launched in the United States. Lion Universe’s mobile 3D technology is patent pending. The smart phone will be distributed through our wholly-owned subsidiary K-TEL, in their existing brick and mortar distribution channel in the Northwest expanding into other areas. It is anticipated that a national and international roll out will soon follow. TPTW is building industry leading personal cellular phones designed for a wide appeal. With a business model built on innovation and progress starting with the Lion Phone technology, we intend to produce high-quality and easy-to-use cellular phones. Our Lion Phone was designed for consumers looking for portable and affordable cutting-edge technology. Our first-generation phones come equipped with full high definition resolution screen for better viewing. We believe this Full HD Naked Eye 3D smart Phone is perfect for watching movies, playing games, even editing photos or videos.

 

Whether that is looking at photos, playing music, emailing or surfing the web, our management believes consumers want more from their phones. We believe our Lion Phone raises the bar for cellular phones. For the first time ever, cellular users can enjoy quality 3D viewing with the naked eyes no glasses required enjoying full high definition video with smooth playback.

 

Our Management believes consumers have been waiting for a way to watch their favorite movies in 3D, with the convenience of their phone and gamers can have the leisure of playing their games without taking head gear with them. Our Lion Universe Technology strives to give customers the best possible experience with our Full HD Naked Eye 3D smart phone in the US and Global markets.

 

We understand the longer we wait the less advantage we might have in our efforts to market this phone as the marketplace moves very quickly. We intend to begin marketing this phone in 2022 as capital is available.

 

 
24

Table of Contants

 

Our differentiation from web streaming

 

We are not a website-based video streaming technology. VML is strictly a native mobile app focused on video streaming technology for mobile platforms. We are not a dashboard-based video content company where users upload content; we are a complete turnkey SaaS application. A survey released in May 2015, sponsored by Level 3 Communications, stated, “Offering both VOD and Live Linear channels will be critical for OTT providers to entice new prospects and gain market share. This trend is a critical one. For existing OTT providers, offering a VOD service may not be enough to maintain, much less grow, market share.” The trend towards adding live linear channel content has the potential to become “table stakes” in the OTT game over the next several years, with both breaking news and live sports content leading the way in terms of interest for OTT service providers adding live linear channels.

 

SaaS White Label

 

We plan to white label our suite of SaaS technologies for yearly licensing and monthly maintenance fees. The prospective user base for the SaaS White Label Suite is extensive as there are more than 200,000 TV broadcasters worldwide alone, and many of them are seeking to migrate to the vast mobile video streaming market space. The sizeable population of potential SaaS clients includes standard television broadcasters in every country, direct marketing companies, low-powered antenna broadcasters (such as universities and churches), IPTV broadcasters, and large content (film and TV) providers that are seeking to further monetize their properties for worldwide syndication.

 

The SaaS suite includes full app development on Apple iOS, Google Android and Roku connected boxes, user interface (menu system), advertising broker network for pre---roll commercial ads (from date of launch), 24/7 LIVE monitoring of inbound and outbound signals, data analytics, seamless updating to all platforms, Amazon web service (AWS) blade servers, and coverage up to the first 20 million streams. The white label product is offered to stand--alone.

 

User Interface

 

In a preprogrammed live linear broadcast application, viewers have free access via a playlist by category and have the ability to “catch--up” with what they may have missed in the LIVE broadcast, regardless of its original airdate. The video-on-demand (VOD) feature provides the opportunity to access additional viewers and monetize past content. After several years in development, we believe that VML has a significant first to market advantage and that no other companies currently have a comparable commercialized offering.

 

 

tptw_10kimg6.jpg

 

 
25

Table of Contants

 

Our Plan for Strategic Partnering with Telecommunication & Media Companies

 

Currently in the world, viewers usually need to have a contract with a cable provider (e.g. AT&T, Cox, Xfinity, Spectrum, or Cablevision in the U.S.) or satellite TV provider (e.g. DirecTV and DISH Network in the U.S.) and be in range of a residential or business Wi-Fi to be able to watch over the top (OTT) content on a connected TV device, website or mobile access. VML is capable of offering a nearly unlimited number of channels to mobile users virtually anywhere and everywhere, with global reach, far exceeding two U.S. satellite companies (DirecTV and DISH Network), which have 500+ channels each and are only available in the U.S.

 

We believe VML will immediately appeal to any channel that is currently on DirecTV and DISH Network for global mobile linear broadcast participation, simply because these platforms are only available in the U.S. market.

 

VML can provide low--powered TV stations (often found in churches and universities), along with high--powered stations, the ability to reach the entire global market. Other potential users are owners of libraries of digitized content, and LIVE event venues such as music concerts, sporting events, festivals, beauty pageants, summer and winter Olympic Games, award shows, red carpet events, trade shows and conventions. Enthusiasts can produce their own show in any area and could launch their own channels for travel, food, spirits, sports, outdoor recreation, retro TV shows, children, cartoons, comedy, drama, reality, education, automobiles, health, corporations, shopping, soap opera, game shows, dating, religion, etc., providing extensive possibilities for media expansion. Content providers will not be limited by the major TV networks and film studios for distribution rights.

 

We have targeted Telecommunication and Media Company Opportunities to offer:

 

 

·

Turn key mobile app for telecommunication and media companies for immediate distribution of TV broadcasts on terrestrial, cable and satellite for free or as subscription.

 

·

Turn key mobile app for free or pay per view live events.

 

·

Turn key mobile app for digital libraries of content providers.

 

·

Reseller program with territorial rights.

 

·

Worldwide analytics on mobile TV content provided to help with target marketing for products and services.

 

·

Transitions to the automotive industry car play systems.

 

·

Option to pre---load Master Network App on telecommunication company’s mobile devices such as smart phones and tablets.

 

·

Pre-load the SaaS white label clients on telecommunication company mobile devices.

 

Geo Fencing Available (The ability to offer broadcast territories by region or regional Networks)

 

Our Plan to Act as a Reseller with Territorial Rights

 

 

·

Value Added Reseller (VAR) to telecommunication and media companies.

 

·

Exclusive rights for a country or region for reselling the white label opportunity.

 

·

Offer to Telecommunication and media companies OTT digital content as a channel or network.

 

·

Offer 1 to 1000 channels by territory.

 

·

Approach emerging markets as capital resources permit.

 

Our business is subject to a number of risks of which you should be aware before making an investment decision. These risks are discussed more fully in the “Risk Factors” section of this prospectus immediately following this the summary.

 

Our Corporate Information          

 

We are a Florida corporation. Our principal executive offices are located at 501 W. Broadway, Suite 800, San Diego, CA 92101, and our telephone number is (619) 400-4996. Our website address is http://www.tptglobaltech.com. Information on or accessed through our website is not incorporated into this prospectus and is not a part of this prospectus.

 

 
26

Table of Contants

 

CYBER RISKS

 

Like other large telecommunications companies, we are a constant target of cyber-attacks of varying degrees, which has caused us to spend increasingly more time and money to deal with increasingly sophisticated attacks. Some of the attacks may result in security breaches, and we periodically notify our customers, our employees or the public of these breaches when necessary or appropriate. None of these resulting security breaches to date have materially adversely affected our business, results of operations or financial condition.

 

We rely on several other communications companies to provide services or products for our offerings. We may lease a significant portion of our core fiber network from our competitors and other third parties. Many of these leases will lapse in future years. Our future ability to provide services on the terms of our current offerings will depend in part upon our ability to renew or replace these leases, agreements and arrangements on terms substantially similar to those currently in effect.

 

For additional information regarding our systems, network, cyber risks, capital expenditure requirements and reliance upon third parties, see "Risk Factors."

 

COMPETITION, COMPETITORS, REGULATION AND TAXATION

 

Competition

 

General

 

We compete in a rapidly evolving and highly competitive market, and we expect intense competition to continue. In addition to competition from larger national telecommunications providers, we are facing increasing competition from several other sources, including cable and satellite companies, wireless providers, technology companies, cloud companies, broadband providers, device providers, resellers, sales agents and facilities-based providers using their own networks as well as those leasing parts of our network. Technological advances and regulatory and legislative changes have increased opportunities for a wide range of alternative communications service providers, which in turn have increased competitive pressures on our business. These alternate providers often face fewer regulations and have lower cost structures than we do. In addition, the communications industry has, in recent years, experienced substantial consolidation, and some of our competitors in one or more lines of our business are generally larger, have stronger brand names, have more financial and business resources and have broader service offerings than we currently do.

 

Wireless telephone services are a significant source of competition with our legacy carrier services. It is increasingly common for customers to completely forego use of traditional wireline phone service and instead rely solely on wireless service for voice services. We anticipate this trend will continue, particularly as our older customers are replaced over time with younger customers who are less accustomed to using traditional wireline voice services. Technological and regulatory developments in wireless services, Wi-Fi, and other wired and wireless technologies have contributed to the development of alternatives to traditional landline voice services. Moreover, the growing prevalence of electronic mail, text messaging, social networking and similar digital non-voice communications services continues to reduce the demand for traditional landline voice services. These factors have led to a long-term systemic decline in the number of our wireline voice service customers.

 

The Telecommunications Act of 1996, which obligates carriers to permit competitors to interconnect their facilities to the carrier's network and to take various other steps that are designed to promote competition, imposes several duties on a carrier if it receives a specific request from another entity which seeks to connect with or provide services using the carrier's network. In addition, each carrier is obligated to (i) negotiate interconnection agreements in good faith, (ii) provide nondiscriminatory "unbundled" access to all aspects of the carrier's network, (iii) offer resale of its telecommunications services at wholesale rates and (iv) permit competitors, on terms and conditions (including rates) that are just, reasonable and nondiscriminatory, to colocate their physical plant on the carrier's property, or provide virtual colocation if physical colocation is not practicable. Current FCC rules require carriers to lease a network element only in those situations where competing carriers genuinely would be impaired without access to such network elements, and where the unbundling would not interfere with the development of facilities-based competition.

 

As a result of these regulatory, consumer and technological developments, carriers also face competition from competitive local exchange carriers, or CLECs, particularly in densely populated areas. CLECs provide competing services through reselling a carrier’s local services, through use of a carrier's unbundled network elements or through their own facilities.

 

Technological developments have led to the development of new products and services that have reduced the demand for our traditional services, as noted above, or that compete with traditional carrier services. Technological improvements have enabled cable television companies to provide traditional circuit-switched telephone service over their cable networks, and several national cable companies have aggressively marketed these services. Similarly, companies providing VoIP services provide voice communication services over the Internet which compete with our traditional telephone service and our own VoIP services. In addition, demand for our broadband services could be adversely affected by advanced wireless data transmission technologies being deployed by wireless providers and by certain technologies permitting cable companies and other competitors to deliver faster average broadband transmission speeds than ours.

 

 
27

Table of Contants

 

Similar to us, many cable, technology or other communications companies that previously offered a limited range of services are now offering diversified bundles of services, either through their own networks, reselling arrangements or joint ventures. As such, a growing number of companies are competing to serve the communications needs of the same customer base.  Such activities will continue to place downward pressure on the demand for and pricing of our services.

 

As customers increasingly demand high-speed connections for entertainment, communications and productivity, we expect the demands on our network will continue to increase over the next several years. To succeed, we must continue to invest in our networks or engage partners to ensure that they can deliver competitive services that meet these increasing bandwidth and speed requirements. In addition, network reliability and security are increasingly important competitive factors in our business.

 

Additional information about competitive pressures is located under the heading “Risk Factors.”

 

Competitors

 

In connection with providing strategic services to our business customers, which includes our small, medium and enterprise business, wholesale and governmental customers, we compete against other telecommunication providers, as well as other regional and national carriers, other data transport providers, cable companies, CLECs and other enterprises, some of whom are substantially larger than us. Competition is based on price, bandwidth, quality and speed of service, promotions and bundled offerings. In providing broadband services, we compete primarily with cable companies, wireless providers, technology companies and other broadband service providers. We face competition in Ethernet based services in the wholesale market from cable companies and fiber-based providers.  In regards to our medical division, we compete with other medical testing facilities and other companies developing SaaS technologies to test and monitor medical testing activities.

 

Our competitors for providing integrated data, broadband, voice services and other data and SaaS services to our business customers range from small to mid-sized businesses. Due to the size of some of these companies, our competitors may be able to offer more inexpensive solutions to our customers. To compete, we focus on providing sophisticated, secure and performance-driven services to our business customers through our infrastructure.

 

The number of companies providing business services has grown and increased competition for these services, particularly with respect to smaller business customers. Many of our competitors for strategic services are not subject to the same regulatory requirements as we are and therefore, they are able to avoid significant regulatory costs and obligations.

 

Government Regulation

 

Overview

 

As discussed further below, our operations are subject to significant local, state, federal and foreign laws and regulations.

 

We are subject to the significant regulations by the FCC, which regulates interstate communications, and state utility commissions, which regulate intrastate communications. These agencies (i) issue rules to protect consumers and promote competition, (ii) set the rates that telecommunication companies charge each other for exchanging traffic, and (iii) have traditionally developed and administered support programs designed to subsidize the provision of services to high-cost rural areas. In most states, local voice service, switched and special access services and interconnection services are subject to price regulation, although the extent of regulation varies by type of service and geographic region. In addition, we are required to maintain licenses with the FCC and with state utility commissions. Laws and regulations in many states restrict the manner in which a licensed entity can interact with affiliates, transfer assets, issue debt and engage in other business activities. Many acquisitions and divestitures may require approval by the FCC and some state commissions. These agencies typically have the authority to withhold their approval, or to request or impose substantial conditions upon the transacting parties in connection with granting their approvals.

 

The following description discusses some of the major industry regulations that may affect our traditional operations, but numerous other regulations not discussed below could also impact us. Some legislation and regulations are currently the subject of judicial, legislative and administrative proceedings which could substantially change the manner in which the telecommunications industry operates and the amount of revenues we receive for our services.

 

Neither the outcome of these proceedings, nor their potential impact on us, can be predicted at this time. For additional information, see "Risk Factors."

 

The laws and regulations governing our affairs are quite complex and occasionally in conflict with each other. From time to time, we are fined for failing to meet applicable regulations or service requirements.

 

 
28

Table of Contants

 

Federal Regulation

 

General

 

We are required to comply with the Communications Act of 1934. Among other things, this law requires our local exchange carriers to offer various of our legacy services at just and reasonable rates and on non-discriminatory terms. The Telecommunications Act of 1996 materially amended the Communications Act of 1934, primarily to promote competition.

 

The FCC regulates interstate services we provide, including the special access charges we bill for wholesale network transmission and the interstate access charges that we bill to long-distance companies and other communications companies in connection with the origination and termination of interstate phone calls. Additionally, the FCC regulates a number of aspects of our business related to privacy, homeland security and network infrastructure, including our access to and use of local telephone numbers and our provision of emergency 911 services. The FCC has responsibility for maintaining and administering support programs designed to expand nationwide access to communications services (which are described further below), as well as other programs supporting service to low-income households, schools and libraries, and rural health care providers. Changes in the composition of the five members of the FCC or its Chairman can have significant impacts on the regulation of our business.

 

In recent years, our operations and those of other telecommunications carriers have been further impacted by legislation and regulation imposing additional obligations on us, particularly with regards to providing voice and broadband service, bolstering homeland security, increasing disaster recovery requirements, minimizing environmental impacts and enhancing privacy. These laws include the Communications Assistance for Law Enforcement Act, and laws governing local telephone number portability and customer proprietary network information requirements. In addition, the FCC has heightened its focus on the reliability of emergency 911 services. The FCC has imposed fines on us and other companies for 911 outages and has adopted new compliance requirements for providing 911 service. We are incurring capital and operating expenses designed to comply with the FCC's new requirements and minimize future outages. All of these laws and regulations may cause us to incur additional costs and could impact our ability to compete effectively against companies not subject to the same regulations.

 

Over the past several years, the FCC has taken various actions and initiated certain proceedings designed to comprehensively evaluate the proper regulation of the provisions of data services to businesses. As part of its evaluation, the FCC has reviewed the rates, terms and conditions under which these services are provided. The FCC's proceedings remain pending, and their ultimate impact on us is currently unknown.

 

We are also regulated for our medical services activities. See discussion below.

 

Telephony Services

 

We operate traditional telecommunications services in our Arizona subsidiary, and those services are largely governed under rules established for CLECs under the Communications Act. The Communications Act entitles our CLEC subsidiary to certain rights, but as telecommunications carriers, it also subjects them to regulation by the FCC and the states. Their designation as telecommunications carriers also results in other regulations that may affect them and the services they offer.

 

Interconnection and Intercarrier Compensation 

 

The Communications Act requires telecommunications carriers to interconnect directly or indirectly with other telecommunications carriers. Under the FCC's intercarrier compensation rules, we are entitled, in some cases, to compensation from carriers when they use our network to terminate or originate calls and in other cases are required to compensate another carrier for using its network to originate or terminate traffic. The FCC and state regulatory commissions, including those in the states in which we operate, have adopted limits on the amounts of compensation that may be charged for certain types of traffic. As noted above, the FCC has determined that intercarrier compensation for all terminating traffic will be phased down over several years to a "bill-and-keep" regime, with no compensation between carriers for most terminating traffic by 2018 and is considering further reform that could reduce or eliminate compensation for originating traffic as well.

 

Universal Service

 

Our CLEC subsidiary is required to contribute to the Universal Service Fund (“USF”). The amount of universal service contribution required of us is based on a percentage of revenues earned from interstate and international services provided to end users. We allocate our end user revenues and remit payments to the universal service fund in accordance with FCC rules. The FCC has ruled that states may impose state universal service fees on CLEC telecommunications services.

 

 
29

Table of Contants

 

State Regulation

 

Our CLEC subsidiary telecommunications services are subject to regulation by state commissions in each state where we provide services. In order to provide our services, we must seek approval from the state regulatory commission or be registered to provide services in each state where we operate and may at times require local approval to construct facilities. Regulatory obligations vary from state to state and include some or all of the following requirements: filing tariffs (rates, terms and conditions); filing operational, financial, and customer service reports; seeking approval to transfer the assets or capital stock of the broadband communications company; seeking approval to issue stocks, bonds and other forms of indebtedness of the broadband communications company; reporting customer service and quality of service requirements; outage reporting; making contributions to state universal service support programs; paying regulatory and state Telecommunications Relay Service and E911 fees; geographic build-out; and other matters relating to competition.

 

Other Regulations 

 

Our CLEC subsidiary telecommunications services are subject to other FCC requirements, including protecting the use and disclosure of customer proprietary network information; meeting certain notice requirements in the event of service termination; compliance with disabilities access requirements; compliance with CALEA standards; outage reporting; and the payment of fees to fund local number portability administration and the North American Numbering Plan. As noted above, the FCC and states are examining whether new requirements are necessary to improve the resiliency of communications networks. Communications with our customers are also subject to FCC, FTC and state regulations on telemarketing and the sending of unsolicited commercial e-mail and fax messages, as well as additional privacy and data security requirements.

 

Broadband

 

Regulatory Classification.    Broadband Internet access services were traditionally classified by the FCC as "information services" for regulatory purposes, a type of service that is subject to a lesser degree of regulation than "telecommunications services." In 2015, the FCC reversed this determination and classified broadband Internet access services as "telecommunications services." This reclassification has subjected our broadband Internet access service to greater regulation, although the FCC did not apply all telecommunications service obligations to broadband Internet access service. The 2015 Order could have a material adverse impact on our business as it may justify additional FCC regulation or support efforts by States to justify additional regulation of broadband Internet access services. In December 2017, the FCC adopted an order that in large part reverses the 2015 Order and reestablishes the "information service" classification for broadband Internet access service. The 2017 Order has not yet gone into effect, however, and the 2015 Order will remain binding until the 2017 Order takes effect. The 2017 Order is expected to be subject to legal challenge that may delay its effect or overturn it.

 

Net Neutrality, and Current Status. The 2015 Order also established a new "Open Internet" framework that expanded disclosure requirements on Internet service providers ("ISPs") such as cable companies, prohibited blocking, throttling, and paid prioritization of Internet traffic on the basis of the content, and imposed a "general conduct standard" that prohibits unreasonable interference with the ability of end users and edge providers to reach each other. The FCC's 2017 Order eliminates these rules except for certain disclosure requirements (see the official release summary from the FCC below). Additionally, Congress and some states are considering legislation that may codify "network neutrality" rules.

 

The Federal Communications Commission has made the following official release about the Restoring Internet Freedom Order:

 

"The FCC's Restoring Internet Freedom Order, which took effect on June 11, (2018) provides a framework for protecting an open Internet while paving the way for better, faster and cheaper Internet access for consumers. It replaces unnecessary, heavy-handed regulations that were developed way back in 1934 with strong consumer protections, increased transparency, and common-sense rules that will promote investment and broadband deployment. The FCC's framework for protecting Internet freedom has the following key parts:

 

1. Consumer Protection

 

The Federal Trade Commission will police and take action against Internet service providers for anticompetitive acts or unfair and deceptive practices. The FTC is the nation's premier consumer protection agency, and until the FCC stripped it of jurisdiction over Internet service providers in 2015, the FTC protected consumers consistently across the Internet economy.

 

2. Transparency

 

A critical part of Internet openness involves Internet service providers being transparent about their business practices. That's why the FCC has imposed enhanced transparency requirements. Internet service providers must publicly disclose information regarding their network management practices, performance, and commercial terms of service. These disclosures must be made via a publicly available, easily accessible company website or through the FCC's website. This will discourage harmful practices and help regulators target any problematic conduct. These disclosures also support innovation, investment, and competition by ensuring that entrepreneurs and other small businesses have the technical information necessary to create and maintain online content, applications, services, and devices.

 

 
30

Table of Contants

 

Internet Service Providers must clearly disclose their network management practices on their own web sites or with the FCC. For more information about these disclosures, you can visit https://www.fcc.gov/isp- disclosures.

 

Removes Unnecessary Regulations to Promote Broadband Investment 

 

The Internet wasn't broken in 2015, when the previous FCC imposed 1930s-era regulations (known as "Title II") on Internet service providers. And ironically, these regulations made things worse by limiting investment in high-speed networks and slowing broadband deployment. Under Title II, broadband network investment dropped more than 5.6% -- the first time a decline has happened outside of a recession. The effect was particularly serious for smaller Internet service providers (fixed wireless companies, small-town cable operators, municipal broadband providers, electric cooperatives, and others) that don't have the resources or lawyers to navigate a thicket of complex rules...."

 

The items listed in this internet Order are for carriers such as Century Link, which is our contract internet provider, and we are in compliance with the areas that we are responsible for which are few. We generate the last mile of internet service, but we are actually a reseller of Century Link services as they provide the bandwidth to us.

 

Access for Persons with Disabilities. The FCC's rules require us to ensure that persons with disabilities have access to "advanced communications services" ("ACS"), such as electronic messaging and interoperable video conferencing. They also require that certain pay television programming delivered via Internet Protocol include closed captioning and require entities distributing such programming to end users to pass through such captions and identify programming that should be captioned.

 

Other Regulation. The 2015 Order also subjected broadband providers' Internet traffic exchange rates and practices to potential FCC oversight and created a mechanism for third parties to file complaints regarding these matters. In addition, our provision of Internet services also subjects us to the limitations on use and disclosure of user communications and records contained in the Electronic Communications Privacy Act of 1986. Broadband Internet access service is also subject to other federal and state privacy laws applicable to electronic communications.

 

Additionally, providers of broadband Internet access services must comply with CALEA, which requires providers to make their services and facilities accessible for law enforcement intercept requests. Various other federal and state laws apply to providers of services that are accessible through broadband Internet access service, including copyright laws, telemarketing laws, prohibitions on obscenity, and a ban on unsolicited commercial e-mail, and privacy and data security laws. Online content we provide is also subject to some of these laws.

 

Other forms of regulation of broadband Internet access service currently being considered by the FCC, Congress or state legislatures include consumer protection requirements, cyber security requirements, consumer service standards, requirements to contribute to universal service programs and requirements to protect personally identifiable customer data from theft. Pending and future legislation in this area could adversely affect our operations as an Internet service provider and our relationship with our Internet customers.

 

Additionally, from time to time the FCC and Congress have considered whether to subject broadband Internet access services to the federal Universal Service Fund ("USF") contribution requirements. Any contribution requirements adopted for Internet access services would impose significant new costs on our broadband Internet service. At the same time, the FCC is changing the manner in which Universal Service funds are distributed. By focusing on broadband and wireless deployment, rather than traditional telephone service, the changes could assist some of our competitors in more effectively competing with our service offerings.

 

VoIP Services

 

We provide telephony services using VoIP technology ("interconnected VoIP"). The FCC has adopted several regulations for interconnected VoIP services, as have several states, especially as it relates to core customer and safety issues such as e911, local number portability, disability access, outage reporting, universal service contributions, and regulatory reporting requirements. The FCC has not, however, formally classified interconnected VoIP services as either information services or telecommunications services. In this vacuum, some states have asserted more expansive rights to regulate interconnected VoIP services, while others have adopted laws that bar the state commission from regulating VoIP service.

 

 
31

Table of Contants

 

Universal Service. Interconnected VoIP services must contribute to the USF used to subsidize communication services provided to low income households, to customers in rural and high cost areas, and to schools, libraries, and rural health care providers. The amount of universal service contribution required of interconnected VoIP service providers is based on a percentage of revenues earned from interstate and international services provided to end users. We allocate our end user revenues and remit payments to the universal service fund in accordance with FCC rules. The FCC has ruled that states may impose state universal service fees on interconnected VoIP providers.

 

Local Number Portability. The FCC requires interconnected VoIP service providers and their "numbering partners" to ensure that their customers have the ability to port their telephone numbers when changing providers. We also contribute to federal funds to meet the shared costs of local number portability and the costs of North American Numbering Plan Administration.

 

Intercarrier Compensation. In an October 2011 reform order and subsequent clarifying orders, the FCC revised the regime governing payments among providers of telephony services for the exchange of calls between and among different networks ("intercarrier compensation") to, among other things, explicitly include interconnected VoIP. In that Order, the FCC determined that intercarrier compensation for all terminating traffic, including VoIP traffic exchanged in TDM format, will be phased down over several years to a "bill-and-keep" regime, with no compensation between carriers for most terminating traffic by 2018. The FCC is considering further reform in this area, which could reduce or eliminate compensation for originating traffic as well.

 

Other Regulation. Interconnected VoIP service providers are required to provide enhanced 911 emergency services to their customers; protect customer proprietary network information from unauthorized disclosure to third parties; report to the FCC on service outages; comply with telemarketing regulations and other privacy and data security requirements; comply with disabilities access requirements and service discontinuance obligations; comply with call signaling requirements; and comply with CALEA standards. In August 2015, the FCC adopted new rules to improve the resiliency of the communications network. Under the new rules, providers of telephony services, including interconnected VoIP service providers, must make available eight hours of standby backup power for consumers to purchase at the point of sale. The rules also require that providers inform new and current customers about service limitations during power outages and steps that consumers can take to address those risks.

 

Medical Division

 

The Center for Medicare & Medicaid Services (“CMS”) regulates all of our mobile laboratory testing activities performed on humans in the United States through Clinical Laboratory Improvement Amendments (‘CLIA’) which covers approximately 260,000 laboratory entities. We obtain CLIA licenses where necessary to operate our mobile laboratories. We also hire staffing agencies that work the health care industry with the appropriate health care workers to operate the mobile laboratories, which agencies and workers are regulated by state and local agencies like the agency for Health Care Administration in Florida (“AHCA”). Each state and local jurisdiction has their own agency or regulatory organization that we follow and adhere to their laws and guidelines in relation operating our mobile testing facilities.

 

For additional information about these matters, see “Risk Factors.”

 

LICENSES

 

Arizona CLEC license in Phoenix area. License #20090393 which expires 2023 and is renewable every seven years.

 

TITLE TO PROPERTIES

 

None.

 

BACKLOG OF ORDERS

 

We currently have no backlogs of orders for sales, at this time.

 

GOVERNMENT CONTRACTS

 

We have no government contracts.

 

COMPANY SPONSORED RESEARCH AND DEVELOPMENT

 

We are not conducting any research.

 

 
32

Table of Contants

 

NUMBER OF PERSONS EMPLOYED

 

We have approximately 50 employees who work approximately 45 hours per week. All officers work approximately 60 hours per week. Directors work as needed.

 

DESCRIPTION OF PROPERTY

 

DESCRIPTION OF PROPERTIES/ASSETS

 

(a)

Real Estate.

None.

(b)

Title to properties.

None.

(c)

Patents, Trade Names, Trademarks and Copyrights

See below.

 

Our executive offices are located in San Diego, California. We do not own any real property, but lease and office space consisting of approximately 5,000 sq. ft. among all of our corporate and subsidiary locations. We believe that substantially all of our property and equipment is in good condition, subject to normal wear and tear, and that our facilities have sufficient capacity to meet the current needs of our business.

 

PATENTS, TRADE NAMES, TRADEMARKS AND COPYRIGHTS

 

Either directly or through our subsidiaries, we have rights in various patents, trade names, trademarks, copyrights and other intellectual property necessary to conduct our business. Our services often use the intellectual property of others, including licensed software. We also occasionally license our intellectual property to others as we deem appropriate.

 

We periodically receive offers from third parties to purchase or obtain licenses for patents and other intellectual property rights in exchange for royalties or other payments. We also periodically receive notices, or are named in lawsuits, alleging that our products or services infringe on patents or other intellectual property rights of third parties. In certain instances, these matters can potentially adversely impact our operations, operating results or financial position. For additional information, see “Risk Factors”.

 

ITEM 1A. RISK FACTORS.

 

FORWARD LOOKING STATEMENTS

 

THIS DOCUMENT INCLUDES FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS, INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, STATEMENTS RELATING TO TPT GLOBAL’S PLANS, STRATEGIES, OBJECTIVES, EXPECTATIONS, INTENTIONS AND ADEQUACY OF RESOURCES. THESE FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS INVOLVE KNOWN AND UNKNOWN RISKS, UNCERTAINTIES, AND OTHER FACTORS THAT MAY CAUSE OUR COMPANY’S ACTUAL RESULTS, PERFORMANCE OR ACHIEVEMENTS TO BE MATERIALLY DIFFERENT FROM ANY FUTURE RESULTS, PERFORMANCE OR ACHIEVEMENTS EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED BY THE FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS. THESE FACTORS INCLUDE, AMONG OTHERS, THE FOLLOWING: OUR ABILITY OF TO IMPLEMENT OUR BUSINESS STRATEGY; ABILITY TO OBTAIN ADDITIONAL FINANCING; TPT GLOBAL’S LIMITED OPERATING HISTORY; UNKNOWN LIABILITIES ASSOCIATED WITH FUTURE ACQUISITIONS; ABILITY TO MANAGE GROWTH; SIGNIFICANT COMPETITION; ABILITY TO ATTRACT AND RETAIN TALENTED EMPLOYEES; AND FUTURE GOVERNMENT REGULATIONS; AND OTHER FACTORS DESCRIBED IN THIS FILING OR IN OTHER OF TPT GLOBAL’S FILINGS WITH THE SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION. TPT GLOBAL IS UNDER NO OBLIGATION TO PUBLICLY UPDATE OR REVISE ANY FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS, WHETHER AS A RESULT OF NEW INFORMATION, FUTURE EVENTS OR OTHERWISE. 

 

RISK FACTORS RELATED TO OUR BUSINESS

 

Many of our competitors are better established and have resources significantly greater than we have, which may make it difficult to attract and retain subscribers.

 

We will compete with other providers of telephony service, many of which have substantially greater financial, technical and marketing resources, larger customer bases, longer operating histories, greater name recognition and more established relationships in the industry. In addition, a number of these competitors may combine or form strategic partnerships. As a result, our competitors may be able to offer, or bring to market earlier, products and services that are superior to our own in terms of features, quality, pricing or other factors. Our failure to compete successfully with any of these companies would have a material adverse effect on our business and the trading price of our common stock.

 

 
33

Table of Contants

 

The market for broadband and VoIP services is highly competitive, and we compete with several other companies within a single market:

 

 

·

cable operators offering high-speed Internet connectivity services and voice communications;

 

·

incumbent and competitive local exchange carriers providing DSL services over their existing wide, metropolitan and local area networks;

 

·

3G cellular, PCS and other wireless providers offering wireless broadband services and capabilities, including developments in existing cellular and PCS technology that may increase network speeds or have other advantages over our services;

 

·

internet service providers offering dial-up Internet connectivity;

 

·

municipalities and other entities operating free or subsidized WiFi networks;

 

·

providers of VoIP telephony services;

 

·

wireless Internet service providers using licensed or unlicensed spectrum;

 

·

satellite and fixed wireless service providers offering or developing broadband Internet connectivity and VoIP telephony;

 

·

electric utilities and other providers offering or planning to offer broadband Internet connectivity over power lines; and

 

·

resellers providing wireless Internet service by “piggy-backing” on DSL or WiFi networks operated by others.

 

Moreover, we expect other existing and prospective competitors, particularly if our services are successful; to adopt technologies or business plans similar to ours or seek other means to develop a product competitive with our services. Many of our competitors are well-established and have larger and better developed networks and systems, longer-standing relationships with customers and suppliers, greater name recognition and greater financial, technical and marketing resources than we have. These competitors can often subsidize competing services with revenues from other sources, such as advertising, and thus may offer their products and services at lower prices than ours. These or other competitors may also reduce the prices of their services significantly or may offer broadband connectivity packaged with other products or services. We may not be able to reduce our prices or otherwise alter our services correspondingly, which would make it more difficult to attract and retain subscribers.

 

Our Acquisitions could result in operating difficulties, dilution and distractions from our core business.

 

We have evaluated, and expect to continue to evaluate, potential strategic transactions, including larger acquisitions. The process of acquiring and integrating a company, business or technology is risky, may require a disproportionate amount of our management or financial resources and may create unforeseen operating difficulties or expenditures, including:

 

 

·

difficulties in integrating acquired technologies and operations into our business while maintaining uniform standards, controls, policies and procedures;

 

·

increasing cost and complexity of assuring the implementation and maintenance of adequate internal control and disclosure controls and procedures, and of obtaining the reports and attestations that are required of a company filing reports under the Securities Exchange Act;

 

·

difficulties in consolidating and preparing our financial statements due to poor accounting records, weak financial controls and, in some cases, procedures at acquired entities based on accounting principles not generally accepted in the United States, particularly those entities in which we lack control; and

 

·

the inability to predict or anticipate market developments and capital commitments relating to the acquired company, business or technology.

 

Acquisitions of and joint ventures with companies organized outside the United States often involve additional risks, including:

 

 

·

difficulties, as a result of distance, language or culture differences, in developing, staffing and managing foreign operations;

 

·

lack of control over our joint ventures and other business relationships;

 

·

currency exchange rate fluctuations;

 

·

longer payment cycles;

 

·

credit risk and higher levels of payment fraud;

 

·

foreign exchange controls that might limit our control over, or prevent us from repatriating, cash generated outside the United States;

 

·

potentially adverse tax consequences;

 

·

expropriation or nationalization of assets;

 

·

differences in regulatory requirements that may make it difficult to offer all of our services;

 

·

unexpected changes in regulatory requirements;

 

·

trade barriers and import and export restrictions; and

 

·

political or social unrest and economic instability.

 

 
34

Table of Contants

 

The anticipated benefit of any of our acquisitions or investments may never materialize. Future investments, acquisitions or dispositions could result in potentially dilutive issuances of our equity securities, the incurrence of debt, contingent liabilities or amortization expenses, or write-offs of goodwill, any of which could harm our financial condition. Future investments and acquisitions may require us to obtain additional equity or debt financing, which may not be available on favorable terms, or at all.

 

Our substantial indebtedness and our current default status and any restrictive debt covenants could limit our financing options and liquidity position and may limit our ability to grow our business.

 

Our indebtedness could have important consequences to the holders of our common stock, such as:

 

 

·

we may not be able to obtain additional financing to fund working capital, operating losses, capital expenditures or acquisitions on terms acceptable to us or at all;

 

·

we may be unable to refinance our indebtedness on terms acceptable to us or at all;

 

·

if substantial indebtedness continues it could make us more vulnerable to economic downturns and limit our ability to withstand competitive pressures; and

 

·

cash flows from operations are currently negative and may continue to be so, and our remaining cash, if any, may be insufficient to operate our business.

 

·

paying dividends to our stockholders;

 

·

incurring, or cause certain of our subsidiaries to incur, additional indebtedness;

 

·

permitting liens on or conduct sales of any assets pledged as collateral;

 

·

selling all or substantially all of our assets or consolidate or merge with or into other companies;

 

·

repaying existing indebtedness; and

 

·

engaging in transactions with affiliates.

 

As of December 31, 2021, the total debt or financing arrangements was $14,273,225, of which approximately $7,237,128 or 21% of total current liabilities is past due.  As of December 31, 2021, the Company had financing lease liability-related amounts of $966,759. During the fourth quarter of 2020, the related party holders of approximately $4,700,000 of existing financing arrangements agreed to exchange their debt and accrued interest for Series D Preferred Stock through a separate $12 Million Private Placement, conditioned on the Company raising at least $12,000,000 in a separate Form 1-A Offering.  Our inability to renegotiate our indebtedness may cause lien holders to obtain possession of a good portion of our assets which would significantly alter our ability to generate revenues and obtain any additional financing.

 

We may experience difficulties in constructing, upgrading and maintaining our network, which could adversely affect customer satisfaction, increase subscriber turnover and reduce our revenues.

 

Our success depends on developing and providing products and services that give subscribers a high-quality internet connectivity and VoIP experience. If the number of subscribers using our network and the complexity of our products and services increase, we will require more infrastructure and network resources to maintain the quality of our services. Consequently, we expect to make substantial investments to construct and improve our facilities and equipment and to upgrade our technology and network infrastructure. If we do not implement these developments successfully, or if we experience inefficiencies, operational failures or unforeseen costs during implementation, the quality of our products and services could decline.

 

We may experience quality deficiencies, cost overruns and delays on construction, maintenance and upgrade projects, including the portions of those projects not within our control or the control of our contractors. The construction of our network requires the receipt of permits and approvals from numerous governmental bodies, including municipalities and zoning boards. Such bodies often limit the expansion of transmission towers and other construction necessary for our business. Failure to receive approvals in a timely fashion can delay system rollouts and raise the cost of completing construction projects. In addition, we typically are required to obtain rights from land, building and tower owners to install our antennas and other equipment to provide service to our subscribers. We may not be able to obtain, on terms acceptable to us, or at all, the rights necessary to construct our network and expand our services.

 

We also face challenges in managing and operating our network. These challenges include operating, maintaining and upgrading network and customer premises equipment to accommodate increased traffic or technological advances, and managing the sales, advertising, customer support, billing and collection functions of our business while providing reliable network service at expected speeds and VoIP telephony at expected levels of quality. Our failure in any of these areas could adversely affect customer satisfaction, increase subscriber turnover, increase our costs, decrease our revenues and otherwise have a material adverse effect on our business, prospects, financial condition and results of operations.

 

 
35

Table of Contants

 

If we do not obtain and maintain rights to use licensed spectrum in one or more markets, we may be unable to operate in these markets, which could adversely affect our ability to execute our business strategy.

 

Even though we have established license agreements, growth requires that we plan to provide our services obtaining additional licensed spectrum both in the United States and internationally, we depend on our ability to acquire and maintain sufficient rights to use licensed spectrum by obtaining our own licenses or long-term spectrum leases, in each of the markets in which we operate or intend to operate. Licensing is the short-term solution to obtaining the necessary spectrum as building out spectrum is a long and difficult process that can be costly and require a disproportionate amount of our management resources. We may not be able to acquire, lease or maintain the spectrum necessary to execute our business strategy.       

 

Using licensed spectrum, whether owned or leased, poses additional risks to us, including:

 

 

·

inability to satisfy build-out or service deployment requirements upon which our spectrum licenses or leases are, or may be, conditioned;

 

·

increases in spectrum acquisition costs;

 

·

adverse changes to regulations governing our spectrum rights;

 

·

the risk that spectrum we have acquired or leased will not be commercially usable or free of harmful interference from licensed or unlicensed operators in our or adjacent bands;

 

·

with respect to spectrum we will lease in the United States, contractual disputes with or the bankruptcy or other reorganization of the license holders, which could adversely affect our control over the spectrum subject to such license;

 

·

failure of the FCC or other regulators to renew our spectrum licenses as they expire; and

 

·

invalidation of our authorization to use all or a significant portion of our spectrum, resulting in, among other things, impairment charges related to assets recorded for such spectrum.

 

If we fail to establish and maintain an effective system of internal control, we may not be able to report our financial results accurately or to prevent fraud. Any inability to report and file our financial results accurately and timely could harm our business and adversely impact the trading price of our common stock.

 

Effective internal control is necessary for us to provide reliable financial reports and prevent fraud. If we cannot provide reliable financial reports or prevent fraud, we may not be able to manage our business as effectively as we would if an effective control environment existed, and our business, brand and reputation with investors may be harmed.

 

In addition, reporting a material weakness may negatively impact investors’ perception of us. We have allocated, and will continue to allocate, significant additional resources to remedy any deficiencies in our internal control. There can be no assurances that our remedial measures will be successful in curing the any material weakness or that other significant deficiencies or material weaknesses will not arise in the future.

 

Interruption or failure of our information technology and communications systems could impair our ability to provide our products and services, which could damage our reputation and harm our operating results.

 

We have experienced service interruptions in some markets in the past and may experience service interruptions or system failures in the future. Any unscheduled service interruption adversely affects our ability to operate our business and could result in an immediate loss of revenues. If we experience frequent or persistent system or network failures, our reputation and brand could be permanently harmed. We may make significant capital expenditures to increase the reliability of our systems, but these capital expenditures may not achieve the results we expect.

 

Our products and services depend on the continuing operation of our information technology and communications systems. Any damage to or failure of our systems could result in interruptions in our service. Interruptions in our service could reduce our revenues and profits, and our brand could be damaged if people believe our network is unreliable. Our systems are vulnerable to damage or interruption from earthquakes, terrorist attacks, floods, fires, power loss, telecommunications failures, computer viruses, computer denial of service attacks or other attempts to harm our systems, and similar events. Some of our systems are not fully redundant, and our disaster recovery planning may not be adequate. The occurrence of a natural disaster or unanticipated problems at our network centers could result in lengthy interruptions in our service and adversely affect our operating results.

 

 
36

Table of Contants

 

The industries in which we operate are continually evolving, which makes it difficult to evaluate our future prospects and increases the risk of your investment. Our products and services may become obsolete, and we may not be able to develop competitive products or services on a timely basis or at all.

 

The markets in which we and our customers compete are characterized by rapidly changing technology, evolving industry standards and communications protocols, and continuous improvements in products and services. Our future success depends on our ability to enhance current products and to develop and introduce in a timely manner new products that keep pace with technological developments, industry standards and communications protocols, compete effectively on the basis of price, performance and quality, adequately address end-user customer requirements and achieve market acceptance. There can be no assurance that the deployment of wireless networks will not be delayed or that our products will achieve widespread market acceptance or be capable of providing service at competitive prices in sufficient volumes. In the event that our products are not timely and economically developed or do not gain widespread market acceptance, our business, results of operations and financial condition would be materially adversely affected. There can also be no assurance that our products will not be rendered obsolete by the introduction and acceptance of new communications protocols.

 

The broadband services industry is characterized by rapid technological change, competitive pricing, frequent new service introductions and evolving industry standards and regulatory requirements. We believe that our success depends on our ability to anticipate and adapt to these challenges and to offer competitive services on a timely basis. We face a number of difficulties and uncertainties associated with our reliance on technological development, such as:

 

 

·

competition from service providers using more traditional and commercially proven means to deliver similar or alternative services;

 

·

competition from new service providers using more efficient, less expensive technologies, including products not yet invented or developed;

 

·

uncertain consumer acceptance;

 

·

realizing economies of scale;

 

·

responding successfully to advances in competing technologies in a timely and cost-effective manner;

 

·

migration toward standards-based technology, requiring substantial capital expenditures; and

 

·

existing, proposed or undeveloped technologies that may render our wireless broadband and VoIP telephony services less profitable or obsolete.

 

As the products and services offered by us and our competitors develop, businesses and consumers may not accept our services as a commercially viable alternative to other means of delivering wireless broadband and VoIP telephony services.

 

If we are unable to successfully develop and market additional services and/or new generations of our services offerings or market our services and product offerings to a broad number of customers, we may not remain competitive.

 

Our future success and our ability to increase net revenue and earnings depend, in part, on our ability to develop and market new additional services and/or new generations of our current services offerings and market our existing services offerings to a broad number of customers. However, we may not be able to, among other things:

 

 

·

successfully develop or market new services or product offerings or enhance existing services offerings;

 

·

educate third-party sales organizations adequately for them to promote and sell our services offerings;

 

·

develop, market and distribute existing and future services offerings in a cost-effective manner; or

 

·

operate the facilities needed to provide our services offerings.

 

If we fail to develop new service offerings, or if we incur unexpected expenses or delays in product development or integration, we may lose our competitive position and incur substantial additional expenses or may be required to curtail or terminate all or part of our present planned business operations.

 

 
37

Table of Contants

 

Our failure to do any of the foregoing could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations. In addition, if any of our current or future services offerings contain undetected errors or design defects or do not work as expected for our customers, our ability to market these services offerings could be substantially impeded, resulting in lost sales, potential reputation damage and delays in obtaining market acceptance of these services offerings. We cannot assure you that we will continue to successfully develop and market new or enhanced applications for our services offerings. If we do not continue to expand our services offerings portfolio on a timely basis or if those products and applications do not receive market acceptance, become regulatory restricted, or become obsolete, we will not grow our business as currently expected.

 

We operate in a very competitive environment.

 

There are three types of competitors for our service offerings.

 

 

(1)

The value-added resellers and other vendors of hardware and software for on-site installation do not typically have an offering similar to our cloud-based services. However, they are the primary historic service suppliers to our targeted customers and will actively work to defend their customer base.

 

 

(2)

There are a number of providers offering services, but they typically offer only one or two applications of their choosing instead of our offering which bundles customer’s chosen services.

 

 

(3)

There are a few providers that offer more than two applications from the cloud. However currently, these providers typically offer only those applications they have chosen.

 

Our industry is characterized by rapid change resulting from technological advances and new services offerings. Certain competitors have substantially greater capital resources, larger customer bases, larger sales forces, greater marketing and management resources, larger research and development staffs and larger facilities than our and have more established reputations with our target customers, as well as distribution channels that are entrenched and may be more effective than ours. Competitors may develop and offer technologies and products that are more effective, have better features, are easier to use, are less expensive and/or are more readily accepted by the marketplace than our offerings. Their products could make our technology and service offerings obsolete or noncompetitive. Competitors may also be able to achieve more efficient operations and distribution than ours may be able to and may offer lower prices than we could offer profitably. We may decide to alter or discontinue aspects of our business and may adopt different strategies due to business or competitive factors or factors currently unforeseen, such as the introduction by competitors of new products or services technologies that would make part or all of our service offerings obsolete or uncompetitive.

 

In addition, the industry could experience some consolidation. There is also a risk that larger companies will enter our markets.

 

If we fail to maintain effective relationships with our major vendors, our services offerings and profitability could suffer.

 

We use third party providers for services. In addition, we purchase hardware, software and services from external suppliers. Accordingly, we must maintain effective relationships with our vendor base to source our needs, maintain continuity of supply, and achieve reasonable costs. If we fail to maintain effective relationships with our vendor base, this may adversely affect our ability to deliver the best products and services to our customers and our profitability could suffer.

 

Any failure of the physical or electronic security that resulted in unauthorized parties gaining access to customer data could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

We use commercial data networks to service customers cloud based services and the associated customer data. Any data is subject to the risk of physical or electronic intrusion by unauthorized parties. We have a multi-homed firewalls and Intrusion Detection / Prevention systems to protect against electronic intrusion and two physical security levels in our networks. Our policy is to close all external ports as a default. Robust anti-virus software runs on all client servers. Systems have automated monitoring and alerting for unusual activity. We also have a Security Officer who monitors these systems. We have better security systems and expertise than our clients can afford separately but any failure of these systems could adversely affect our business growth and financial condition.

 

Demand for our service offerings may decrease if new government regulations substantially increase costs, limit delivery or change the use of Internet access and other products on which our service offerings depend.

 

We are dependent on Internet access to deliver our service offerings. If new regulations are imposed that limit the use of the Internet or impose significant taxes on services delivered via the Internet it could change our cost structure and/or affect our business model. The significant changes in regulatory costs or new limitations on Internet use could impact our ability to operate as we anticipate, could damage our reputation with our customers, disrupt our business or result in, among other things, decreased net revenue and increased overhead costs. As a result, any such failure could harm our business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

Our securities, as offered hereby, are highly speculative and should be purchased only by persons who can afford to lose their entire investment in us. Each prospective investor should carefully consider the following risk factors, as well as all other information set forth elsewhere in this prospectus, before purchasing any of the shares of our common stock.

 

 
38

Table of Contants

 

Increasing regulation of our Internet-based products and services could adversely affect our ability to provide new products and services.

 

On February 26, 2015, the FCC adopted a new "network neutrality" or Open Internet order (the "2015 Order") that: (1) reclassified broadband Internet access service as a Title II common carrier service, (2) applied certain existing Title II provisions and associated regulations; (3) forbore from applying a range of other existing Title II provisions and associated regulations, but to varying degrees indicated that this forbearance may be only temporary and (4) issued new rules expanding disclosure requirements and prohibiting blocking, throttling, paid prioritization and unreasonable interference with the ability of end users and edge providers to reach each other. The 2015 Order also subjected broadband providers' Internet traffic exchange rates and practices to potential FCC oversight and created a mechanism for third parties to file complaints regarding these matters. The 2015 Order could limit our ability to efficiently manage our cable systems and respond to operational and competitive challenges. In December 2017, the FCC adopted an order (the "2017 Order") that in large part reverses the 2015 Order. The 2017 Order has not yet gone into effect, however, and the 2015 Order will remain binding until the 2017 Order takes effect. The 2017 Order is expected to be subject to legal challenge that may delay its effect or overturn it. Additionally, Congress and some states are considering legislation that may codify "network neutrality" rules.

 

Offering telephone services may subject us to additional regulatory burdens, causing us to incur additional costs.

 

We offer telephone services over our broadband network and continue to develop and deploy interconnected VoIP services. The FCC has ruled that competitive telephone companies that support VoIP services, such as those that we offer to our customers, are entitled to interconnect with incumbent providers of traditional telecommunications services, which ensures that our VoIP services can operate in the market. However, the scope of these interconnection rights are being reviewed in a current FCC proceeding, which may affect our ability to compete in the provision of telephony services or result in additional costs. It remains unclear precisely to what extent federal and state regulators will subject VoIP services to traditional telephone service regulation. Expanding our offering of these services may require us to obtain certain authorizations, including federal and state licenses. We may not be able to obtain such authorizations in a timely manner, or conditions could be imposed upon such licenses or authorizations that may not be favorable to us. The FCC has already extended certain traditional telecommunications requirements, such as E911 capabilities, Universal Service Fund contribution, Communications Assistance for Law Enforcement Act ("CALEA"), measures to protect Customer Proprietary Network Information, customer privacy, disability access, number porting, battery back-up, network outage reporting, rural call completion reporting and other regulatory requirements to many VoIP providers such as us. If additional telecommunications regulations are applied to our VoIP service, it could cause us to incur additional costs and may otherwise materially adversely impact our operations. In 2011, the FCC released an order significantly changing the rules governing intercarrier compensation for the origination and termination of telephone traffic between interconnected carriers. These rules have resulted in a substantial decrease in interstate compensation payments over a multi-year period. The FCC is currently considering additional reforms that could further reduce interstate compensation payments. Further, although the FCC recently declined to impose additional regulatory burdens on certain point to point transport ("special access") services provided by cable companies, that FCC decision has been appealed by multiple parties. If those appeals are successfully, there could be additional regulatory burdens and additional costs placed on these services.

 

We may engage in acquisitions and other strategic transactions and the integration of such acquisitions and other strategic transactions could materially adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

Our business has grown significantly as a result of acquisitions, including the Acquisitions, which entail numerous risks including:

 

 

·

distraction of our management team in identifying potential acquisition targets, conducting due diligence and negotiating acquisition agreements;

 

 

 

 

·

difficulties in integrating the operations, personnel, products, technologies and systems of acquired businesses;

 

 

 

 

·

difficulties in enhancing our customer support resources to adequately service our existing customers and the customers of acquired businesses;

 

 

 

 

·

the potential loss of key employees or customers of the acquired businesses;

 

 

 

 

·

unanticipated liabilities or contingencies of acquired businesses;

 

 

 

 

·

unbudgeted costs which we may incur in connection with pursuing potential acquisitions which are not consummated;

 

 

 

 

·

failure to achieve projected cost savings or cash flow from acquired businesses, which are based on projections that are inherently uncertain;

 

 

 

 

·

fluctuations in our operating results caused by incurring considerable expenses to acquire and integrate businesses before receiving the anticipated revenues expected to result from the acquisitions; and

 

 

 

 

·

difficulties in obtaining regulatory approvals required to consummate acquisitions.

 

 
39

Table of Contants

 

We also participate in competitive bidding processes, some of which may involve significant cable systems. If we are the winning bidder in any such process involving significant cable systems or we otherwise engage in acquisitions or other strategic transactions in the future, we may incur additional debt, contingent liabilities and amortization expenses, which could materially adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations. We could also issue substantial additional equity which could dilute existing stockholders.

 

If our acquisitions do not result in the anticipated operating efficiencies, are not effectively integrated, or result in costs which exceed our expectations, our business, financial condition and results of operations could be materially adversely affected.

 

Significant unanticipated increases in the use of bandwidth-intensive Internet-based services could increase our costs.

 

The rising popularity of bandwidth-intensive Internet-based services poses risks for our broadband services. Examples of such services include peer-to-peer file sharing services, gaming services and the delivery of video via streaming technology and by download. If heavy usage of bandwidth-intensive broadband services grows beyond our current expectations, we may need to incur more expenses than currently anticipated to expand the bandwidth capacity of our systems or our customers could have a suboptimal experience when using our broadband service. In order to continue to provide quality service at attractive prices, we need the continued flexibility to develop and refine business models that respond to changing consumer uses and demands and to manage bandwidth usage efficiently. Our ability to undertake such actions could be restricted by regulatory and legislative efforts to impose so-called "net neutrality" requirements on broadband communication providers like us that provide broadband services. For more information, see "Regulation—Broadband."

 

We operate in a highly competitive business environment which could materially adversely affect our business, financial condition, results of operations and liquidity.

 

We operate in a highly competitive, consumer-driven industry and we compete against a variety of broadband, pay television and telephony providers and delivery systems, including broadband communications companies, wireless data and telephony providers, satellite-delivered video signals, Internet-delivered video content and broadcast television signals available to residential and business customers in our service areas. Some of our competitors include AT&T and its DirecTV subsidiary, CenturyLink, DISH Network, Frontier and Verizon. In addition, our pay television services compete with all other sources of leisure, news, information and entertainment, including movies, sporting or other live events, radio broadcasts, home-video services, console games, print media and the Internet.

 

In some instances, our competitors have fewer regulatory burdens, easier access to financing, greater resources, greater operating capabilities and efficiencies of scale, stronger brand-name recognition, longstanding relationships with regulatory authorities and customers, more subscribers, more flexibility to offer promotional packages at prices lower than ours and greater access to programming or other services. This competition creates pressure on our pricing and has adversely affected, and may continue to affect, our ability to add and retain customers, which in turn adversely affects our business, financial condition and results of operations. The effects of competition may also adversely affect our liquidity and ability to service our debt. For example, we face intense competition from Verizon and AT&T, which have network infrastructure throughout our service areas. We estimate that competitors are currently able to sell a fiber-based triple play, including broadband, pay television and telephony services, and may expand these and other service offerings to our potential customers.

 

Our competitive risks are heightened by the rapid technological change inherent in our business, evolving consumer preferences and the need to acquire, develop and adopt new technology to differentiate our products and services from those of our competitors, and to meet consumer demand. We may need to anticipate far in advance which technology we should use for the development of new products and services or the enhancement of existing products and services. The failure to accurately anticipate such changes may adversely affect our ability to attract and retain customers, which in turn could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations. Consolidation and cooperation in our industry may allow our competitors to acquire service capabilities or offer products that are not available to us or offer similar products and services at prices lower than ours. For example, Comcast and Charter Communications have agreed to jointly explore operational efficiencies to speed their respective entries into the wireless market, including in the areas of creating common operating platforms and emerging wireless technology platforms. In addition, changes in the regulatory and legislative environments may result in changes to the competitive landscape.

 

In addition, certain of our competitors own directly or are affiliated with companies that own programming content or have exclusive arrangements with content providers that may enable them to obtain lower programming costs or offer exclusive programming that may be attractive to prospective subscribers. For example, DirecTV has exclusive arrangements with the National Football League that give it access to programming we cannot offer. AT&T also has an agreement to acquire Time Warner, which owns a number of cable networks, including TBS, CNN and HBO, as well as Warner Bros. Entertainment, which produces television, film and home-video content. AT&T's and DirecTV's potential access to Time Warner programming could allow AT&T and DirecTV to offer competitive and promotional packages that could negatively affect our ability to maintain or increase our existing customers and revenues. DBS operators such as DISH Network and DirecTV also have marketing arrangements with certain phone companies in which the DBS provider's pay television services are sold together with the phone company's broadband and mobile and traditional phone services.

 

 
40

Table of Contants

 

Most broadband communications companies, which already have wired networks, an existing customer base and other operational functions in place (such as billing and service personnel), offer DSL services. We believe DSL service competes with our broadband service and is often offered at prices lower than our Internet services. However, DSL is often offered at speeds lower than the speeds we offer. In addition, DSL providers may currently be in a better position to offer Internet services to businesses since their networks tend to be more complete in commercial areas. They may also increasingly have the ability to combine video services with telephone and Internet services offered to their customers, particularly as broadband communications companies enter into co-marketing agreements with other service providers. In addition, current and future fixed and wireless Internet services, such as 3G, 4G and 5G fixed and wireless broadband services and Wi-Fi networks, and devices such as wireless data cards, tablets and smartphones, and mobile wireless routers that connect to such devices, may compete with our broadband services.

 

Our telephony services compete directly with established broadband communications companies and other carriers, including wireless providers, as increasing numbers of homes are replacing their traditional telephone service with wireless telephone service. We also compete against VoIP providers like Vonage, Skype, GoogleTalk, Facetime, WhatsApp and magicJack that do not own networks but can provide service to any person with a broadband connection, in some cases free of charge. In addition, we compete against ILECs, other CLECs and long-distance voice-service companies for large commercial and enterprise customers. While we compete with the ILECs, we also enter into interconnection agreements with ILECs so that our customers can make and receive calls to and from customers served by the ILECs and other telecommunications providers. Federal and state law and regulations require ILECs to enter into such agreements and provide facilities and services necessary for connection, at prices subject to regulation. The specific price, terms and conditions of each agreement, however, depend on the outcome of negotiations between us and each ILEC. Interconnection agreements are also subject to approval by the state regulatory commissions, which may arbitrate negotiation impasses. These agreements, like all interconnection agreements, are for limited terms and upon expiration are subject to renegotiation, potential arbitration and approval under the laws in effect at that time.

 

We also face competition for our advertising sales from traditional and non-traditional media outlets, including television and radio stations, traditional print media and the Internet.

 

We face significant risks as a result of rapid changes in technology, consumer expectations and behavior.

 

The broadband communications industry has undergone significant technological development over time and these changes continue to affect our business, financial condition and results of operations. Such changes have had, and will continue to have, a profound impact on consumer expectations and behavior. Our video business faces technological change risks as a result of the continuing development of new and changing methods for delivery of programming content such as Internet-based delivery of movies, shows and other content which can be viewed on televisions, wireless devices and other developing mobile devices. Consumers' video consumption patterns are also evolving, for example, with more content being downloaded for time-shifted consumption. A proliferation of delivery systems for video content can adversely affect our ability to attract and retain subscribers and the demand for our services and it can also decrease advertising demand on our delivery systems. Our broadband business faces technological challenges from rapidly evolving wireless Internet solutions. Our telephony service offerings face technological developments in the proliferation of telephony delivery systems including those based on Internet and wireless delivery. If we do not develop or acquire and successfully implement new technologies, we will limit our ability to compete effectively for subscribers, content and advertising. We cannot provide any assurance that we will realize, in full or in part, the anticipated benefits we expect from the introduction of new technologies, or that any new technologies will be rolled out across our footprint in the timeframe we anticipate. In addition, we may be required to make material capital and other investments to anticipate and to keep up with technological change. These challenges could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

Our revenues and growth may be constrained due to demand exceeding capacity of our systems or our inability to develop solutions.

 

We anticipate generating revenues in the future from broadband connectivity, other Internet services, and broadband and in the cloud services. Demand and market acceptance for these recently introduced services and products delivered over the Internet is uncertain. Critical issues concerning the use of the Internet, such as ease of access, security, reliability, cost and quality of service, exist and may affect the growth of Internet use or the attractiveness of conducting commerce online. In addition, the Internet and online services may not be accepted as viable for a number of reasons, including potentially inadequate development of the necessary network infrastructure or delayed development of enabling technologies and performance improvements. To the extent that the Internet and online services continue to experience significant growth, there can be no assurance that the infrastructure of the Internet and online services will prove adequate to support increased user demands. In addition, the Internet or online services could lose their viability due to delays in the development or adoption of new standards and protocols required to handle increased levels of Internet or online service activity. Changes in, or insufficient availability of, telecommunications services to support the Internet or online services also could result in slower response times and adversely affect usage of the Internet and online services generally and us in particular. If use of the Internet and online services does not continue to grow or grows more slowly than expected, if the infrastructure for the Internet and online services does not effectively support growth that may occur, or if the Internet and online services do not become a viable commercial marketplace, our business could be adversely affected.

 

 
41

Table of Contants

 

Certain aspects of our VoIP telephony services differ from traditional telephone service. The factors that may have this effect include:

 

 

·

our subscribers may experience lower call quality than they experience with traditional wireline telephone companies, including static, echoes and transmission delays;

 

·

our subscribers may experience higher dropped-call rates than they experience with traditional wireline telephone companies; and

 

·

a power loss or Internet access interruption causes our service to be interrupted.

 

Additionally, our VoIP emergency calling service is significantly more limited than the emergency calling services offered by traditional telephone companies. Our VoIP emergency calling service can only transmit to a dispatcher at a public safety answering point, or PSAP, the location information that the subscriber has registered with us, which may at times be different from the actual location at the time of the call. As a result, our emergency calling systems may not assure that the appropriate PSAP is reached and may cause significant delays, or even failures, in callers’ receipt of emergency assistance. Our failure to develop or operate an adequate emergency calling service could subject us to substantial liabilities and may result in delays in subscriber adoption of our VoIP telephony services or all of our services, abandonment of our services by subscribers, and litigation costs, damage awards and negative publicity, any of which could harm our business, prospects, financial condition or results of operations.

 

If our subscribers do not accept the differences between our VoIP telephony services and traditional telephone service, they may not adopt or keep our VoIP telephony services or our other services, or may choose to retain or return to service provided by traditional telephone companies. Because VoIP telephony services represent an important aspect of our business strategy, failure to achieve subscribers’ acceptance of our VoIP telephony services may adversely affect our prospects, results of operations and the trading price of our shares.

 

We rely on contract manufacturers and a limited number of third-party suppliers to produce our network equipment and to maintain our network sites. If these companies fail to perform, we may have a shortage of components and may be required to suspend our network deployment and our product and service introduction.

 

We depend on contract manufacturers, to produce and deliver acceptable, high quality products on a timely basis. We also depend on a limited number of third parties to maintain our network facilities. If our contract manufacturer or other providers do not satisfy our requirements, or if we lose our contract manufacturers or any other significant provider, we may have an insufficient network services for delivery to subscribers, we may be forced to suspend portions of our wireless broadband network, enrollment of new subscribers, and product sales and our business, prospects, financial condition and operating results may be harmed.

 

We rely on highly skilled executives and other personnel. If we cannot retain and motivate key personnel, we may be unable to implement our business strategy.

 

We will be highly dependent on the scientific, technical, and managerial skills of certain key employees, including technical, research and development, sales, marketing, financial and executive personnel, and on our ability to identify, hire and retain additional personnel. To accommodate our current size and manage our anticipated growth, we must expand our employee base. Competition for key personnel, particularly persons having technical expertise, is intense, and there can be no assurance that we will be able to retain existing personnel or to identify or hire additional personnel. The need for such personnel is particularly important given the strains on our existing infrastructure and the need to anticipate the demands of future growth. In particular, we are highly dependent on the continued services of our senior management team, which currently is composed of a small number of individuals. We do not maintain key-man life insurance on the life of any employee. The inability of us to attract, hire or retain the necessary technical, sales, marketing, financial and executive personnel, or the loss of the services of any member of our senior management team, could have a material adverse effect on us.

 

Our future success depends largely on the expertise and reputation of our founder, Chairman and Chief Executive Officer Stephen J. Thomas, Richard Eberhardt, and the other members of our senior management team. In addition, we intend to hire additional highly skilled individuals to staff our operations. Loss of any of our key personnel or the inability to recruit and retain qualified individuals could adversely affect our ability to implement our business strategy and operate our business.

 

We are currently managed by a small number of key management and operating personnel. Our future success depends, in part, on our ability to recruit and retain qualified personnel. Failure to do so likely would have an adverse impact on our business and the trading price of our common stock.

 

 
42

Table of Contants

 

If our data security measures are breached, subscribers may perceive our network and services as not secure.

 

Our network security and the authentication of the subscriber’s credentials are designed to protect unauthorized access to data on our network. Because techniques used to obtain unauthorized access to or to sabotage networks change frequently and may not be recognized until launched against a target, we may be unable to anticipate or implement adequate preventive measures against unauthorized access or sabotage. Consequently, unauthorized parties may overcome our encryption and security systems and obtain access to data on our network, including on a device connected to our network. In addition, because we operate and control our network and our subscribers’ Internet connectivity, unauthorized access or sabotage of our network could result in damage to our network and to the computers or other devices used by our subscribers. An actual or perceived breach of network security, regardless of whether the breach is our fault, could harm public perception of the effectiveness of our security measures, adversely affect our ability to attract and retain subscribers, expose us to significant liability and adversely affect our business prospects.

 

Our activities outside the United States could disrupt our operations.

 

We intend to invest in various international companies and spectrum opportunities through acquisitions and strategic alliances as these opportunities arise. Our activities outside the United States operate in environments different from the one we face in the United States, particularly with respect to competition and regulation. Due to these differences, our activities outside the United States may require a disproportionate amount of our management and financial resources, which could disrupt our U.S. operations and adversely affect our business.

 

In a number of international markets, we face substantial competition from local service providers that offer or may offer their own wireless broadband or VoIP telephony services and from other companies that provide Internet connectivity services. We may face heightened challenges in gaining market share, particularly in certain European countries, where a large portion of the population already has broadband Internet connectivity and incumbent companies already have a dominant market share in their service areas. Furthermore, foreign providers of competing services may have a substantial advantage over us in attracting subscribers due to a more established brand, greater knowledge of local subscribers’ preferences and access to significant financial or strategic resources.

 

In addition, foreign regulatory authorities frequently own or control the incumbent telecommunications companies operating under their jurisdiction. Established relationships between government-owned or government-controlled telecommunications companies and their traditional local providers of telecommunications services often limit access of third parties to these markets. The successful expansion of our international operations in some markets will depend on our ability to locate, form and maintain strong relationships with established local communication services and equipment providers. Failure to establish these relationships or to market or sell our products and services successfully could limit our ability to attract subscribers to our services.

 

We may be unable to protect our intellectual property, which could reduce the value of our services and our brand.

 

Our ability to compete effectively depends on our ability to protect our proprietary technologies, system designs and manufacturing processes. We may not be able to safeguard and maintain our proprietary rights. We rely on patents, trademarks and policies and procedures related to confidentiality to protect our intellectual property. Some of our intellectual property, however, is not covered by any of these protections.

 

We could be subject to claims that we have infringed on the proprietary rights of others, which claims would likely be costly to defend, could require us to pay damages and could limit our ability to use necessary technologies in the future.

 

Our competitors may independently develop or patent technologies or processes that are substantially equivalent or superior to ours. These competitors may claim that our services and products infringe on these patents or other proprietary rights. Defending against infringement claims, even merit less ones, would be time consuming, distracting and costly. If we are found to be infringing proprietary rights of a third party, we could be enjoined from using such third party’s rights and be required to pay substantial royalties and damages and may no longer be able to use the intellectual property on acceptable terms or at all. Failure to obtain licenses to intellectual property could delay or prevent the development, manufacture or sale of our products or services and could cause us to expend significant resources to develop or acquire non-infringing intellectual property.

 

Our business depends on our brand, and if we do not maintain and enhance our brand, our ability to attract and retain subscribers may be impaired and our business and operating results harmed.

 

We believe that our brand is a critical part of our business. Maintaining and enhancing our brand may require us to make substantial investments with no assurance that these investments will be successful. If we fail to promote and maintain our brands, or if we incur significant expenses in this effort, our business, prospects, operating results and financial condition may be harmed. We anticipate that maintaining and enhancing our brand will become increasingly important, difficult and expensive.

 

 
43

Table of Contants

 

We are subject to extensive regulation.

 

Our acquisition, lease, maintenance and use of spectrum licenses are extensively regulated by federal, state, local, and foreign governmental entities. A number of other federal, state, local and foreign privacy, security and consumer laws also apply to our business. These regulations and their application are subject to continual change as new legislation, regulations or amendments to existing regulations are adopted from time to time by governmental or regulatory authorities, including as a result of judicial interpretations of such laws and regulations. Current regulations directly affect the breadth of services we are able to offer and may impact the rates, terms and conditions of our services. Regulation of companies that offer competing services, such as cable and DSL providers and incumbent telecommunications carriers, also affects our business indirectly.

 

We are also subject to regulation because we provide VoIP telephony services. As an “interconnected” VoIP provider, we are required under FCC rules, to comply with the Communications Assistance for Law Enforcement Act, or CALEA, which requires service providers to build certain capabilities into their networks and to accommodate wiretap requests from law enforcement agencies.

 

In addition, the FCC or other regulatory authorities may in the future restrict our ability to manage subscribers’ use of our network, thereby limiting our ability to prevent or address subscribers’ excessive bandwidth demands. To maintain the quality of our network and user experience, we manage the bandwidth used by our subscribers’ applications, in part by restricting the types of applications that may be used over our network. Some providers and users of these applications have objected to this practice. If the FCC or other regulatory authorities were to adopt regulations that constrain our ability to employ bandwidth management practices, excessive use of bandwidth-intensive applications would likely reduce the quality of our services for all subscribers. Such decline in the quality of our services could harm our business.

 

In certain of our international markets, the services provided by our business may require receipt of a license from national, provincial or local regulatory authorities. Where required, regulatory authorities may have significant discretion in granting the licenses and in the term of the licenses and are often under no obligation to renew the licenses when they expire.

 

The breach of a license or applicable law, even if inadvertent, can result in the revocation, suspension, cancellation or reduction in the term of a license or the imposition of fines. In addition, regulatory authorities may grant new licenses to third parties, resulting in greater competition in territories where we already have rights to licensed spectrum. In order to promote competition, licenses may also require that third parties be granted access to our bandwidth, frequency capacity, facilities or services. We may not be able to obtain or retain any required license, and we may not be able to renew a license on favorable terms, or at all.

 

Our wireless broadband and VoIP telephony services may become subject to greater state or federal regulation in the future. The scope of the regulations that may apply to VoIP telephony services providers and the impact of such regulations on providers’ competitive position are presently unknown.

 

Our Chairman and Chief Executive Officer is also our largest stockholder, and as a result he can exert control over us and has actual or potential interests that may diverge from yours.

 

Mr. Thomas may have interests that diverge from those of other holders of our common stock and he owns our super majority voting Series A stock. As a result, Mr. Thomas may vote the shares he owns or otherwise cause us to take actions that may conflict with your best interests as a stockholder, which could adversely affect our results of operations and the trading price of our common stock.

 

Through his control, Mr. Thomas can control our management, affairs and all matters requiring stockholder approval, including the approval of significant corporate transactions, a sale of our company, decisions about our capital structure and, the composition of our board of directors.

 

COVID-19 effects on the economy may negatively affect our Company business.

 

In December 2019, COVID-19 emerged and has subsequently spread worldwide. The World Health Organization has declared COVID-19 a pandemic resulting in federal, state and local governments and private entities mandating various restrictions, including travel restrictions, restrictions on public gatherings, stay at home orders and advisories and quarantining of people who may have been exposed to the virus.

 

As the COVID-19 pandemic is complex and rapidly evolving, the Company's business may be negatively affected for a sustained time frame. At this point, we cannot reasonably estimate the duration and severity of this pandemic, which could have a material adverse impact on our business, results of operations, financial position and cash flows.

 

 
44

Table of Contants

 

Our officers and directors may have conflicts of interests as to corporate opportunities which we may not be able or allowed to participate in.

 

Presently there is no requirement contained in our Articles of Incorporation, Bylaws, or minutes which requires officers and directors of our business to disclose to us business opportunities which come to their attention. Our officers and directors do, however, have a fiduciary duty of loyalty to us to disclose to us any business opportunities which come to their attention, in their capacity as an officer and/or director or otherwise. Excluded from this duty would be opportunities which the person learns about through his involvement as an officer and director of another company. We have no intention of merging with or acquiring business opportunity from any affiliate or officer or director.

 

We have agreed to indemnification of officers and directors as is provided by Florida Statutes.

 

Florida Statutes provide for the indemnification of our directors, officers, employees, and agents, under certain circumstances, against attorney’s fees and other expenses incurred by them in any litigation to which they become a party arising from their association with or activities our behalf. We will also bear the expenses of such litigation for any of our directors, officers, employees, or agents, upon such person’s promise to repay us therefore if it is ultimately determined that any such person shall not have been entitled to indemnification. This indemnification policy could result in substantial expenditures by us that we will be unable to recoup.

 

Our directors’ liability to us and shareholders is limited.

 

Florida Statutes exclude personal liability of our directors and our stockholders for monetary damages for breach of fiduciary duty except in certain specified circumstances. Accordingly, we will have a much more limited right of action against our directors that otherwise would be the case. This provision does not affect the liability of any director under federal or applicable state securities laws.

 

We may not be able to successfully implement our business strategy without substantial additional capital. Any such failure may adversely affect the business and results of operations.

 

Unless we can generate revenues sufficient to implement our Business Plan, we will need to obtain additional financing through debt or bank financing, or through the sale of shareholder interests to execute our Business Plan. We expect to need at least $38,000,000 in the next twelve months in capital or loans to complete our plans and operations. We may not be able to obtain this financing at all. We have not sought commitments for this financing, and we have no terms for either debt or equity financing, and we realize that it may be difficult to obtain on favorable terms. Moreover, if we issue additional equity securities to support our operations, Investor holdings may be diluted. Our business plans are at risk if we cannot continually achieve additional capital raising to complete our plans.

 

We are reliant, in part, on third party sales organizations, which may not perform as we expect.

 

We, from time to time rely on the sales force of third-party sales organizations with support from our own selling resources. The third-party relationships and internal organization are not fully developed at this time and must be developed. We may not be able to hire effective inside salespeople to help our third-party sales organizations close sales. There is no assurance that any approaches will improve sales. Further, using only a direct sales force would be less cost-effective than our plan to use third-party sales organizations. In addition, a direct sales model may be ineffective if we were unable to hire and retain qualified sales people and if the sales force fails to complete sales. Moreover, even if we successfully implement our business strategy, we may not have positive operating results. We may decide to alter or discontinue aspects of our business strategy and may adopt different strategies due to business or competitive factors.

 

Our growth may be affected adversely if our sales of products and services are negatively affected by competition or other factors.

 

The growth of our business is dependent, in large part, upon the development of sales for our services and product offerings. Market opportunities that we expect to exist may not develop as expected, or at all. For example, a substantial percentage of our service offerings is oriented around data access. If lower cost alternatives are developed, our sales would decrease and our operating results would be negatively affected. Moreover, even if market opportunities develop as expected, new technologies and services offerings introduced by competitors may significantly limit our ability to capitalize on any such market opportunity. Our failure to capitalize on expected market opportunities would adversely affect revenue growth.

 

The lack of operating history and the rapidly changing nature of the market in which we compete make it difficult to accurately forecast revenues and operating results. We anticipate that revenues and operating results might fluctuate in the future due to a number of factors including the following:

 

 

·

the timing of sales for current services and products offerings

 

 

 

 

·

the timing of new product implementations

 

 
45

Table of Contants

 

 

·

unexpected delays in introducing new services and products offerings

 

 

 

 

·

increased expense related to sales and marketing, product development or administration

 

 

 

 

·

the mix of products and our services offerings

 

 

 

 

·

costs related to possible acquisitions of technology or business.

 

 

 

 

·

costs of providing services

 

We may be unable to compete with larger, more established competitors.

 

The market for providing network delivered service solutions is competitive. We expect competition to intensify in the future. Many of our potential competitors have longer operating histories, larger customer bases, greater recognition and significantly greater resources. As a result, competitors may be able to respond more quickly to emerging technologies and changes in customer requirements than we can. The continuous and timely introduction of competitively priced services offerings into the market is critical to our success, and there can be no assurance that we will be able to introduce such services offerings. We may not be able to compete successfully against competitors, and the competitive pressures we face may have an adverse effect on our business.

 

RISK FACTORS RELATED TO OUR STOCK

 

We can give no assurance of success or profitability to our investors.

 

Cash flows generated from operating activities were not enough to support all working capital requirements for the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020. Financing activities described below have helped with working capital and other capital requirements.

 

We incurred $4,095,507 and $8,119,268, respectively, in losses, and we used $995,093 and $489,573, respectively, in cash for operations for the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020. We calculate the net cash used by operating activities by decreasing, or increasing in case of gain, our let loss by those items that do not require the use of cash such as depreciation, amortization, promissory note issued for research and development, note payable issued for legal fees, derivative expense or gain, gain on extinguishment of debt, loss on conversion of notes payable, impairment of goodwill and long-loved assts and share-based compensation which totaled to a net $(1,170,451) for 2021 and $5,378,277 for 2020. 

 

In addition, we report increases and reductions in liabilities as uses of cash and deceases assets and increases in liabilities as sources of cash, together referred to as changes in operating assets and liabilities.  For the year ended December 31, 2021, we had a net increase in our assets and liabilities of $4,270,865 primarily from an increase in accounts payable from lag of payments for accounts payable for cash flow considerations and an increase in the balances from our operating lease liabilities.  For the year ended December 31, 2020 we had a net increase to our assets and liabilities of $2,251,418 for similar reasons.

 

Cash flows from financing activities were $1,169,810 and $817,608 for the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively.  For the year ended December 30, 2021, these cash flows were generated from the sale of Series D Preferred Stock, common stock subscriptions of $610,502, proceeds from convertible notes, loans and advances of $3,900,400 offset by payment on convertible loans, advances and factoring agreements of $3,502,592 and payments on convertible notes and amounts payable – related parties of $64,480.  For the year ended December 31, 2020, cash flows from financing activities primarily came from proceeds from the sale of interest in QuikLABS of $460,000, convertible notes, loans and advances of $1,753,204 offset by payments on convertible loans, advances and factoring agreements of $1,169,330.

 

Cash flows provided by (used in) investing activities were $324,040 and $(500,898), respectively, for the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020 primarily related to the acquisition of property and equipment and the purchase of intangibles.

 

These factors raise substantial doubt about the ability of the Company to continue as a going concern for a period of one year from the issuance of these financial statements. The financial statements do not include any adjustments that might result from the outcome of this uncertainty.

 

 
46

Table of Contants

 

In December 2019, COVID-19 emerged and has subsequently spread worldwide. The World Health Organization has declared COVID-19 a pandemic resulting in federal, state and local governments and private entities mandating various restrictions, including travel restrictions, restrictions on public gatherings, stay at home orders and advisories and quarantining of people who may have been exposed to the virus. After close monitoring and responses and guidance from federal, state and local governments, in an effort to mitigate the spread of COVID-19, around March 18, 2020 for a period of time, the Company closed its Blue Collar office in Los Angeles and its TPT SpeedConnect offices in Michigan, Idaho and Arizona.  Most employees were working remotely, however this is not possible with certain employees and all subcontractors that work for Blue Collar. The Company continues to monitor developments, including government requirements and recommendations at the national, state, and local level to evaluate possible extensions to all or part of such closures.

 

The Company has taken advantage of the stimulus offerings and received $1,402,700 in PPP loans.  All of these PPP loans were forgiven in the year ended December 31, 2021.  The Company is also in the process of trying to raise debt and equity financing, some of which may have to be used for working capital shortfalls if revenues continue to decline. 

 

In order for us to continue as a going concern for a period of one year from the issuance of these financial statements, we will need to obtain additional debt or equity financing and look for companies with cash flow positive operations that we can acquire. There can be no assurance that we will be able to secure additional debt or equity financing, that we will be able to acquire cash flow positive operations, or that, if we are successful in any of those actions, those actions will produce adequate cash flow to enable us to meet all our future obligations. Most of our existing financing arrangements are short-term. If we are unable to obtain additional debt or equity financing, we may be required to significantly reduce or cease operations.

 

Sales of common stock resulting from issuances of common stock for conversions by our convertible noteholders or Rule 144 sales in the future will have a depressive effect on our common stock price.

 

Most of our convertible noteholders have rights to convert their notes at significant discounts to the market prices as shown in the schedule below, for sale under the requirements of Rule 144 or other applicable exemptions from registration under the Act and perhaps under registration statements which the company is preparing to file in the next thirty days. Rule 144 provides in essence that a person who has held restricted securities for six months or is deemed to have held them due to the issuance by the Company of convertible notes under certain conditions, may sell those shares in brokerage transactions. There is no limit on the amount of restricted securities that may be sold by a non-affiliate after the owner has held the restricted securities for a period of six months. A sale under Rule 144 or under any other exemption from the Act, if available, or pursuant to subsequent registration of shares of common stock of present stockholders underlying the convertible notes, will have a depressive effect upon the price of the common stock in the market, since they are issued at a discount to market-often 50-60% of the lowest bid for differing periods, and sales can be expected at some discounted prices, with larger than normal volumes.  We have also issued preferred stock and options and warrants that allow for the purchase of shares at significant discounts to the market prices, often 50% of the ten-day low bids, or other highly discounted rates, which would allow the holders of those warrants to sell shares into the market at a profit over their discounted price, which could have the effect of depressing the price of the shares in the market.

 

As of December 31, 2021, we had the following convertible promissory notes, preferred stock and options and warrants outstanding that are convertible into common shares as follows:

 

 

 

2021

 

Convertible Promissory Notes

 

 

429,623,112

 

Series A Preferred Stock (1)

 

 

1,349,817,125

 

Series B Preferred Stock

 

 

2,588,693

 

Series D Preferred Stock (2)

 

 

25,297,722

 

Stock Options and warrants

 

 

111,000,000

 

 

 

 

1,918,326,652

 

_____________________

(1)

Holder of the Series A Preferred Stock which is Stephen J. Thomas, is guaranteed 60% of the then outstanding common stock upon conversion. The Company would have to authorize additional shares for this to occur as only 1,250,000,000 shares were authorized as of December 31, 2021 and 2,500,000,000 as of April 6, 2022.

 

 

(2)

Holders of the Series D Preferred Stock may decide after 12 months to convert to common stock @ 75% of the 30-day average market closing price (for previous 30 business days) divided into $5.00. There is also an automatic conversion of the Series D Preferred Stock without consent of holders upon any national exchange listing approval and the registration effectiveness of common stock underlying the conversion rights. The automatic conversion to common from Series D Preferred shall be on the same conversion basis.

 

 
47

Table of Contants

 

Stock Options

 

 

 

Options Outstanding 

 

 

Vested 

 

 

Vesting Period 

 

 

Exercise Price Outstanding and Exercisable 

 

 

Expiration Date 

 

December 31, 2019

 

 

3,000,000

 

 

 

3,000,000

 

 

12 to 18 months

 

 

$0.10

 

 

3-1-20 to 3-21-21 

 

Expired

 

 

(2,000,000)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2020

 

 

1,000,000

 

 

 

1,000,000

 

 

12 months

 

 

$0.10

 

 

3-21-21 

 

Expired

 

 

(1,000,000)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2021

 

 

---

 

 

 

---

 

 

 

---

 

 

 

---

 

 

 

---

 

 

On October 14, 2017, the Board of Directors and majority stockholders of TPT approved the 2017 TPT Global Tech, Inc. Stock Option and Award Incentive Plan (“the 2017 Plan.”) There are 20,000,000 shares of our common stock reserved under the 2017 Plan.

 

Warrants

 

As of December 31, 2021, there were 111,000,000 warrants outstanding that expire in five years or in the year ended December 31, 2024.  As part of the Convertible Promissory Notes payable – third party issuance in Note 5, the Company issued 3,333,333 warrants to purchase 3,333,333 common shares of the Company at 70% of the current market price.  Current market price means the average of the three lowest trading prices for our common stock during the ten-trading day period ending on the latest complete trading day prior to the date of the respective exercise notice.  However, if a required registration statement, registering the underlying shares of the Convertible Promissory Notes, is declared effective on or before June 11, 2019 to September 11, 2019, then, while such Registration Statement is effective, the current market price shall mean the lowest volume weighted average price for our common stock during the ten-trading day period ending on the last complete trading day prior to the conversion date.   Since issuance of the 3,333,333 originally issued, 2,333,333 of the warrants have been bought back or exercised.

 

During the year ended December 31, 2021, the Company issued warrants in conjunction with the issuance of the FirstFire Note, the Cavalry Investment Note and the Cavalry Fund I Note agreements.  Warrants to purchase 110,000,000 shares of common stock at 110% of the opening price on the first day the Company trades on the Nasdaq exchange were issued to these note holders.

 

The exercise of the options, warrants, convertible promissory notes and Series A, B, C, D, and E Series Preferred Stock into shares of our common stock could have a dilutive effect to the holdings of our existing shareholders.

 

We may in the future issue more shares which could cause a loss of control by our present management and current stockholders.

 

We may issue further shares as consideration for the cash or assets or services out of our authorized but unissued common stock that would, upon issuance, represent a majority of the voting power and equity of our Company. The result of such an issuance would be those new stockholders and management would control our Company, and persons unknown could replace our management at this time. Such an occurrence would result in a greatly reduced percentage of ownership of our Company by our current shareholders, which could present significant risks to investors.

 

Our officers and directors may have conflicts of interests as to corporate opportunities which we may not be able or allowed to participate in.

 

Presently there is no requirement contained in our Articles of Incorporation, Bylaws, or minutes which requires officers and directors of our business to disclose to us business opportunities which come to their attention. Our officers and directors do, however, have a fiduciary duty of loyalty to us to disclose to us any business opportunities which come to their attention, in their capacity as an officer and/or director or otherwise. Excluded from this duty would be opportunities which the person learns about through his involvement as an officer and director of another company. We have no intention of merging with or acquiring business opportunity from any affiliate or officer or director.

 

We have agreed to indemnification of officers and directors as is provided by Florida Statutes.

 

Florida Statutes provide for the indemnification of our directors, officers, employees, and agents, under certain circumstances, against attorney’s fees and other expenses incurred by them in any litigation to which they become a party arising from their association with or activities our behalf. We will also bear the expenses of such litigation for any of our directors, officers, employees, or agents, upon such person’s promise to repay us therefore if it is ultimately determined that any such person shall not have been entitled to indemnification. This indemnification policy could result in substantial expenditures by us that we will be unable to recoup.

 

 
48

Table of Contants

 

Our directors’ liability to us and shareholders is limited.

 

Florida Statutes exclude personal liability of our directors and our stockholders for monetary damages for breach of fiduciary duty except in certain specified circumstances. Accordingly, we will have a much more limited right of action against our directors that otherwise would be the case. This provision does not affect the liability of any director under federal or applicable state securities laws.

 

Our Stock prices in the Market may be volatile.

 

The value of our Common stock may be highly volatile and could be subject to fluctuations in price in response to various factors, some of which are beyond our control. These factors include:

 

 

·

quarterly variations in our results of operations or those of our competitors;

 

·

announcements by us or our competitors of acquisitions, new products, significant contracts, commercial relationships or capital commitments;

 

·

disruption to our operations or those of other sources critical to our network operations;

 

·

the emergence of new competitors or new technologies;

 

·

our ability to develop and market new and enhanced products on a timely basis;

 

·

seasonal or other variations in our subscriber base;

 

·

commencement of, or our involvement in, litigation;

 

·

availability of additional spectrum;

 

·

dilutive issuances of our stock or the stock of our subsidiaries, or the incurrence of additional debt;

 

·

changes in our board or management;

 

·

adoption of new or different accounting standards;

 

·

changes in governmental regulations or in the status of our regulatory approvals;

 

·

changes in earnings estimates or recommendations by securities analysts;

 

·

announcements regarding WiMAX and other technical standards; and

 

·

general economic conditions and slow or negative growth of related markets.

 

In addition, the stock market in general, and the market for shares of technology companies in particular, has experienced price and volume fluctuations that have often been unrelated or disproportionate to the operating performance of those companies. We expect the value of our common stock will be subject to such fluctuations.

 

We may not be able to successfully implement our business strategy without substantial additional capital. Any such failure may adversely affect the business and results of operations.

 

Unless we can generate revenues sufficient to implement our Business Plan, we will need to obtain additional financing through debt or bank financing, or through the sale of shareholder interests to execute our Business Plan. We expect to need at least $38,000,000 in the next twelve months in capital or loans to complete our plans and operations. We may not be able to obtain this financing at all. We have not sought commitments for this financing, and we have no terms for either debt or equity financing, and we realize that it may be difficult to obtain on favorable terms. Moreover, if we issue additional equity securities to support our operations, Investor holdings may be diluted. Our business plans are at risk if we cannot continually achieve additional capital raising to complete our plans.

 

We are reliant, in part, on third party sales organizations, which may not perform as we expect.

 

We, from time to time rely on the sales force of third-party sales organizations with support from our own selling resources. The third-party relationships and internal organization are not fully developed at this time and must be developed. We may not be able to hire effective inside salespeople to help our third-party sales organizations close sales. There is no assurance that any approaches will improve sales. Further, using only a direct sales force would be less cost-effective than our plan to use third-party sales organizations. In addition, a direct sales model may be ineffective if we were unable to hire and retain qualified salespeople and if the sales force fails to complete sales. Moreover, even if we successfully implement our business strategy, we may not have positive operating results. We may decide to alter or discontinue aspects of our business strategy and may adopt different strategies due to business or competitive factors.

 

 
49

Table of Contants

 

Our growth may be affected adversely if our sales of products and services are negatively affected by competition or other factors.

 

The growth of our business is dependent, in large part, upon the development of sales for our services and product offerings. Market opportunities that we expect to exist may not develop as expected, or at all. For example, a substantial percentage of our service offerings is oriented around data access. If lower cost alternatives are developed, our sales would decrease and our operating results would be negatively affected. Moreover, even if market opportunities develop as expected, new technologies and services offerings introduced by competitors may significantly limit our ability to capitalize on any such market opportunity. Our failure to capitalize on expected market opportunities would adversely affect revenue growth.

 

The lack of operating history and the rapidly changing nature of the market in which we compete make it difficult to accurately forecast revenues and operating results. We anticipate that revenues and operating results might fluctuate in the future due to a number of factors including the following:

 

 

·

the timing of sales for current services and products offerings

 

 

·

the timing of new product implementations

 

 

·

unexpected delays in introducing new services and products offerings

 

 

·

increased expense related to sales and marketing, product development or administration

 

 

·

the mix of products and our services offerings

 

 

·

costs related to possible acquisitions of technology or business.

 

 

·

costs of providing services

 

We may be unable to compete with larger, more established competitors.

 

The market for providing network delivered service solutions is competitive. We expect competition to intensify in the future. Many of our potential competitors have longer operating histories, larger customer bases, greater recognition and significantly greater resources. As a result, competitors may be able to respond more quickly to emerging technologies and changes in customer requirements than we can. The continuous and timely introduction of competitively priced services offerings into the market is critical to our success, and there can be no assurance that we will be able to introduce such services offerings. We may not be able to compete successfully against competitors, and the competitive pressures we face may have an adverse effect on our business.

 

Our common stock will in all likelihood be thinly traded and as a result you may be unable to sell at or near ask prices or at all if you need to liquidate your shares, after any conversion from Preferred Stock.

 

The shares of our common stock may be thinly-traded on the OTC Market, meaning that the number of persons interested in purchasing our common shares at or near ask prices at any given time may be relatively small or non-existent. This situation is attributable to a number of factors, including the fact that we are a small company which is relatively unknown to stock analysts, stock brokers, institutional investors and others in the investment community that generate or influence sales volume, and that even if we came to the attention of such persons, they tend to be risk-averse and would be reluctant to follow an unproven, early stage company such as ours or purchase or recommend the purchase of any of our Securities until such time as we became more seasoned and viable. As a consequence, there may be periods of several days or more when trading activity in our Securities is minimal or non-existent, as compared to a seasoned issuer which has a large and steady volume of trading activity that will generally support continuous sales without an adverse effect on Securities price. We cannot give you any assurance that a broader or more active public trading market for our common Securities will develop or be sustained, or that any trading levels will be sustained. Due to these conditions, we can give investors no assurance that they will be able to sell their shares at or near ask prices or at all if they need money or otherwise desire to liquidate their securities of our Company.

 

 
50

Table of Contants

 

The regulation of penny stocks by SEC and FINRA may discourage the tradability of our common stock or other securities.

 

We are a “penny stock” company. Our common stock currently trades on the OTCQB under the symbol “TPTW” and will be subject to a Securities and Exchange Commission rule that imposes special sales practice requirements upon broker-dealers who sell such securities to persons other than established customers or accredited investors. For purposes of the rule, the phrase “accredited investors” means, in general terms, institutions with assets in excess of $5,000,000, or individuals having a net worth in excess of $1,000,000 or having an annual income that exceeds $200,000 (or that, when combined with a spouse’s income, exceeds $300,000). For transactions covered by the rule, the broker-dealer must make a special suitability determination for the purchaser and receive the purchaser’s written agreement to the transaction prior to the sale. Effectively, this discourages broker-dealers from executing trades in penny stocks. Consequently, the rule will affect the ability of purchasers to sell their securities in any market that might develop therefore because it imposes additional regulatory burdens on penny stock transactions.

 

In addition, the Securities and Exchange Commission has adopted a number of rules to regulate “penny stocks". Such rules include Rules 3a51-1, 15g-1, 15g-2, 15g-3, 15g-4, 15g-5, 15g-6, 15g-7, and 15g-9 under the Securities and Exchange Act of 1934, as amended. Because our securities constitute “penny stocks” within the meaning of the rules, the rules would apply to us and to our securities. The rules will further affect the ability of owners of shares to sell our securities in any market that might develop for them because it imposes additional regulatory burdens on penny stock transactions.

 

Shareholders should be aware that, according to Securities and Exchange Commission, the market for penny stocks has suffered in recent years from patterns of fraud and abuse. Such patterns include (i) control of the market for the security by one or a few broker-dealers that are often related to the promoter or issuer; (ii) manipulation of prices through prearranged matching of purchases and sales and false and misleading press releases; (iii) “boiler room” practices involving high-pressure sales tactics and unrealistic price projections by inexperienced sales persons; (iv) excessive and undisclosed bid-ask differentials and markups by selling broker-dealers; and (v) the wholesale dumping of the same securities by promoters and broker-dealers after prices have been manipulated to a desired consequent investor losses. Our management is aware of the abuses that have occurred historically in the penny stock market. Although we do not expect to be in a position to dictate the behavior of the market or of broker-dealers who participate in the market, management will strive within the confines of practical limitations to prevent the described patterns from being established with respect to our securities.

 

Inventory in penny stocks have limited remedies in the event of violations of penny stock rules. While the courts are always available to seek remedies for fraud against us, most, if not all, brokerages require their customers to sign mandatory arbitration agreements in conjunctions with opening trading accounts. Such arbitration may be through an independent arbiter. Investors may file a complaint with FINRA against the broker allegedly at fault, and FINRA may be the arbiter, under FINRA rules. Arbitration rules generally limit discovery and provide more expedient adjudication, but also provide limited remedies in damages usually only the actual economic loss in the account. Investors should understand that if a fraud case is filed against a company in the courts it may be vigorously defended and may take years and great legal expenses and costs to pursue, which may not be economically feasible for small investors.

 

That absent arbitration agreements related to brokerage accounts, specific legal remedies available to investors of penny stocks include the following:

 

If a penny stock is sold to the investor in violation of the requirements listed above, or other federal or states securities laws, the investor may be able to cancel the purchase and receive a refund of the investment.

 

If a penny stock is sold to the investor in a fraudulent manner, the investor may be able to sue the persons and firms that committed the fraud for damages.

 

The fact that we are a penny stock company will cause many brokers to refuse to handle transactions in the stocks, and may discourage trading activity and volume, or result in wide disparities between bid and ask prices. These may cause investors significant illiquidity of the stock at a price at which they may wish to sell or in the opportunity to complete a sale. Investors will have no effective legal remedies for these illiquidity issues.

 

We will pay no dividends in the foreseeable future on common stock.

 

We have not paid dividends on our common stock and do not anticipate paying such dividends in the foreseeable future. The Series D Preferred Stock will be paid 6% per annum on a cumulative basis, in cash or in registered common stock.

 

Rule 144 sales of stock in the future may have a depressive effect on our stock price.

 

All of the outstanding shares of common stock held by our present officers, directors, and affiliate stockholders are “restricted securities” within the meaning of Rule 144 under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended. As restricted Shares, common shares may be resold only pursuant to an effective registration statement or under the requirements of Rule 144 or other applicable exemptions from registration under the Act and as required under applicable state securities laws. Rule 144 provides in essence that a person who has held restricted securities for six months, under certain conditions, sell every three months, in brokerage transactions, a number of shares that does not exceed the greater of 1.0% of a company’s outstanding common stock or the average weekly trading volume during the four calendar weeks prior to the sale. There is no limit on the amount of restricted securities that may be sold by a non-affiliate after the owner has held the restricted securities for a period of six months. A sale under Rule 144 or under any other exemption from the Act, if available, or pursuant to subsequent registration of shares of common stock of present stockholders, may have a depressive effect upon the price of the common stock in any market that may develop.

 

 
51

Table of Contants

 

Any sales of our common stock, if in significant amounts, are likely to depress the future market price of our securities.

 

Assuming all of the shares of common stock held by the selling security holder registered in a Form S-1 and effective with the SEC on January 27, 2021 are sold, we would have 7,500,000 new shares that are freely tradable and therefor available for sale, in market or private transactions.

 

Unrestricted sales of 7,500,000 shares of stock by our selling stockholders could have a huge negative impact on our share price, and the market for our shares.

 

Any new potential investors will suffer a disproportionate risk and there will be immediate dilution of existing investor’s investments.

 

Our present shareholders have acquired their securities at a cost significantly less than that which the investors purchasing hereto will pay for their stock holdings or at which future purchasers in the market may pay. Therefore, any new potential investors will bear most of the risk of loss.

 

We can issue future series of shares of preferred stock without shareholder approval, which could adversely affect the rights of common shareholders.

 

Our Articles of Incorporation permit our Board of Directors to establish the rights, privileges, preferences and restrictions, including voting rights, of future series of stock and to issue such stock without approval from our shareholders. The rights of holders of common stock may suffer as a result of the rights granted to holders of preferred stock that may be issued in the future. In addition, we could issue preferred stock to prevent a change in control of our Company, depriving common shareholders of an opportunity to sell their stock at a price in excess of the prevailing market price.

 

RISKS RELATING TO OUR INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY AND POTENTIAL LITIGATION

 

We may not be able to protect our intellectual property and proprietary rights.

 

There can be no assurances that we will be able to obtain intellectual property protection that will effectively prevent any competitors from developing or marketing the same or a competing technology. In addition, we cannot predict whether we will be subject to intellectual property litigation the outcome of which is subject to uncertainty and which can be very costly to pursue or defend. We will attempt to continue to protect our proprietary designs and to avoid infringing on the intellectual property of third parties. However, there can be no assurance that we will be able to protect our intellectual property or avoid suits by third parties claiming intellectual property infringement.

 

If our patents and other intellectual property rights do not adequately protect our service offering, we may lose market share to competitors and be unable to operate our business profitably.

 

Patents and other proprietary rights are anticipated to be of value to our future business, and our ability to compete effectively with other companies depends on the proprietary nature of our current or future technologies. We also rely upon trade secrets, know-how, continuing technological innovations and licensing opportunities to develop, maintain, and strengthen our competitive position. We cannot assure you that any future patent applications will result in issued patents, that any patents issued or licensed to us will not be challenged, invalidated or circumvented or that the rights granted there under will provide a competitive advantage to us or prevent competitors from entering markets which we currently serve. Any required license may not be available to us on acceptable terms, if at all or may become invalid if the licensee’s right to such technology become challenged and/or revoked. In addition, some licenses may be non-exclusive, and therefore competitors may have access to the same technologies as we do. Furthermore, we may have to take legal action in the future to protect our trade secrets or know-how, or to defend them against claimed infringement of the rights of others. Any legal action of that type could be costly and time-consuming to us, and we cannot assure you that such actions will be successful. The invalidation of key patents or proprietary rights which we own or unsuccessful outcomes in lawsuits to protect our intellectual property may have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

 
52

Table of Contants

 

We may in the future become subject to claims that some, or the entire service offering violates the patent or intellectual property rights of others, which could be costly and disruptive to us.

 

We operate in an industry that is susceptible to patent litigation. As a result, we or the parties we license technology from may become subject to patent infringement claims or litigation. Further, one or more of our future patents or applications may become subject to interference proceedings declared by the U.S. Patent and Trademark Office, (“USPTO”) or the foreign equivalents thereof to determine the priority of claims to inventions. The defense of intellectual property suits, USPTO interference proceedings or the foreign equivalents thereof, as well as related legal and administrative proceedings, are both costly and time consuming and may divert management's attention from other business concerns. An adverse determination in litigation or interference proceedings to which we may become a party could, among other things:

 

 

·

subject us to significant liabilities to third parties, including treble damages;

 

 

 

 

·

require disputed rights to be licensed from a third party for royalties that may be substantial;

 

 

 

 

·

require us to cease using such technology; or

 

 

 

 

·

prohibit us from selling certain of our service offerings.

 

Any of these outcomes could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

ITEM 1B. UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS.

 

None.

 

ITEM 2. PROPERTIES.

 

Description of properties/assets

 

(a)

Real Estate.

None.

(b)

Title to properties.

None.

(c)

Patents, Trade Names, Trademarks and Copyrights

See below.

 

Our executive offices are located in San Diego, California. We do not own any real property, but lease and office space consisting of approximately 5,000 sq. ft. among all of our corporate and subsidiary locations. We believe that substantially all of our property and equipment is in good condition, subject to normal wear and tear, and that our facilities have sufficient capacity to meet the current needs of our business.

 

Patents, trade names, trademarks and copyrights

 

Either directly or through our subsidiaries, we have rights in various patents, trade names, trademarks, copyrights and other intellectual property necessary to conduct our business. Our services often use the intellectual property of others, including licensed software. We also occasionally license our intellectual property to others as we deem appropriate.

 

We periodically receive offers from third parties to purchase or obtain licenses for patents and other intellectual property rights in exchange for royalties or other payments. We also periodically receive notices, or are named in lawsuits, alleging that our products or services infringe on patents or other intellectual property rights of third parties. In certain instances, these matters can potentially adversely impact our operations, operating results or financial position. For additional information, see “Risk Factors”.

 

ITEM 3. LEGAL PROCEEDINGS.

 

On March 18, 2019, the Company issued to an Investor a convertible promissory note in the principal amount of $600,000.00 (the “Auctus Promissory Note”) and Warrant Agreement (the “Auctus Warrant Agreement”) pursuant to that certain securities purchase agreement dated March 18, 2019 (the “Auctus SPA”) with Auctus Fund, LLC (“Auctus”). Pursuant to claims by Auctus that the Company had not complied with terms of the Auctus SPA, the Company and Auctus entered into a settlement agreement dated October 13, 2021 where by the Company would pay $763,231.97 and allow Auctus to exercise its right to exercise 15,000,000 warrants to purchase 15,000,000 shares of common stock.  Auctus agreed to limit the sale of common shares of the Company to 2,000,000 during each respective calendar week. The Company recognized a gain on debt extinguishment of $7,068,339 when this Auctus Promissory Note was paid off in large part because of the related derivative liability on the books at the time of the settlement.

 

We have been named in a lawsuit by EMA Financial, LLC (“EMA”) for failing to comply with a Securities Purchase Agreement entered into in June 2019.   More specifically, EMA claims the Company failed to honor notices of conversion, failed to establish and maintain share reserves, failed to register EMA shares and by failed to assure that EMA shares were Rule 144 eligible within 6 months.  EMA has claimed in excess of $7,614,967 in relief.  The Company has filed a motion in response for which EMA has filed a motion to dismiss.   The Company does not believe at this time that any negative outcome would result in more than the $786,355 it has recorded on its balance sheet as of December 31, 2021.

 

 
53

Table of Contants

 

A lawsuit was filed in Michigan by the one of the former owners of SpeedConnect, LLC, John Ogren.   Mr. Ogren claimed he was owed back wages related to the acquisition agreement wherein the Company acquired the assets of SpeedConnect, LLC and kept him on through a consulting agreement. The Company’s position was that he ultimately resigned in writing and was not due any back wages.  In August 2021, Mr. Ogren was awarded $334,908 in back wages by an Arbitrator.  This amount has been included in accounts payable as of September 30, 2021 and expensed in the statement of operations as other expenses for the year ended December 31, 2021.  Mr. Ogren and the Company have agreed to a settlement whereby the Company would pay $120,000 within 14 days of a written agreement with four monthly payments of $20,000 starting on December 5, 2021 through March 2, 2022. This debt was completely paid off subsequent to December 31, 2021.  The balance owing as of December 31, 2021 was $60,000 included in accounts payable.

 

We have been named in a lawsuit by a collection law firm on behalf of Pinnacle Towers LLC and Crown Atlantic Company Inc., against TPT Global Tech, Inc.  The claim derives from an outstanding debt by incurred by Copperhead Digital.  The lawsuit is over unpaid rent that should have been paid by Copperhead Digital but was not paid.  The Company believes it has several defenses to this claim and is in the process of communicating with opposing counsel for dismissal of the claims which amount to $386,030.62 plus interest, costs and attorney fees.  The Company has accounted for approximately $600,000 in payables on its consolidated balance sheet as of December 31, 2021 for this subsidiary payable.

 

Lawsuits are being threatened by vendors in relation to tower lease payments in accordance with tower lease agreements that were entered into by SpeedConnect.  The claims are currently being investigated and the amount in controversy being claimed is approximately $3,500,000. The Company has approximately $1,200,000 in accounts payable for these threatened claims as of December 31, 2021.  The claims appear to include lease agreements that have been terminated and future payments not yet due, among other issues.  As such, the parties are trying to come up with resolutions for these claims.

 

The Company has been named in a lawsuit, Robert Serrett vs. TruCom, Inc., by a former employee who was terminated by management in 2016. The employee was working under an employment agreement but was terminated for breach of the agreement. The former employee is suing for breach of contract and is seeking around $75,000 in back pay and benefits. We recently learned that Mr. Serrett received a default judgement in Texas on May 15, 2018 for $70,650 plus $3,500 in attorney fees and 5% interest and court costs.  However, he has made no attempt that we are aware of to obtain a sister state judgment in Arizona, where TruCom resides, or to try and enforce the judgement and collect.  Management believes it has good and meritorious defenses and does not belief the outcome of the lawsuit will have any material effect on the financial position of the Company. 

 

We are not currently involved in any litigation that we believe could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition or results of operations. There is no action, suit, proceeding, inquiry or investigation before or by any court, public board, government agency, self-regulatory organization or body pending or, to the knowledge of the executive officers of our company or any of our subsidiaries, threatened against or affecting our company, our common stock, any of our subsidiaries or of our companies or our subsidiaries’ officers or directors in their capacities as such, in which an adverse decision could have a material adverse effect. We anticipate that we (including current and any future subsidiaries) will from time to time become subject to claims and legal proceedings arising in the ordinary course of business. It is not feasible to predict the outcome of any such proceedings and we cannot assure that their ultimate disposition will not have a materially adverse effect on our business, financial condition, cash flows or results of operations.

 

ITEM 4. MINE SAFETY DISCLOSURE.

 

Not applicable.

 

 
54

Table of Contants

 

PART II

 

ITEM 5. MARKET FOR REGISTRANT’S COMMON EQUITY, RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS AND ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES.

 

Our common stock is currently quoted on the OTC QB under the symbol “TPTW”. Because we are quoted on the OTCQB, our securities may be less liquid, receive less coverage by security analysts and news media, and generate lower prices than might otherwise be obtained if they were listed on a national securities exchange.

 

The following table sets forth the high and low bid quotations for our common stock as reported on the OTCQB for the periods indicated.

 

 

 

2021

 

 

2020

 

 

2019

 

Quarter Ended

 

High

 

 

Low

 

 

High

 

 

Low

 

 

High

 

 

Low

 

March 31

 

$0.10

 

 

$0.03

 

 

$0.011

 

 

$0.0007

 

 

$0.119

 

 

$0.0211

 

June 30

 

$0.04

 

 

$0.01

 

 

$0.037

 

 

$0.002

 

 

$0.198

 

 

$0.0511

 

September 30

 

$0.07

 

 

$0.01

 

 

$0.093

 

 

$0.024

 

 

$0.14

 

 

$0.0432

 

December 31

 

$0.03

 

 

$0.01

 

 

$0.06

 

 

$0.021

 

 

$0.072

 

 

$0.0035

 

 

Holders.

 

As of April 6, 2022, there are approximately 434 record holders of 923,029,038 shares of our common stock.

 

Dividends.

 

As of the filing of this Form 10-K, we have not paid any dividends on our common stock to shareholders. The Series D and Series E Preferred Stock will be paid 6% per annum on a cumulative basis, in cash or in registered common stock. There are no restrictions which would limit our ability to pay dividends on common equity or that are likely to do so in the future. The Florida Revised Statutes, however, do prohibit us from declaring dividends where, after giving effect to the distribution of the dividend; we would not be able to pay our debts as they become due in the usual course of business; or our total assets would be less than the sum of the total liabilities plus the amount that would be needed to satisfy the rights of shareholders who have preferential rights superior to those receiving the distribution.

 

 
55

Table of Contants

 

Common Stock.

 

We are presently authorized to issue two billion five hundred million (2,500,000,000) shares of our $0.001 par value common stock. A total of Nine Hundred Twenty-Three Million, Twenty-Nine Thousand, Thirty-Eight (923,029,038) common shares are issued and outstanding as of April 6, 2022. 

 

Common Shares

 

All common shares are equal to each other with respect to voting, liquidation, and dividend rights. Special shareholders' meetings may be called by the officers or director, or upon the request of holders of at least one-tenth (1/10th) of the outstanding shares. Holders of shares are entitled to one vote at any shareholders' meeting for each share they own as of the record date fixed by the board of directors. There is no quorum requirement for shareholders' meetings. Therefore, a vote of the majority of the shares represented at a meeting will govern even if this is substantially less than a majority of the shares outstanding. Holders of shares are entitled to receive such dividends as may be declared by the board of directors out of funds legally available therefore, and upon liquidation are entitled to participate pro rata in a distribution of assets available for such a distribution to shareholders. There are no conversion, pre-emptive or other subscription rights or privileges with respect to any shares. Reference is made to our Articles of Incorporation and our By-Laws as well as to the applicable statutes of the State of Florida for a more complete description of the rights and liabilities of holders of shares. It should be noted that the board of directors without notice to the shareholders may amend the By-Laws. Our shares do not have cumulative voting rights, which means that the holders of more than fifty percent (50%) of the shares voting for election of directors may elect all the directors if they choose to do so. In such event, the holders of the remaining shares aggregating less than fifty percent (50%) of the shares voting for election of directors may not be able to elect any director.

 

Preferred Stock

 

As of December 31, 2021, we had authorized 100,000,000 shares of Preferred Stock, of which certain shares had been designated as Series A Preferred Stock, Series B Preferred Stock, Series C Preferred Stock and Series D Preferred Stock.

 

Series A Convertible Preferred Stock

 

The Company designated 1,000,000 shares of Preferred Stock as Series A Preferred Stock.  In February 2015, the Board of Directors authorized the issuance of 1,000,000 shares of Series A Preferred Stock to Stephen Thomas, Chairman, CEO and President of the Company, valued at $3,117,000 for compensation expense.  These shares are outstanding as of December 31, 2021.

 

The Series A Preferred Stock has a par value of $.001, is redeemable at the Company’s option at $100 per share, is senior to any other class or series of outstanding Preferred Stock or Common Stock and does not bear dividends. The Series A Preferred Stock has a liquidation preference immediately after any Senior Securities, as defined and amended, of an amount equal to amounts payable owing, including contingency amounts where Holders of the Series A have personally guaranteed obligations of the Company. Holders of the Series A Preferred Stock shall, collectively have the right to convert all of their Series A Preferred Stock when conversion is elected into that number of shares of Common Stock of the Company, determined by the following formula: 60% of the issued and outstanding Common Shares as computed immediately after the transaction for conversion. For further clarification, the 60% of the issued and outstanding common shares includes what the holders of the Series A Preferred Stock may already hold in common shares at the time of conversion. The Series A Preferred Stock, collectively, shall have the right to vote as if converted prior to the vote to a number of shares equal to 60% of the outstanding Common Stock of the Company.

 

During the year ended December 31, 2020, the Series A Preferred Stock was reclassified as mezzanine equity as a result of the Company not having enough authorized common shares to be able to issue common shares upon their conversion.

 

Series B Convertible Preferred Stock

 

In February 2015, the Company designated 3,000,000 shares of Preferred Stock as Series B Convertible Preferred Stock. 

 

The Series B Preferred Stock was designated in February 2015, has a par value of $.001, is not redeemable, is senior to any other class or series of outstanding Preferred Stock, except the Series A Preferred Stock, or Common Stock and does not bear dividends. The Series B Preferred Stock has a liquidation preference immediately after any Senior Securities, as defined and currently the Series A Preferred Stock, and of an amount equal to $2.00 per share. Holders of the Series B Preferred Stock have a right to convert all or any part of the Series B Preferred Shares and will receive and equal number of common shares at the conversion price of $2.00 per share. The Series B Preferred Stockholders have a right to vote on any matter with holders of Common Stock and shall have a number of votes equal to that number of Common Shares on a one-to- one basis.

 

 
56

Table of Contants

 

There are 2,588,693 shares of Series B Convertible Preferred Stock outstanding as of December 31, 2021. During the year ended December 31, 2020, the Series B Preferred Stock was reclassified as mezzanine equity as a result of the Company not having enough authorized common shares to be able to issue common shares upon their conversion.

 

Series C Convertible Preferred Stock

 

In May 2018, the Company designated 3,000,000 shares of Preferred Stock as Series C Convertible Preferred Stock. 

 

The Series C Preferred Stock has a par value of $.001, is not redeemable, is senior to any other class or series of outstanding Preferred Stock, except the Series A and Series B Preferred Stock, or Common Stock and does not bear dividends. The Series C Preferred Stock has a liquidation preference immediately after any Senior Securities, as defined and currently the Series A and B Preferred Stock, and of an amount equal to $2.00 per share. Holders of the Series C Preferred Stock have a right to convert all or any part of the Series C Preferred Shares and will receive an equal number of common shares at the conversion price of $0.15 per share. The Series C Preferred Stockholders have a right to vote on any matter with holders of Common Stock and shall have a number of votes equal to that number of Common Shares on a one-to-one basis.

 

There are no shares of Series C Convertible Preferred Stock outstanding as of December 31, 2021.  There are approximately $688,500 in convertible notes payable convertible into Series C Convertible Preferred Stock which compromise some of the common stock equivalents calculated in Note 1. 

 

Series D Convertible Preferred Stock

 

On July 6, 2020 and September 15, 2021, the Company amended its Series D Designation from January 14, 2020. These Amendments changed the number of shares to 10,000,000 shares of the authorized 100,000,000 shares of the Company's $0.001 par value preferred stock as the Series D Convertible Preferred Stock ("the Series D Preferred Shares.") 

 

Series D Preferred shares have the following features: (i) 6% Cumulative Annual Dividends payable on the purchase value in cash or common stock of the Company at the discretion of the Board and payment is also at the discretion of the Board, which may decide to cumulate to future years; (ii) Any time after 12 months from issuance an option to convert to common stock at the election of the holder @ 75% of the 30 day average market closing price (for previous 30 business days) divided into $5.00. ; (iii) Automatic conversion of the Series D Preferred Stock shall occur without consent of holders upon any national exchange listing approval and the registration effectiveness of common stock underlying the conversion rights. The automatic conversion to common from Series D Preferred shall be @ 75% of the 30 day average market closing price (for previous 30 business days) divided into $5.00, which shall be post-reverse split as may be necessary for any Exchange listing (iv) Registration Rights – the Company has granted Piggyback Registration Rights for common stock underlying conversion rights in the event it files any other Registration Statement (other than an S-1 that the Company may file for certain conversion common shares for the convertible note financing that was arranged and funded in 2019). Further, the Company will file, and pursue to effectiveness, a Registration Statement or offering statement for common stock underlying the Automatic Conversion event triggered by an exchange listing. (v) Liquidation Rights - $5.00 per share plus any accrued unpaid dividends – subordinate to Series A, B, and C Preferred Stock receiving full liquidation under the terms of such series. The Company has redemption rights for the first year following the Issuance Date to redeem all or part of the principal amount of the Series D Preferred Stock at between 115% and 140%.

 

During the year ended December 31, 2021, 46,649 shares of Series D Preferred Share were purchased for $233,244 of which Stephen Thomas, CEO of the Company, acquired 36,649 for $183,244.  The remainder of the shares were purchased by a third party.  

 

As of December 31, 2021, there are 46,649 Series D Preferred shares outstanding.

 

Series E Convertible Preferred Stock

 

On November 10, 2021, the Company designated 10,000,000 shares of the authorized 100,000,000 shares of the Company's $0.001 par value preferred stock as the Series E Convertible Preferred Stock ("the Series E Preferred Shares").

 

Series E Preferred shares have the following features: (i) 6% Cumulative Annual Dividends payable on the purchase value in cash or common stock of the Company at the discretion of the Board and payment is also at the discretion of the Board, which may decide to cumulate to future years; (ii) Any time after 12 months from issuance an option to convert to common stock at the election of the holder @ 75% of the 30 day average market closing price (for previous 30 business days) divided into $5.00. ; (iii) Automatic conversion of the Series D Preferred Stock shall occur without consent of holders upon any national exchange listing approval and the registration effectiveness of common stock underlying the conversion rights. The automatic conversion to common from Series D Preferred shall be @ 75% of the 30 day average market closing price (for previous 30 business days) divided into $5.00, which shall be post-reverse split as may be necessary for any Exchange listing (iv) Registration Rights – the Company has granted Piggyback Registration Rights for common stock underlying conversion rights in the event it files any other Registration Statement (other than an S-1 that the Company may file for certain conversion common shares for the convertible note financing that was arranged and funded in 2019). Further, the Company will file, and pursue to effectiveness, a Registration Statement or offering statement for common stock underlying the Automatic Conversion event triggered by an exchange listing. (v) Liquidation Rights - $5.00 per share plus any accrued unpaid dividends – subordinate to Series A, B, C and D Preferred Stock receiving full liquidation under the terms of such series. The Company has redemption rights for the first year following the Issuance Date to redeem all or part of the principal amount of the Series D Preferred Stock at between 115% and 140%.

 

 
57

Table of Contants

 

As of December 31, 2021, there are no Series E Preferred shares outstanding.

 

During the year ended December 31, 2020, the related party holders of approximately $4,700,000 of existing financing arrangements agreed to exchange their debt and accrued interest for 940,800 Series D Preferred Stock through a separate $12 Million Private Placement of Series D Preferred Stock (“$12 Million Private Placement”), conditioned on the Company raising at least $12,000,000.  To date, this condition has not been met.

 

Securities Authorized for Issuance Under Equity Compensation Plans.

 

None.

 

Recent Sales of Unregistered Securities.

 

Aside from what has been disclosed in our Registration Statement on Form S-1/A dated February 13, 2019, amended December 10, 2019, September 14, 2020 and September 29, 2020, and Registration Statement on Form S-8 dated September 25, 2020, Registration Statement on Form S-1 dated October 28, 2020 and amended on January 15, 2021, Registration Statement on Form S-1 dated June 30, 2021, amended on July 6, 2021 and July 14, 2021, Registration Statement on Form S-1 dated February 25, 2022 and amended March 1, 2022, we have issued the following pursuant to conversions of amounts due under convertible promissory notes.  Otherwise, we have not sold unregistered securities in the past 2 years without registering the securities under the Securities Act of 1933.

 

2021 Conversions

 

 

 

Accrued

 

 

Share

 

 

Price

 

 

 

Date

 

Principal

 

 

Interest

 

 

Amounts

 

 

Per Share

 

Auctus

 

10/13/2020

 

 

423,300

 

 

 

---

 

 

 

15,000,000

 

 

 

0.0275

 

 

 

 

 

 

---

 

 

 

---

 

 

 

---

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

 

 

 

58,000

 

 

 

---

 

 

 

15,000,000

 

 

 

 

 

 

(REMAINDER OF PAGE LEFT BLANK INTENTIONALLY)

 

 
58

Table of Contants

 

2020 Conversions

 

 

 

 

Accrued

 

 

Share

 

 

Price

 

 

 

Date

 

Principal

 

 

Interest

 

 

Amounts

 

 

Per Share

 

Geneva #3

 

1/6/2020

 

 

15,000

 

 

 

 

 

 

6,818,182

 

 

 

0.0022

 

 

 

1/21/2020

 

 

15,100

 

 

 

 

 

 

9,437,500

 

 

 

0.0016

 

 

 

1/27/2020

 

 

14,200

 

 

 

 

 

 

9,466,667

 

 

 

0.0015

 

 

 

1/30/2020

 

 

13,200

 

 

 

 

 

 

9,428,571

 

 

 

0.0014

 

 

 

2/3/2020

 

 

500

 

 

 

3,480

 

 

 

3,618,182

 

 

 

0.0011

 

 

 

 

 

 

58,000

 

 

 

3,480

 

 

 

38,769,102

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Geneva #4

 

2/3/2020

 

 

6,400

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

5,818,182

 

 

 

0.0011

 

 

 

2/7/2020

 

 

8,900

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

11,710,526

 

 

 

0.0008

 

 

 

2/10/2020

 

 

8,900

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

11,710,526

 

 

 

0.0008

 

 

 

2/11/2020

 

 

8,900

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

11,710,526

 

 

 

0.0008

 

 

 

2/12/2020

 

 

10,600

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

13,947,368

 

 

 

0.0008

 

 

 

2/13/2020

 

 

9,300

 

 

 

1,300

 

 

 

13,947,368

 

 

 

0.0008

 

 

 

 

 

 

53,000

 

 

 

1,300

 

 

 

68,844,496

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Auctus

 

1/22/2020

 

 

 

 

 

 

8,250

 

 

 

9,000,000

 

 

 

0.0009

 

 

 

1/31/2020

 

 

 

 

 

 

7,407

 

 

 

11,328,792

 

 

 

0.0007

 

 

 

2/11/2020

 

 

 

 

 

 

5,692

 

 

 

13,419,792

 

 

 

0.0005

 

 

 

2/14/2020

 

 

 

 

 

 

5,692

 

 

 

13,419,792

 

 

 

0.0005

 

 

 

2/20/2020

 

 

 

 

 

 

5,692

 

 

 

13,419,792

 

 

 

0.0005

 

 

 

2/25/2020

 

 

 

 

 

 

8,717

 

 

 

19,723,187

 

 

 

0.0005

 

 

 

3/3/2020

 

 

 

 

 

 

10,626

 

 

 

23,699,083

 

 

 

0.0005

 

 

 

3/9/2020

 

 

 

 

 

 

11,323

 

 

 

25,151,000

 

 

 

0.0005

 

 

 

3/13/2020

 

 

5,593

 

 

 

5,593

 

 

 

29,839,300

 

 

 

0.0004

 

 

 

3/20/2020

 

 

4,784

 

 

 

4,784

 

 

 

32,246,500

 

 

 

0.0003

 

 

 

3/26/2020

 

 

4,365

 

 

 

4,365

 

 

 

33,855,570

 

 

 

0.0003

 

 

 

3/31/2020

 

 

3,125

 

 

 

3,125

 

 

 

25,000,000

 

 

 

0.0003

 

 

 

4/6/2020

 

 

3,536

 

 

 

3,536

 

 

 

27,936,930

 

 

 

0.0003

 

 

 

4/9/2020

 

 

1,006

 

 

 

6,066

 

 

 

27,936,930

 

 

 

0.0003

 

 

 

4/15/2020

 

 

5,574

 

 

 

2,279

 

 

 

30,725,000

 

 

 

0.0003

 

 

 

4/21/2020

 

 

5,197

 

 

 

2,257

 

 

 

29,298,332

 

 

 

0.0003

 

 

 

 

 

 

33,180

 

 

 

95,404

 

 

 

366,000,000

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

JSJ

 

2/10/2020

 

 

3,734

 

 

 

---

 

 

 

5,656,913

 

 

 

0.0007

 

 

 

 

 

 

3,734

 

 

 

 

 

 

5,656,913

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

EMA

 

2/14/2020

 

 

3,546

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

15,500,000

 

 

 

0.0002

 

 

 

2/19/2020

 

 

4,700

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

19,000,000

 

 

 

0.0003

 

 

 

2/24/2020

 

 

5,180

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

20,600,000

 

 

 

0.0003

 

 

 

2/28/2020

 

 

6,080

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

23,600,000

 

 

 

0.0003

 

 

 

3/2/2020

 

 

6,080

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

23,600,000

 

 

 

0.0003

 

 

 

3/10/2020

 

 

7,100

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

27,000,000

 

 

 

0.0003

 

 

 

3/17/2020

 

 

2,680

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

18,400,000

 

 

 

0.0002

 

 

 

 

 

 

35,366

 

 

 

 

 

 

147,700,000

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Odyssey

 

1/8/2020

 

 

10,000

 

 

 

713

 

 

 

5,487,027

 

 

 

0.0020

 

 

 

1/17/2020

 

 

12,000

 

 

 

892

 

 

 

9,191,886

 

 

 

0.0014

 

 

 

2/12/2020

 

 

8,800

 

 

 

729

 

 

 

13,860,465

 

 

 

0.0007

 

 

 

2/25/2020

 

 

12,700

 

 

 

1,106

 

 

 

20,082,138

 

 

 

0.0007

 

 

 

6/3/2020 

 

 

5,650

 

 

 

676

 

 

 

4,340,405

 

 

 

0.0015

 

 

 

 

 

 

49,150

 

 

 

4,116

 

 

 

52,961,921

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Conversions 2020

 

 

 

 

232,430

 

 

 

104,300

 

 

 

679,932,432

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
59

Table of Contants

 

We have filed Forms 8-K with the SEC related to convertible promissory notes for which the underlying common shares have not be registered. Details of the convertible promissory notes can be found at http://sec.gov.

 

Exemption From Registration Claimed

 

All of the above sales by us of our unregistered securities were made by us in reliance upon Rule 506 of Regulation D and Section 4(a)(5) of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the "1933 Act"). All of the individuals and/or entities that purchased the unregistered securities were primarily existing shareholders, known to us and our management, through pre-existing business relationships, as long-standing business associates and employees. All purchasers were provided access to all material information, which they requested, and all information necessary to verify such information and were afforded access to our management in connection with their purchases. All purchasers of the unregistered securities acquired such securities for investment and not with a view toward distribution, acknowledging such intent to us. All certificates or agreements representing such securities that were issued contained restrictive legends, prohibiting further transfer of the certificates or agreements representing such securities, without such securities either being first registered or otherwise exempt from registration in any further resale or disposition.

 

Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities

 

We did not repurchase any shares of our common stock during the year ended December 31, 2021.

 

ITEM 6. RESERVED.

 

ITEM 7. MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS.

 

Forward-Looking Statements and Associated Risks.

 

This Form 10-K contains certain statements that are forward-looking within the meaning of the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. For this purpose, any statements contained in this Form 10-K that are not statements of historical fact may be deemed to be forward-looking statements. Without limiting the foregoing, words such as “may,” “will,” “expect,” “believe,” “anticipate,” “estimate,” “continue,” or comparable terminology are intended to identify forward-looking statements. These statements by their nature involve substantial risks and uncertainties, and actual results may differ materially depending on a variety of factors, many of which are not within our control. These factors include but are not limited to economic conditions generally and in the industries in which we may participate; competition within our chosen industry, including competition from much larger competitors; technological advances and failure to successfully develop business relationships.

 

Based on our financial history since inception, our auditor has expressed substantial doubt as to our ability to continue as a going concern. As reflected in the accompanying financial statements, as of December 31, 2021, we had an accumulated deficit totaling $44,921,837. This raises substantial doubts about our ability to continue as a going concern.

 

We generate revenues primarily through telecommunications and Internet services and as a provider of ecommerce and cloud solutions in the western United States.

 

PLAN OF OPERATIONS

 

Our Capital Budget for the next 12 months

 

Liquidity and Capital Resource Needs

 

If we can raise sufficient capital resources, we intend to expend significant funds after our intended funding event equally throughout 2022 as follows.

 

Equipment purchases and manufacturing

 

$14,000,000

 

Product advancement

 

$2,250,000

 

Acquisitions

 

$500,000

 

Debt Restructuring

 

$7,300,000

 

Working Capital, including marketing

 

$11,470,000

 

Brokerage commissions

 

$2,280,000

 

Offering expenses

 

$200,000

 

 

 

$38,000,000

 

 

 
60

Table of Contants

 

Although the items set forth above indicate management’s present estimate of our use of the net proceeds, we may reallocate the proceeds or utilize them for other corporate purposes. Our actual use of proceeds may vary from these estimates because of a number of factors, including whether we are successful in completing future acquisitions, whether we obtain additional funding, what other obligations have been incurred by us, the operating results of our initial acquisition activities, and whether we are able to operate profitably. If our need for working capital increases, we may seek additional funds through loans or other financing. There are no commitments for any such financing, and there can be no assurance that these funds may be obtained in the future if the need arises.

 

RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

 

For the Year Ended December 31, 2021 Compared to the Year Ended December 31, 2020

 

During the year ended December 31, 2021, we recognized total revenues of $10,029,579 compared to the prior period of $11,094,170. The decrease was primarily a result of the continued loss of net customers within TPT SpeedConnect as a result of the lack of capital to properly update the network and to carry out an effective marketing campaign.

 

Gross profit for the year ended December 31, 2021 was $2,227,404 compared to $3,900,677 for the prior period.  The decrease was due primarily to the decrease in net customers consistent with the decrease in revenues.  This decrease is reflected also in the decrease in gross profit percentage from 35% to 22%.  When the revenue decrease occurs from a decrease in customers, the cost of sales does not always proportionately follow with committed towers contracts in place.

 

During the year ended December 31, 2021, we recognized $8,905,220 in expenses compared to $12,105,016 for the prior period.  The decrease was a result of a lower impairment of goodwill and long-lived assets of $1,709,054 than in the prior year.  In addition, research and development expense was $1,000,000 in the prior year compared to $36,485 in the current year, and depreciation of $682,111 in the current year was much lower than the $1,054,702 in the prior year as a result of the impairment of equipment in the prior year. 

 

There was derivative expense of $3,536,901 in the current year versus a derivative gain of $1,140,323 in the prior year.

 

Gain on extinguishment of $8,470,939 resulted primarily from the payoff of the Auctus Convertible Debt and the recognition of the $1,402,700 in PPP loan forgiveness.

 

Interest expense increased for the year ended December 31, 2021 compared to the prior period by $1,105,399, which decrease is largely from the derivative debt being in default and the increase in convertible note agreements.

 

 Net loss for the current period was $4,095,507 compared to $8,119,268.  The primary reason for the decrease is the gain on debt extinguishment offset by decreases in customer base, an increase in derivative expense, decrease in impairment expense and research and development.

 

LIQUIDITY AND CAPITAL RESOURCES

 

Cash flows generated from operating activities were not enough to support all working capital requirements for the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020. Financing activities described below have helped with working capital and other capital requirements.

 

We incurred $4,095,507 and $8,119,268, respectively, in losses, and we used $995,093 and $489,573, respectively, in cash for operations for the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020. We calculate the net cash used by operating activities by decreasing, or increasing in case of gain, our let loss by those items that do not require the use of cash such as depreciation, amortization, promissory note issued for research and development, note payable issued for legal fees, derivative expense or gain, gain on extinguishment of debt, loss on conversion of notes payable, impairment of goodwill and long-loved assts and share-based compensation which totaled to a net $(1,170,451) for 2021 and $5,378,277 for 2020. 

 

In addition, we report increases and reductions in liabilities as uses of cash and deceases assets and increases in liabilities as sources of cash, together referred to as changes in operating assets and liabilities.  For the year ended December 31, 2021, we had a net increase in our assets and liabilities of $4,270,865 primarily from an increase in accounts payable from lag of payments for accounts payable for cash flow considerations and an increase in the balances from our operating lease liabilities.  For the year ended December 31, 2020 we had a net increase to our assets and liabilities of $2,251,418 for similar reasons.

 

Cash flows from financing activities were $1,169,810 and $817,608 for the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively.  For the year ended December 30, 2021, these cash flows were generated from the sale of Series D Preferred Stock, common stock subscriptions of $610,502, proceeds from convertible notes, loans and advances of $3,900,400 offset by payment on convertible loans, advances and factoring agreements of $3,502,592 and payments on convertible notes and amounts payable – related parties of $64,480.  For the year ended December 31, 2020, cash flows from financing activities primarily came from proceeds from the sale of interest in QuikLABS of $460,000, convertible notes, loans and advances of $1,753,204 offset by payments on convertible loans, advances and factoring agreements of $1,169,330.

 

 
61

Table of Contants

 

Cash flows provided by (used in) investing activities were $324,040 and $(500,898), respectively, for the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020 primarily related to the acquisition of property and equipment and the purchase of intangibles.

 

In December 2019, COVID-19 emerged and has subsequently spread worldwide. The World Health Organization has declared COVID-19 a pandemic resulting in federal, state and local governments and private entities mandating various restrictions, including travel restrictions, restrictions on public gatherings, stay at home orders and advisories and quarantining of people who may have been exposed to the virus. After close monitoring and responses and guidance from federal, state and local governments, in an effort to mitigate the spread of COVID-19, around March 18, 2020 for a period of time, the Company closed its Blue Collar office in Los Angeles and its TPT SpeedConnect offices in Michigan, Idaho and Arizona.  Most employees were working remotely, however this is not possible with certain employees and all subcontractors that work for Blue Collar. The Company continues to monitor developments, including government requirements and recommendations at the national, state, and local level to evaluate possible extensions to all or part of such closures.

 

The Company has taken advantage of the stimulus offerings and received $1,402,700 in PPP loans.  All of these PPP loans were forgiven in the year ended December 31, 2021.  The Company is also in the process of trying to raise debt and equity financing, some of which may have to be used for working capital shortfalls if revenues continue to decline. 

 

In order for us to continue as a going concern for a period of one year from the issuance of these financial statements, we will need to obtain additional debt or equity financing and look for companies with cash flow positive operations that we can acquire. There can be no assurance that we will be able to secure additional debt or equity financing, that we will be able to acquire cash flow positive operations, or that, if we are successful in any of those actions, those actions will produce adequate cash flow to enable us to meet all our future obligations. Most of our existing financing arrangements are short-term. If we are unable to obtain additional debt or equity financing, we may be required to significantly reduce or cease operations.

 

(REMAINDER OF PAGE LEFT BLANK INTENTIONALLY)

 

 
62

Table of Contants

 

A summary of material terms of our financing arrangements as of December 31, 2021 is as follows:

 

 

 

Balance

 

Rate

 

Due Date

 

Past Due

 

Conversion

 

Secured

Third party debt:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Loans and advances

 

$

941,242

 

 

 

3.76-14

%

 

 

May 2020 to March 2021

 

 

$

580,942

 

 

 

None

 

 

Company assets

Convertible Notes Payable

 

 

1,162,606

 

 

 

6-24

%

 

 

(1)

 

 

$

508,771

 

 

 

Convertible at $0.15 to $0.25 per share

 

 

Company stock

Factoring Agreements

 

 

723,754

 

 

 

30-43%

 

 

 

February 2020 to October 2021

 

 

$

101,244

 

 

 

None

 

 

Receivables

Total third party debt

 

$

2,827,602

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Related party debt:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Line of Credit

 

$

3,043,390

 

 

 

1 Mo Libor plus 2.0

%

 

 

(2)

 

 

 

$3,043,390

 

 

 

None

 

 

Trucom assets

Debt (Matrixsites)(5)

 

 

5,000,000

 

 

 

0

%

 

 

(3)

 

 

 

None

 

 

 

None

 

 

VuMe Live assets

42 Debt (Lion Phone)

 

 

350,000

 

 

 

0

%

 

 

None

 

 

 

None

 

 

 

None

 

 

None

Debt (Blue Collar)(4)

 

 

1,600,000

 

 

 

3

%

 

 

August 31, 2020

 

 

 

$1,600,000

 

 

 

None

 

 

Blue Collar assets

Debt (Air Fitness)(6)

 

 

500,000

 

 

 

--- 

 

 

February 1, 2021

 

 

 

500,000

(6)

 

 

None

 

 

Air Fitness assets

Convertible Debt

 

 

902,781

 

 

 

4-6

%

 

 

Various in 2020 and 2021

 

 

 

$902,781

 

 

 

Convertible at $0.15 to $1.00 per share

 

 

Company assets

Shareholder Debt

 

 

49,452

 

 

 

0

%

 

 

None

 

 

 

None

 

 

 

None

 

 

None

Total related party debt

 

$

11,445,623

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total financing arrangements

 

$

14,272,925

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(1)

Various dates from December 2019 to June 2020.

 

 

(2)

Subsequently amended to August 31, 2020.

 

 

(3)

$2,000,000 from debt proceeds and $2,000,000 from a second Company public offering.

 

 

(4)

On September 1, 2018, the Company closed on its acquisition of Blue Collar. Part of the acquisition included a promissory note of $1,600,000 and interest at 3%. The promissory note is secured by the assets of Blue Collar.

 

 

(5)

Matrixsites debt of $4,000,000 does not bear interest, is not convertible and is payable $2,000,000 from debt proceeds and $2,000,000 from a second Company public offering and has a security interest in the assets that were acquired.

 

 

(6)

Air Fitness debt of $500,000 does not bear interest unless in default, is not convertible, is payable six months from origination (August 1, 2020) or as agreed up by the Company and the former owners (currently non-controlling interest holders) of Air Fitness has a security interest in the assets that were acquired. This Note Payable became delinquent subsequent to December 31, 2020.

 

Consequences of not repaying the Blue Collar $1,600,000 debt, the Matrixsites $5,000,000 debt and the Air Fitness $500,000 debt are outlined in the security agreements which are generally the following:

 

The lender (seller) may foreclose on the assets in the event of default of non-payment or other default and may bid in the assets at foreclosure at less than the debt. This could have the practical effect of taking away the assets pledged, through the foreclosure and, may leave a deficiency under the note, which would mean the company would have none of the assets and still retain liability for an unknown amount, and have no business related to these acquisitions.

 

 
63

Table of Contants

 

CRITICAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES

 

Revenue Recognition

 

On January 1, 2018, we adopted the new accounting standard ASC 606, Revenue from Contracts with Customers, and all of the related amendments (“new revenue standard”). We recorded the change, which was immaterial, related to adopting the new revenue standard using the modified retrospective method. Under this method, we recognized the cumulative effect of initially applying the new revenue standard as an adjustment to the opening balance of retained earnings. This results in no restatement of prior periods, which continue to be reported under the accounting standards in effect for those periods. We expect the impact of the adoption of the new revenue standard to continue to be immaterial on an ongoing basis. We have applied the new revenue standard to all contracts as of the date of initial application and as such, have used the following criteria described below in more detail for each business unit:

 

Identify the contract with the customer.

Identify the performance obligations in the contract.

Determine the transaction price.

Allocate the transaction price to performance obligations in the contract.

Recognize revenue when or as we satisfy a performance obligation. 

 

Reserves are recorded as a reduction in net sales and are not considered material to our consolidated statements of income for the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020. In addition, we invoice our customers for taxes assessed by governmental authorities such as sales tax and value added taxes, where applicable. We present these taxes on a net basis.

 

The Company’s revenue generation for the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020 came from the following sources disaggregated by services and products, which sources are explained in detail below.

 

 

 

For the year ended

December 31, 2021

 

 

For the year ended

December 31, 2020 

 

TPT SpeedConnect

 

$7,579,003

 

 

$9,958,770

 

Blue Collar

 

 

1,545,721

 

 

 

1,051,120

 

TPT MedTech

 

 

155,919

 

 

 

30,484

 

Other (1)

 

 

179,757

 

 

 

14,405

 

Total Services Revenues

 

$9,460,400

 

 

$11,054,779

 

TPT MedTech – Product Revenue

 

 

566,689

 

 

 

 

K Telecom – Product Revenue

 

 

2,490

 

 

 

39,391

 

Total Product Revenues

 

$569,179

 

 

$39,391

 

Total Revenue

 

$10,029,579

 

 

$11,094,170

 

 

 

(1)

Includes international sales for the year ended December 31, 2021 of $165,834 related to TPT Asia.

 

TPT SpeedConnect: ISP and Telecom Revenue

 

TPT SpeedConnect is a rural Internet provider operating in 10 Midwestern States under the trade name SpeedConnect. TPT SC’s primary business model is subscription based, pre-paid monthly reoccurring revenues, from wireless delivered, high-speed internet connections. In addition, the company resells third-party satellite and DSL internet and IP telephony services. Revenue generated from sales of telecommunications services is recognized as the transaction with the customer is considered closed and the customer receives and accepts the services that were the result of the transaction. There are no financing terms or variable transaction prices. Due date is detailed on monthly invoices distributed to customer. Services billed monthly in advance are deferred to the proper period as needed. Deferred revenue are contract liabilities for cash received before performance obligations for monthly services are satisfied. Deferred revenue for TPT SpeedConnect at December 31, 2021 and 2020 are $421,643 and $292,847, respectively. Certain of our products require specialized installation and equipment. For telecom products that include installation, if the installation meets the criteria to be considered a separate element, product revenue is recognized upon delivery, and installation revenue is recognized when the installation is complete. The Installation Technician collects the signed quote containing terms and conditions when installing the site equipment at customer premises.

 

Revenue for installation services and equipment is billed separately from recurring ISP and telecom services and is recognized when equipment is delivered and installation is completed. Revenue from ISP and telecom services is recognized monthly over the contractual period, or as services are rendered and accepted by the customer.

 

 
64

Table of Contants

 

The overwhelming majority of our revenue continues to be recognized when transactions occur. Since installation fees are generally small relative to the size of the overall contract and because most contracts are for two years or less, the impact of not recognizing installation fees over the contract is immaterial.

 

Blue Collar: Media Production Services

 

Blue Collar creates original live action and animated content productions and has produced hundreds of hours of material for the television, theatrical, home entertainment and new media markets. Blue Collar designs branding and marketing campaigns and has had agreements with some of the world’s largest companies including PepsiCo, Intel, HP, WalMart and many other Fortune 500 companies. Additionally, they create motion picture, television and home entertainment marketing campaigns for studios including Sony, DreamWorks, Twentieth Century Fox, Universal Studios, Paramount Studios, and Warner Brothers. With regard to revenue recognition, Blue Collar receives an agreement from each client to perform defined work. Some agreements are written, some are verbal. Work may include creation of marketing materials and/or content creation. Some work may be short term and take weeks to create and some work may be longer and take months to create. There are instances where customer agreements segregate identifiable obligations (like filming on site vs. film editing and final production) with separate transaction pricing. The performance obligation is generally satisfied upon delivery of such film or production products, at which time revenue is recognized. There are no financing terms or variable transaction prices.

 

TPT MedTech: Medical Testing Revenue

 

TPT MedTech operates in the Point of Care Testing (“POCT”) market by primarily offering mobile medical testing facilities and software equipped for mobile devices to monitor and manage personalized healthcare.  Services used from our mobile medical testing facilities are billing through credit cards at the time of service.  Revenue is generated from our software platform as users sign up for our mobile healthcare monitor and management application and tests are performed.  If medical testing is in one our own owned facility, the usage of the software application is included in the testing fees.  If the testing is in a non-owned outside contracted facility, fees are generated from the usage of the software application on a per test basis and billed monthly.

 

TPT MedTech also offers various products.  One is to build and sell its mobile testing facilities called QuikLABs designed for mobile testing.  This is used by TPT MedTech for its own testing services.  Another is to build customized mobile gyms for exercising.  This is sold to third parties.  Another is medical equipment, one of which is a sanitizing unit called SANIQuik which is used as a safe and flexible way to sanitize providing an additional routine to hand washing and facial coverings.  The SANIQuik has not yet been approved for sale in the United States but has in some parts of the European community.  Revenues from these products are recognized when a product is delivered, the sales transaction considered closed and accepted by a customer.  When deposits are received for which a product has not been delivered, it is recognized as deferred revenue.  Deferred revenue as of December 31, 2021 and 2020 was $41,000 and $41,000, respectively. There are no financing terms or variable transaction prices for either of these products.

 

SDM: Ecommerce, Email Marketing and Web Design Services

 

SDM generates revenue by providing ecommerce, email marketing and web design solutions to small and large commercial businesses, complete with monthly software support, updates and maintenance. Services are billed monthly. There are no financing terms or variable transaction prices. Platform infrastructure support is a prepaid service billed in monthly recurring increments. The services are billed a month in advance and due prior to services being rendered. The revenue is deferred when invoiced and booked in the month the service is provided. There is no deferred revenue at December 31, 2021 and 2020. Software support services (including software upgrades) are billed in real time, on the first of the month. Web design service revenues are recognized upon completion of specific projects. Revenue is booked in the month the services are rendered and payments are due on the final day of the month. There are usually no contract revenues that are deferred until services are performed.

 

K Telecom: Prepaid Phones and SIM Cards Revenue

 

K Telecom generates revenue from reselling prepaid phones, SIM cards, and rechargeable minute traffic for prepaid phones to its customers (primarily retail outlets). Product sales occur at the customer’s locations, at which time delivery occurs and cash or check payment is received. The Company recognizes the revenue when they receive payment at the time of delivery. There are no financing terms or variable transaction prices.

 

 
65

Table of Contants

 

Copperhead Digital: ISP and Telecom Revenue

 

Copperhead Digital operated as a regional internet and telecom services provider operating in Arizona under the trade name Trucom.  Although there are currently no customers and it will take capital to reopen this revenue stream, Copperhead Digital operated as a wireless telecommunications Internet Service Provider (“ISP”) facilitating both residential and commercial accounts. Copperhead Digital’s primary business model was subscription based, pre-paid monthly reoccurring revenues, from wireless delivered, high-speed internet connections. In addition, the company resold third-party satellite and DSL internet and IP telephony services. Revenue generated from sales of telecommunications services was recognized as the transaction with the customer is considered closed and the customer received and accepted the services that were the result of the transaction. There are no financing terms or variable transaction prices. Due date was detailed on monthly invoices distributed to customer. Services billed monthly in advance were deferred to the proper period as needed. Deferred revenue was contract liabilities for cash received before performance obligations for monthly services are satisfied. Certain of its products required specialized installation and equipment. For telecom products that included installation, if the installation met the criteria to be considered a separate element, product revenue was recognized upon delivery, and installation revenue was recognized when the installation was complete. The Installation Technician collected the signed quote containing terms and conditions when installing the site equipment at customer premises.

 

Revenue for installation services and equipment was billed separately from recurring ISP and telecom services and was recognized when equipment was delivered, and installation was completed. Revenue from ISP and telecom services was recognized monthly over the contractual period, or as services were rendered and accepted by the customer.

 

The overwhelming majority of revenue was recognized when transactions occurred. Since installation fees were generally small relative to the size of the overall contract and because most contracts were for a year or less, the impact of not recognizing installation fees over the contract was immaterial.

 

Use of Estimates

 

The preparation of financial statements in conformity with United States generally accepted accounting principles requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities, disclosures of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ materially from those estimates. The Company’s consolidated financial statements reflect all adjustments that management believes are necessary for the fair presentation of their financial condition and results of operations for the periods presented. 

 

Share-based Compensation

 

We are required to measure and recognize compensation expense for all share-based payment awards (including stock options) made to employees and directors based on estimated fair value. Compensation expense for equity-classified awards is measured at the grant date based on the fair value of the award and is recognized as an expense in earnings over the requisite service period.

 

We record compensation expense related to non-employees that are awarded stock in conjunction with selling goods or services and recognize compensation expenses over the vesting period of such awards.

 

In June 2018, the FASB issued ASU No. 2018-07, Improvements to Nonemployee Share-Based Payment Accounting, which amends ASC 718, Compensation – Stock Compensation. This ASU requires that most of the guidance related to stock compensation granted to employees be followed for non-employees, including the measurement date, valuation approach, and performance conditions. The expense is recognized in the same period as though cash were paid for the good or service. The effective date is the first quarter of fiscal year 2020, with early adoption permitted, including in interim periods. The ASU has been adopted using a modified-retrospective transition approach. The adoption is not considered to have a material effect on the consolidated financial statements.

 

Income Taxes

 

Deferred tax assets and liabilities are recognized for the future tax consequences attributable to differences between the financial statement carrying amounts of existing assets and liabilities and their respective tax bases. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured using enacted tax rates expected to apply to taxable income in the year in which those temporary differences are expected to be recovered or settled. The effect on deferred tax assets and liabilities of a change in tax rates is recognized in our income tax provision in the period of enactment.

 

We recognize deferred tax assets to the extent that we believe that these assets are more likely than not to be realized. In making such a determination, we consider all available positive and negative evidence, including future reversal of existing taxable temporary differences, projected future taxable income, tax-planning strategies, and results of recent operations, including taxable income in carryback periods. If we determine that we would be able to realize our deferred tax assets in the future in excess of their net recorded amount, we would make an adjustment to the deferred tax asset valuation allowance, which would reduce our income tax provision.

 

 
66

Table of Contants

 

We account for uncertain tax positions using a “more-likely-than-not” recognition threshold. We evaluate uncertain tax positions on a quarterly basis and consider various factors, including, but not limited to, changes in tax law, the measurement of tax positions taken or expected to be taken in tax returns, the effective settlement of matters subject to audit, new audit activity and changes in facts or circumstances related to a tax position.

 

During November 2015, the FASB issued Accounting Standards Update No. 2015-17, ASU 2015-17, Balance Sheet Classification of Deferred Taxes, which simplifies the presentation of deferred income taxes. ASU 2015-17 requires that deferred tax assets and liabilities be classified as non-current in a statement of financial position. We adopted ASU 2015-17 effective December 31, 2015.

 

It is our policy to record costs associated with interest and penalties related to tax in the selling, general and administrative line of the consolidated statements of operations.

 

Goodwill

 

Goodwill relates to amounts that arose in connection with our various business combinations and represents the difference between the purchase price and the fair value of the identifiable tangible and intangible net assets when accounted for using the acquisition method of accounting. Goodwill is not amortized, but it is subject to periodic review for impairment.

 

We test goodwill balances for impairment on an annual basis as of December 31st or whenever impairment indicators arise. We utilize several reporting units in evaluating goodwill for impairment using a quantitative assessment, which uses a combination of a guideline public company market-based approach and a discounted cash flow income-based approach. The quantitative assessment considers whether the carrying amount of a reporting unit exceeds its fair value, in which case an impairment charge is recorded to the extent the reporting unit’s carrying value exceeds its fair value. Based on our impairment testing, we recorded impairment charges of $663,434 and $853,366 of goodwill during the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively.

 

Intangible Assets

 

Our intangible assets consist primarily of customer relationships, developed technology, favorable leases, trademarks and the film library. The majority of our intangible assets were recorded in connection with our various business combinations. Our intangible assets are recorded at fair value at the time of their acquisition.  Intangible assets are amortized over their estimated useful life on a straight-line basis. Estimated useful lives are determined considering the period the assets are expected to contribute to future cash flows. We evaluate the recoverability of our intangible assets periodically and take into account events or circumstances that warrant revised estimates of useful lives or that indicate impairment exists. 

 

Business Acquisitions

 

Our business acquisitions have historically been made at prices above the fair value of the assets acquired and liabilities assumed, resulting in goodwill or some identifiable intangible asset. Significant judgment is required in estimating the fair value of intangible assets and in assigning their respective useful lives. The fair value estimates are based on available historical information and on future expectations and assumptions deemed reasonable by management but are inherently uncertain.

 

We generally employ the income method to estimate the fair value of intangible assets, which is based on forecasts of the expected future cash flows attributable to the respective assets. Significant estimates and assumptions inherent in the valuations reflect a consideration of other marketplace participants and include the amount and timing of future cash flows (including expected growth rates and profitability), the underlying product life cycles, economic barriers to entry, a brand’s relative market position and the discount rate applied to the cash flows. Unanticipated market or macroeconomic events and circumstances may occur, which could affect the accuracy or validity of the estimates and assumptions.

 

Net assets acquired are recorded at their fair value and are subject to adjustment upon finalization of the fair value analysis. 

 

Long-Lived Assets 

 

We periodically review the carrying amount of our depreciable long-lived assets for impairment which include property and equipment and intangible assets. An asset is considered impaired when estimated future cash flows are less than the carrying amount of the asset. In the event the carrying amount of such asset is not considered recoverable, the asset is adjusted to its fair value. Fair value is generally determined based on discounted future cash flow.  As of December 31, 2020, we adjusted the net book values of the equipment of Copperhead Digital as it became doubtful given the decrease in customers bases that the estimated future cash flows would recover the net book values.  We recorded impairment expenses of $330,508 and $1,849,630 for the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively.

  

 
67

Table of Contants

 

Leases

 

In February 2016, the FASB issued ASU 2016-02, Leases (Topic 842) and subsequent amendments to the initial guidance: ASU 2017-13, ASU 2018-10, ASU 2018-11, ASU 2018-20 and ASU 2019-01 (collectively, Topic 842). Topic 842 requires lessees to classify leases as either finance or operating leases and to record a right-of-use asset and a lease liability for all leases with a term greater than 12 months regardless of the lease classification. We adopted Topic 842 using the effective date, January 2019, as the date of our initial application of the standard. Consequently, financial information for the comparative periods has been updated. Our finance and operating lease commitments are subject to the new standard and we recognize as finance and operating lease liabilities and right-of-use assets. 

 

Research and Development

 

Our research and development programs focus on telecommunications products and services. Research and development costs are expensed as incurred. Any payments received from external parties to fund our research and development activities reduce the recorded research and development expenses.

 

Basic and Diluted Net Loss Per Share

 

The Company computes net income (loss) per share in accordance with ASC 260, “Earning per Share””. ASC 260 requires presentation of both basic and diluted earnings per share (“EPS”) on the face of the income statement. Basic EPS is computed by dividing net income (loss) available to common shareholder (numerator) by the weighted average number of shares outstanding (denominator) during the period. Diluted EPS gives effect to all dilutive potential common shares outstanding during the period using the treasury stock method and convertible preferred stock using the if-converted method. In computing diluted EPS, the average stock price for the period is used in determining the number of shares assumed to be purchased from the exercise of stock options or warrants. Diluted EPS excludes all dilutive potential shares if their effect is anti-dilutive. As of December 31, 2021, the Company had shares that were potentially common stock equivalents as follows:

 

 

 

2021

 

Convertible Promissory Notes

 

 

429,623,112

 

Series A Preferred Stock (1)

 

 

1,349,817,125

 

Series B Preferred Stock

 

 

2,588,693

 

Series D Preferred Stock (2)

 

 

25,297,722

 

Stock Options and warrants

 

 

111,000,000

 

 

 

 

1,918,326,652

 

_________________

 

(1)

Holder of the Series A Preferred Stock which is Stephen J. Thomas, is guaranteed 60% of outstanding common stock upon conversion. The Company would have to authorize additional shares for this to occur as only 1,250,000,000 shares were authorized as of December 31, 2021 and 2,500,000,000 as of April 6, 2022.

 

 

 

 

(2)

Holders of the Series D Preferred Stock may decide after 12 months to convert to common stock @ 75% of the 30 day average market closing price (for previous 30 business days) divided into $5.00. There is also an automatic conversion of the Series D Preferred Stock without consent of holders upon any national exchange listing approval and the registration effectiveness of common stock underlying the conversion rights. The automatic conversion to common from Series D Preferred shall be @ 75% of the 30 day average market closing price (for previous 30 business days) divided into $5.00.

 

In the event of default under some of the notes, the conversion rates change significantly, allowing certain noteholders to convert at a greater discount to the market, which results in amounts of issuable shares which cannot be determined at this time.  An estimate of the issuable shares is reflected below.

 

Derivative Financial Instruments

 

Derivative financial instruments, as defined in ASC 815, “Accounting for Derivative Financial Instruments and Hedging Activities”, consist of financial instruments or other contracts that contain a notional amount and one or more underlying (e.g. interest rate, security price or other variable), require no initial net investment and permit net settlement. Derivative financial instruments may be free-standing or embedded in other financial instruments. Further, derivative financial instruments are initially, and subsequently, measured at fair value and recorded as liabilities or, in rare instances, assets.

 

The Company does not use derivative financial instruments to hedge exposures to cash-flow, market or foreign-currency risks. However, the Company had issued financial instruments including convertible promissory notes payable with features during 2019 that were either (i) not afforded equity classification, (ii) embody risks not clearly and closely related to host contracts, or (iii) may be net-cash settled by the counterparty. As required by ASC 815, in certain instances, these instruments are required to be carried as derivative liabilities, at fair value, in our financial statements. 

 

 
68

Table of Contants

 

The Company estimates the fair values of derivative financial instruments using the Monte Carlo model. Estimating fair values of derivative financial instruments requires the development of significant and subjective estimates (such as volatility, estimated life and interest rates) that may, and are likely to, change over the duration of the instrument with related changes in internal and external market factors. In addition, option-based techniques are highly volatile and sensitive to changes in the trading market price of our common stock, which has a high-historical volatility. Since derivative financial instruments are initially and subsequently carried at fair values, the Company’s operating results will reflect the volatility in these estimate and assumption changes.

 

The Company issued convertible promissory notes which are convertible into common stock, at holders’ option, at a discount to the market price of the Company’s common stock. The Company has identified the embedded derivatives related to these notes relating to certain anti-dilutive (reset) provisions. These embedded derivatives included certain conversion features. The accounting treatment of derivative financial instruments requires that the Company record fair value of the derivatives as of the inception date of debenture and to fair value as of each subsequent reporting date.

 

As of December 31, 2021, the Company marked to market the fair value of the debt derivatives and determined a fair value of $4,042,910 ($3,057,026 from the convertible notes and $985,884 from the warrants) in Note 6. The Company recorded an expense of $3,536,901 and gain of $1,140,323 from change in fair value of debt derivatives for the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively. The fair value of the embedded derivatives was determined using Monte Carlo simulation method based on the following assumptions: (1) dividend yield of 0%, (2) expected volatility of 115.4% to 298.6%, (3) weighted average risk-free interest rate of 0.06% to 1.26% (4) expected life of 0.25 to 4.79 years, and (5) the quoted market price of $0.011 for the Company’s common stock.

 

COVID-19

 

In December 2019, COVID-19 emerged and has subsequently spread worldwide. The World Health Organization has declared COVID-19 a pandemic resulting in federal, state and local governments and private entities mandating various restrictions, including travel restrictions, restrictions on public gatherings, stay at home orders and advisories and quarantining of people who may have been exposed to the virus. After close monitoring and responses and guidance from federal, state and local governments, in an effort to mitigate the spread of COVID-19, around March 18, 2020 for a period of time, the Company closed its Blue Collar office in Los Angeles and its TPT SpeedConnect offices in Michigan, Idaho and Arizona.  Most employees were working remotely, however this is not possible with certain employees and all subcontractors that work for Blue Collar. The Company continues to monitor developments, including government requirements and recommendations at the national, state, and local level to evaluate possible extensions to all or part of such closures.

 

The Company has taken advantage of the stimulus offerings and received $1,402,700 in PPP loans.  All of these PPP loans were forgiven in the year ended December 31, 2021.  The Company is also in the process of trying to raise debt and equity financing, some of which may have to be used for working capital shortfalls if revenues continue to decline. 

 

The Company is also in the process of raising debt and equity financing. Through December 31, 2021, the Company raised $855,094 from sales of Common Stock and Series D Preferred Stock. Some of this was by way of its agreement with White Lion where they agreed to provide the Company of up to $5,000,000 through a registration statement that was filed with the SEC.   In addition, subsequent to December 31, 2021, the Company entered into convertible promissory notes for a total of $543,500.

 

As the COVID-19 pandemic is complex and rapidly evolving, the Company's plans as described above may change. At this point, we cannot reasonably estimate the duration and severity of this pandemic, which could have a material adverse impact on our business, results of operations, financial position and cash flows.

 

ITEM 7A. QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK.

 

We are a smaller reporting company as defined by Rule 12b-2 of the Securities Act of 1934 and are not required to provide the information under this item.

 

 
69

Table of Contants

 

ITEM 8. FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA.

 

TPT GLOBAL TECH, INC.

 CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

For the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020

 

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM (PCAOB ID: 3627) 

 

F-1 – F-3

 

 

 

 

 

CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS

 

F-4

 

 

 

 

 

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS

 

F-6

 

 

 

 

 

CONSLIDATED STATEMENTS OF STOCKHOLDERS’ DEFICIT

 

F-7

 

 

 

 

 

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

 

F-8

 

 

 

 

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

 

F-10 – F-38

 

 

 
70

Table of Contants

 

 REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

 

 

To the Board of Directors and Shareholders of TPT Global Tech, Inc.:

 

Opinion on the Financial Statements

 

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of TPT Global Tech, Inc. (“the Company”) as of December 31, 2021 and 2020, the related consolidated statements of operations, stockholders’ deficit, and cash flows for each of the years in the two-year period ended December 31, 2021 and the related notes (collectively referred to as the “financial statements”). In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the Company as of December 31, 2021 and 2020, and the results of its operations and its cash flows for each of the years in the two-year period ended December 31, 2021, in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.

 

Explanatory Paragraph Regarding Going Concern

 

The accompanying financial statements have been prepared assuming that the Company will continue as a going concern. As discussed in Note 3 to the financial statements, the Company has suffered recurring losses from operations and has a net capital deficiency which raises substantial doubt about its ability to continue as a going concern. Management's plans in regard to these matters are also described in Note 3. The financial statements do not include any adjustments that might result from the outcome of this uncertainty.

 

Basis for Opinion

 

These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s financial statements based on our audits.  We are a public accounting firm registered with the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (“PCAOB”) and are required to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.

 

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement, whether due to error or fraud. The Company is not required to have, nor were we engaged to perform, an audit of its internal control over financial reporting. As part of our audits, we are required to obtain an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, but not for the purpose of expressing an opinion on the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting. Accordingly, we express no such opinion.

 

Our audits included performing procedures to assess the risks of material misstatement of the financial statements, whether due to error or fraud, and performing procedures that respond to those risks.  Such procedures included examining on a test basis, evidence regarding the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements.  Our audits also included evaluating the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the financial statements.  We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion. 

 

Critical Audit Matters

 

The critical audit matters communicated below are matters arising from the current period audit of the financial statements that were communicated or required to be communicated to the audit committee and that: (1) related to accounts or disclosures that are material to the financial statements and (2) involved our especially challenging, subjective, or complex judgements. The communication of critical audit matters does not alter in any way our opinion on the financial statements, taken as a whole, and we are not, by communicating the critical matters below, providing separate opinions on the critical audit matters or on the accounts or disclosures to which they relate.

 

Long-Lived Asset Impairment Assessment

 

Critical Audit Matter Description

 

As described in Note 1 to the consolidated financial statements, the Company performs impairment testing for its long-lived assets when events or changes in circumstances indicate that carrying amount of its long-lived asset groups may not be recoverable and exceeds its fair value.  An impairment exists when the carrying value of the long-lived group is not recoverable and the impairment is measured by the difference in the carrying value of the long-lived asset group and its fair value. Due to challenging industry and economic conditions, the Company tested its long-lived assets at December 31, 2021.   The Company’s recoverability analysis requires management to prepare an undiscounted future cash flow model which requires management to make significant estimates and assumptions related to forecasted revenues, gross margin, other operating expenses, and income taxes over the remaining useful life of the assets.  Management determined the fair value of each long-lived asset group based on a discounted cash flow model which utilized the same significant estimates and assumptions noted above along with significant assumptions related to the long term growth rate and appropriate discount rate. As a result of this impairment review, the Company recorded an impairment charge of $330,508 at December 31, 2021. 

 

 
F-1

Table of Contants

  

We identified the evaluation of the impairment analysis for long-lived assets as a critical audit matter because of the significant estimates and assumptions management used in the related cash flow analysis. Performing audit procedures to evaluate the reasonableness of these estimates and assumptions required a high degree of auditor judgment and an increased extent of effort.

 

How the Critical Audit Matter Was Addressed in the Audit

 

Our audit procedures related to the following:

 

·         Testing management’s process for developing the undiscounted cash flow model used in the recoverability tests and the discounted cash flow model used, as applicable, in the impairment test.

 

·         Evaluating the appropriateness and mechanical accuracy of the cash flow models used by management.

 

·         Testing the completeness and accuracy of underlying data used in the respective models.

 

·         Evaluating the significant assumptions used by management in the models, including assumptions related to revenues, gross margin, other operating expenses, income taxes, long-term growth rate, and discount rate to discern whether they are reasonable considering (i) the current and past performance of the entity; (ii) the consistency with external market and industry data; and (iii) whether these assumptions were consistent with evidence obtained in other areas of the audit.

 

Goodwill Impairment Assessment

 

Critical Audit Matter Description

 

As discussed in Note 11, on December 31, 2021, the Company had a goodwill balance of $104,657 and had recognized goodwill impairment expense for the year ended December 31, 2021 of $663,434.  As described in Note 1 to the consolidated financial statements, the Company tests goodwill for impairment annually at the reporting unit level, or more frequently, if events or circumstances indicate it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit is less than its carrying amount. Reporting units are tested for impairment by comparing the estimated fair value of each reporting unit with the carrying amount of such reporting unit. If the carrying amount of a reporting unit exceeds its estimated fair value, an impairment loss is recorded based on the difference between the fair value and carrying amount, not to exceed the associated carrying amount of goodwill. To determine the fair value of the reporting unit, management prepared a discounted cash flow model for each reporting unit. The significant assumptions and estimates used by management in the models included assumptions and estimates related to revenues, gross margin, other operating expenses, income taxes, long-term growth rate, and discount rate. The Company’s annual impairment test occurred on December 31, 2021. 

 

We identified the evaluation of the impairment analysis for goodwill as a critical audit matter because of the significant estimates and assumptions management used in the discounted cash flow analysis performed by management to determine fair value of the reporting unit. Performing audit procedures to evaluate the reasonableness of these estimates and assumptions required a high degree of auditor judgment and an increased extent of effort.

  

 
F-2

Table of Contants

 

How the Critical Audit Matter Was Addressed in the Audit

 

Our audit procedures related to the following: 

 

·         Testing management’s process for developing the discounted cash flow models used to determine the fair value of the respective reporting units.

 

·         Evaluating the appropriateness  and mechanical accuracy of the discounted cash flow models used by management.

 

·         Testing the completeness and accuracy of underlying data used in the discounted cash flow models.

 

·         Evaluating the significant assumptions used by management, including assumptions related to revenues, gross margin, other operating expenses, income taxes, long term growth rate, and discount rate to discern whether they are reasonable considering (i) the current and past performance of the entity; (ii) the consistency with external market and industry data; and (iii) whether these assumptions were consistent with evidence obtained in other areas of the audit.

 

Determination and Valuation of Derivative Liabilities

 

Critical Audit Matter Description

 

As described further in Note 6 of the consolidated financial statements, during the year ended December 31, 2021 and in prior periods, the Company issued convertible notes and warrants that required management to assess whether the conversion features of the convertible notes required bifurcation and separate valuation as a derivative liability and whether the warrants required accounting as derivative liabilities. The Company determined that the conversion features of certain of its convertible notes and certain warrants issued in financing arrangements required to be accounted for as derivative liabilities due to: (1) certain conversion features did not contain an explicit limit on the number of shares to be delivered in share settlement; and (2) the fact the Company could not assert it had sufficient authorized but unissued shares available to settle certain instruments considering all other stock-based commitments. The derivative liabilities were recorded at fair value when issued and subsequently re-measured to fair value upon settlement or at the end of each reporting period.  The Company utilized valuation models to determine the fair value of the derivative liabilities depending on the features embedded in the instruments.  These models use certain assumptions related to exercise price, term, expected volatility, and risk-free interest rate.

 

We identified auditing the determination and valuation of the derivative liabilities as a critical audit matter due to the significant judgements used by the Company in determining whether the embedded conversion features and warrants required derivative accounting treatment and the significant judgements used in determining the fair value of the derivative liabilities. Auditing the determination and valuation of the derivative liabilities involved a high degree of auditor judgement, and specialized skills and knowledge were needed. 

 

How the Critical Audit Matter Was Addressed in the Audit

 

Our audit procedures included the following, among others:

 

·         We inspected and reviewed debt agreements, warrant agreements, conversion notices, and settlement agreements to evaluate the Company's determination of whether derivative accounting was required, including assessing and evaluating management's application of relevant accounting standards to such transactions. 

 

·         We evaluated the reasonableness and appropriateness of the choice of valuation model used for each specific derivative instrument.

 

·         We tested the reasonableness of the assumptions used by the Company in the valuation models, including exercise price, term, expected volatility, and risk-free interest rate.

 

·         We tested the accuracy and completeness of data used by the Company in developing the assumptions used in the valuation models.

 

·         We developed an independent expectation for comparison to the Company's estimate, which included developing our own valuation model and assumptions.

 

·         We evaluated the accuracy and completeness of the Company's presentation of these instruments in the financial statements and related disclosures in Note 6, including evaluating whether such disclosures were in accordance with relevant accounting standards. 

 

·         Professionals with specialized skill and knowledge were utilized by the Firm to assist in the evaluation of the valuation models deployed by management.

 

/s/ Sadler, Gibb & Associates, LLC
 
We have served as the Company’s auditor since 2016. 
  

Draper, UT

 

April 14, 2022 

 

 

 
F-3

Table of Contants

 

TPT Global Tech, Inc.

CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS

 

ASSETS

 

 

 

December 31,

 

 

 

2021

 

 

2020

 

CURRENT ASSETS

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents

 

$518,066

 

 

$19,309

 

Accounts receivable, net

 

 

101,935

 

 

 

164,818

 

Prepaid expenses and other current assets

 

 

122,428

 

 

 

180,362

 

Total current assets

 

 

742,429

 

 

 

364,489

 

NON-CURRENT ASSETS

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Property and equipment, net

 

 

1,649,022

 

 

 

2,145,597

 

Operating lease right of use assets

 

 

4,259,758

 

 

 

4,732,459

 

Intangible assets, net

 

 

3,656,241

 

 

 

4,714,941

 

Goodwill

 

 

104,657

 

 

 

768,091

 

Deposits and other assets

 

 

265,318

 

 

 

111,111

 

Total non-current assets

 

 

9,934,996

 

 

 

12,472,199

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

TOTAL ASSETS

 

$10,677,425

 

 

$12,836,688

 

 

LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' DEFICIT

 

Current liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

Accounts payable and accrued expenses

 

$9,653,093

 

 

$7,866,140

 

Deferred revenue

 

 

462,643

 

 

 

341,789

 

Customer liability

 

 

338,725

 

 

 

338,725

 

Current portion of loans, advances and factoring agreements

 

 

1,446,571

 

 

 

2,308,753

 

Current portion of convertible notes payable, net of discounts

 

 

1,162,606

 

 

 

1,711,098

 

Notes payable – related parties, net of discounts

 

 

10,542,842

 

 

 

10,559,796

 

Current portion of convertible notes payable – related party, net of discounts

 

 

902,781

 

 

 

922,481

 

Derivative liabilities

 

 

4,042,910

 

 

 

5,265,139

 

Current portion of operating lease liabilities

 

 

3,987,405

 

 

 

2,682,722

 

Financing lease liabilities

 

 

284,055

 

 

 

184,939

 

Financing lease liability – related party

 

 

682,704

 

 

 

654,633

 

Total current liabilities

 

 

33,506,335

 

 

 

32,836,215

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

NON-CURRENT LIABILITIES

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Long term portion:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Loans, advances and factoring agreements, net of current portion and discounts

 

 

218,425

 

 

 

843,577

 

Operating lease liabilities, net of current portion

 

 

2,976,623

 

 

 

2,872,952

 

Total non-current liabilities

 

 

3,195,048

 

 

 

3,716,529

 

Total liabilities

 

36,701,383

 

 

36,552,744

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commitments and contingencies

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

 

 
F-4

Table of Contants

 

TPT Global Tech, Inc.

CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS - CONTINUED

 

 

 

December 31,

 

 

December 31,

 

 

 

2021

 

 

2020

 

MEZZANINE EQUITY

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Convertible Preferred Series A, 1,000,000 designated - 1,000,000 shares issued and outstanding as of December 31, 2021 and 2020

 

$3,117,000

 

 

3,117,000

 

Convertible Preferred Series B, 3,000,000 designated - 2,588,693 shares issued and outstanding as of December 31, 2021 and 2020

 

 

1,677,473

 

 

 

1,677,473

 

Convertible Preferred Series C – 3,000,000 shares designated, zero shares issued and outstanding as of December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

Convertible Preferred Series D – 10,000,000 shares designated, 46,649 and zero shares issued and outstanding as of December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively

 

 

244,592

 

 

 

-

 

Convertible Preferred Series E – 10,000,000 shares designated,  zero shares issued and outstanding as of December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

Total mezzanine equity

 

$5,039,065

 

 

4,794,473

 

 

STOCKHOLDER’S DEFICIT

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

PREFERRED STOCK, $.001 PAR VALUE 100,000,000 SHARES AUTHORIZED:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Common stock, $0.001 par value, 1,250,000,000 shares authorized, 923,029,038 and 865,564,371 as of December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively

 

923,029

 

 

865,565

 

Subscriptions payable

 

 

5,610

 

 

 

125,052

 

Additional paid-in capital

 

 

12,860,873

 

 

 

11,462,940

 

Accumulated deficit

 

 

(44,921,837 )

 

 

(40,902,944 )

Total TPT Global Tech, Inc. Stockholders’ deficit

 

 

(31,132,325 )

 

 

(28,449,387 )

Non-controlling interests

 

 

69,302

 

 

 

(61,142 )

Total stockholders' deficit

 

 

(31,063,023 )

 

 

(28,510,529 )

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

TOTAL LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' DEFICIT

 

$10,677,425

 

 

$12,836,688

 

 

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

 

 
F-5

Table of Contants

 

TPT Global Tech, Inc.

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS

 

 

 

For the years ended December 31,

 

 

 

2021

 

 

2020

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Revenues:

 

 

 

 

 

 

Products

 

$569,179

 

 

$39,391

 

Services

 

 

9,460,400

 

 

 

11,054,799

 

Total Revenues

 

 

10,029,579

 

 

 

11,094,170

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

COST OF SALES:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Products

 

 

437,958

 

 

 

38,455

 

Services

 

 

7,364,217

 

 

 

7,155,038

 

Total Costs of Sales

 

 

7,802,175

 

 

 

7,193,493

 

Gross profit

 

 

2,227,404

 

 

 

3,900,677

 

OPERATING EXPENSES:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Sales and marketing

 

 

20,281

 

 

 

55,776

 

Professional

 

 

1,493,467

 

 

 

2,077,770

 

Payroll and related

 

 

2,624,667

 

 

 

2,502,461

 

General and administrative

 

 

2,362,560

 

 

 

1,980,371

 

Research and development

 

 

-

 

 

 

1,000,000

 

Impairment of goodwill and long-lived assets

 

 

993,942

 

 

 

2,702,996

 

Depreciation

 

 

682,111

 

 

 

1,054,702

 

Amortization

 

 

728,192

 

 

 

730,940

 

Total operating expenses

 

 

8,905,220

 

 

 

12,105,016

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Loss from operations

 

 

(6,677,816 )

 

 

(8,204,339 )

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

OTHER INCOME (EXPENSE)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Derivative gain (expense)

 

 

(3,536,901 )

 

 

1,140,323

 

Gain on debt extinguishment

 

 

8,470,939

 

 

 

1,252,131

 

Gain (loss) on debt conversions

 

 

-

 

 

 

(775,650 )

Interest expense

 

 

(2,637,132 )

 

 

(1,531,733 )

Other gains, net

 

 

285,403

 

 

 

-

 

Total other income (expense)

 

 

2,582,309

 

 

 

85,071

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net loss before income taxes

 

 

(4,095,507 )

 

 

(8,119,268 )

Income taxes

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

Net loss before non-controlling interests

 

 

(4,095,507 )

 

(8,119,268 )

Net loss attributable to non-controlling interests

 

 

76,614

 

 

 

47,417

 

Net loss attributable to TPT Global Tech, Inc. Shareholders

 

$(4,018,893 )

 

(8,071,851 )

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Loss per common shares-basic and diluted

 

$(0.00 )

 

$(0.01 )

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted-average common shares outstanding-basic and diluted

 

 

889,406,311

 

 

 

740,163,898

 

 

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements. 

 

 
F-6

Table of Contants

 

TPT Global Tech, Inc.

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF STOCKHOLDERS' DEFICIT

For the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020

 

 

 

Series A

Preferred Stock

 

 

Series B

Preferred Stock

 

 

Common Stock

 

 

Subscriptions 

 

 

Additional

Paid-in

 

 

Accumulated

 

 

Non-

Controlling

 

 

Total

Stockholders’

 

 

 

Shares

 

 

Amount

 

 

Shares

 

 

Amount

 

 

Shares

 

 

Amount

 

 

Payable

 

 

 Capital

 

 

Deficit

 

 

Interest

 

 

Deficit

 

Balance as of

December 31, 2019

 

 

1,000,000

 

 

$1,000

 

 

 

2,588,693

 

 

$2,589

 

 

 

177,629,939

 

 

$177,630

 

 

$574,256

 

 

$13,279,749

 

 

$(32,831,093)

 

$-

 

 

$(18,795,869)

Common stock issued for services

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

7,002,000

 

 

 

7,002

 

 

 

(812,773)

 

 

859,771

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

54,000

 

Common stock issuable for services

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

363,569

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

363,569

 

Equity interest in QuikLABS issued for cash

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

368,000

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

92,000

 

 

 

460,000

 

Acquisition of Air Fitness

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

113,333

 

 

 

113,333

 

Common stock issued for settlement of liability

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

1,000,000

 

 

 

1,000

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

57,000

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

58,000

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Reclassification of preferred stock as mezzanine

 

 

(1,000,000)

 

 

(1,000)

 

 

(2,588,693)

 

 

(2,589)

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

(4,790,884)

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

(4,794,473)

Common stock issued for convertible promissory notes

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

679,932,432

 

 

 

679,933

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

1,470,246

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

2,150,179

 

InnovaQor merger

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

219,058

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

(219,058)

 

 

-

 

Net Loss

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

(8,071,851)

 

 

(47,417)

 

 

(8,119,268)

Balance as of December 31, 2020

 

 

-

 

 

$-

 

 

 

-

 

 

$-

 

 

 

865,564,371

 

 

$865,565

 

 

$125,052

 

 

$11,462,940

 

 

$(40,902,944)

 

$(61,142)

 

$(28,510,529)

Common stock issued for services or subscription payable

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

5,964,667

 

 

 

5,965

 

 

 

(119,442)

 

 

336,188

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

222,711

 

Equity interest in QuikLABS issued for cash

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

8,000

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

2,000

 

 

 

10,000

 

Refund of equity interest in QuikLABS

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

(56,000)

 

 

-

 

 

 

(14,000)

 

 

(70,000)

Common  shares issued in exchange for debt

 

 

-

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

22,500,000

 

 

 

22,500

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

747,300

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

769,800

 

Common  shares issued for cash

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

29,000,000

 

 

 

28,999

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

581,503

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

610,502

 

TPT Strategic license cancellation

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(219,058)

 

 

-

 

 

 

219,058

 

 

 

-

 

Net Loss

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

(4,018,893)

 

 

(76,614)

 

 

(4,095,507)

Balance as of December 31, 2021

 

 

-

 

 

$-

 

 

 

-

 

 

$-

 

 

 

923,029,038

 

 

$923,029

 

 

$5,610

 

 

$12,860,873

 

 

$(44,921,837)

 

$69,302

 

 

$(31,063,023)

 

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

 

 
F-7

Table of Contants

 

TPT Global Tech, Inc.

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

 

 

 

For the years ended December 31,

 

 

 

2021

 

 

2020

 

Cash flows from operating activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net loss

 

$(4,095,507)

 

$(8,119,268)

Adjustments to reconcile net loss to net cash used in operating activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Depreciation

 

 

682,111

 

 

 

1,054,702

 

Amortization

 

 

728,192

 

 

 

730,940

 

Debt discount amortization and other financing costs

 

 

1,622,035

 

 

 

738,794

 

Promissory note issued for research and development

 

 

-

 

 

 

1,000,000

 

Note payable issued for legal fees

 

 

-

 

 

 

350,000

 

Gain on conversion of notes payable

 

 

-

 

 

 

775,650)

Gain on disposition of assets

 

 

(485,404)

 

 

-

 

Derivative expense (gain)

 

 

3,536,901

 

 

 

(1,140,323)

Forgiveness of debt

 

 

(8,470,939)

 

 

(1,252,131)

Loss on impairment

 

 

993,942

 

 

 

2,702,996

 

Common stock issued for services

 

 

222,711

 

 

 

417,649

 

Changes in operating assets and liabilities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Accounts receivable

 

 

62,883

 

 

 

254,022)

Prepaid expenses and other assets

 

 

(139,069)

 

 

(138,339)

Accounts payable and accrued expenses

 

 

2,345,145

 

 

 

1,314,086

 

Other liabilities

 

 

120,851

 

 

 

43,969

 

Net change in operating lease assets and liabilities

 

 

1,881,055

 

 

 

777,680

 

Net cash used in operating activities

 

 

(995,093)

 

 

(489,573)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash flows from investing activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Acquisition of property and equipment, net of sales

 

 

(223,419)

 

 

(424,560)

Insurance proceeds from property and equipment

 

 

547,459

 

 

 

-

 

Purchase of intangibles

 

 

-

 

 

 

(76,798)

Payment for business acquisitions, net of cash acquired

 

 

-

 

 

 

460)

Net cash used in investing activities

 

 

324,040

 

 

 

(500,898)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash flows from financing activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Proceeds from sale of non-controlling interests in QuikLABS, net

 

 

10,000

 

 

 

460,000

 

Proceeds from sales of Series D Preferred Stock

 

 

233,244

 

 

 

-

 

Proceeds from sale of common stock

 

 

610,502

 

 

 

-

 

Proceeds from convertible notes, loans and advances

 

 

3,900,400

 

 

 

1,753,204

 

Payments on convertible loans, advances and factoring agreements

 

 

(3,502,592)

 

 

(1,169,330)

Payments on convertible notes and amounts payable – related parties

 

 

(64,480)

 

 

(212,256)

Proceeds from convertible notes and notes payable – related parties

 

 

-

 

 

 

2,400

 

Payments on financing lease liabilities

 

 

(17,264)

 

 

(16,410)

Net cash provided by financing activities

 

 

1,169,810

 

 

 

817,608

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net change in cash

 

 

498,757

 

 

 

(172,863)

Cash and cash equivalents – beginning of period

 

 

19,309

 

 

 

192,172

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents – end of period

 

$518,066

 

 

$19,309

 

 

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

 

 
F-8

Table of Contants

 

TPT Global Tech, Inc.

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS - CONTINUED 

 

Supplemental Cash Flow Information:

 

Cash used for:

 

 

 

2021

 

 

2020

 

Interest expense

 

$-

 

 

$-

 

Taxes

 

$-

 

 

$-

 

 

Non-Cash Investing and Financing Activity:

 

 

 

2021

 

 

2020

 

Debt discount on convertible promissory notes

 

$2,174,000

 

 

$634,341

 

Common stock issued for conversion of convertible notes

 

$769,800

 

 

$2,258,637

 

Convertible Preferred Series A and B reclassified to mezzanine equity

 

$-

 

 

$4,790,884

 

Acquisition of Air Fitness – Liabilities assumed

 

$-

 

 

$610,919

 

Purchase of property and equipment under finance leases

 

$-

 

 

$201,349

 

InnovaQor Merger- non controlling interest

 

$(219,058 )

 

$219,058

 

 

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

 

 
F-9

Table of Contants

 

TPT Global Tech, Inc.

NOTES TO
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
DECEMBER 31, 2021

 

NOTE 1 - DESCRIPTION OF BUSINESS AND SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES

 

Nature of Operations

 

The Company was originally incorporated in 1988 in the state of Florida. TPT Global, Inc., a Nevada corporation formed in June 2014, merged with Ally Pharma US, Inc., a Florida corporation, (“Ally Pharma”, formerly known as Gold Royalty Corporation) in a “reverse merger” wherein Ally Pharma issued 110,000,000 shares of Common Stock, or 80% ownership, to the owners of TPT Global, Inc. in exchange for all outstanding common stock of TPT Global Inc. and Ally Pharma agreed to change its name to TPT Global Tech, Inc. (jointly referred to as “the Company” or “TPTG”).

 

The following acquisitions have resulted in entities which have been consolidated into TPTG since the reverse merger in 2014.

 

Name

 

Herein referred to as

 

Acquisition or

Incorporation Date

 

Ownership

TPT Global Tech, Inc.

 

Company or TPTG

 

 

1988

 

 

 

100

%

K Telcom and Wireless LLC

 

K Telecom

 

 

2014

 

 

 

100

%

Global Telecom International LLC

 

Global Telecom

 

 

2014

 

 

 

100

%

Copperhead Digital Holdings, Inc.

 

Copperhead Digital or CDH

 

 

2015

 

 

 

100

%

TruCom, LLC

 

TruCom

 

 

2015

 

 

 

100

%

Nevada Utilities, Inc.

 

Nevada Utilities

 

 

2015

 

 

 

100

%

CityNet Arizona, LLC

 

CityNet

 

 

2015

 

 

 

100

%

San Diego Media Inc.

 

SDM

 

 

2016

 

 

 

100

%

Blue Collar Production, Inc.

 

Blue Collar

 

 

2018

 

 

 

100

%

TPT SpeedConnect, LLC

 

TPT SpeedConnect

 

 

2019

 

 

 

100

%

TPT Federal, LLC

 

TPT Federal

 

 

2020

 

 

 

100

%

TPT MedTech, LLC

 

TPT MedTech

 

 

2020

 

 

 

100

%

InnovaQor, Inc./TPT Strategic, Inc.

 

InnovaQor and TPT Strategic

 

 

2020

 

 

 

94

%

QuikLab 1 LLC

 

Quiklab 1

 

 

2020

 

 

 

80

%

QuikLAB 2, LLC

 

QuikLAB 2

 

 

2020

 

 

 

80

%

QuikLAB 3, LLC

 

QuikLAB 3

 

 

2020

 

 

 

80

%

The Fitness Container, LLC

 

Air Fitness

 

 

2020

 

 

 

75

%

TPT Global Tech Asia Limited

 

TPT Asia

 

 

2020

 

 

 

78

%

TPT MedTech UK LTD

 

TPT MedTech UK

 

 

2020

 

 

 

100

%

TPT Global Defense Systems, Inc.

 

TPT Global Defense

 

 

2-19-21

 

 

 

100

%

TPT Innovations Technology, Inc.

 

TPT Innovations

 

 

2-19-21

 

 

 

100

%

TPT Global Caribbean Inc.

 

TPT Caribbean

 

 

6-10-21

 

 

 

100

%

TPT Media and Entertainment, LLC

 

TPT Media and Entertainment

 

 

6-14-21

 

 

 

100

%

VuMe Live, LLC

 

VuMe Live

 

 

11-17-21

 

 

 

100

%

Digithrive, LLC

 

Digithrive

 

 

12-31-21

 

 

 

100

%

 

We are based in San Diego, California, and operate as a technology-based company with divisions providing telecommunications, medical technology and product distribution, media content for domestic and international syndication as well as technology solutions. We operate on our own proprietary Global Digital Media TV and Telecommunications infrastructure platform and also provide technology solutions to businesses domestically and worldwide. We offer Software as a Service (SaaS), Technology Platform as a Service (PAAS), Cloud-based Unified Communication as a Service (UCaaS) and carrier-grade performance and support for businesses over our private IP MPLS fiber and wireless network in the United States. Our cloud-based UCaaS services allow businesses of any size to enjoy all the latest voice, data, media and collaboration features in today's global technology markets. We also operate as a Master Distributor for Nationwide Mobile Virtual Network Operators (MVNO) and Independent Sales Organization (ISO) as a Master Distributor for Pre-Paid Cellphone services, Mobile phones, Cellphone Accessories and Global Roaming Cellphones.

 

 
F-10

Table of Contants

 

SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES

 

Principles of Consolidation

 

Our consolidated financial statements include the wholly-owned accounts, as well as, non-controlling interests where appropriate.  All intercompany accounts and transactions have been eliminated in consolidation.

 

Use of Estimates

 

The preparation of financial statements in conformity with United States generally accepted accounting principles requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities, disclosures of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ materially from those estimates. The Company’s consolidated financial statements reflect all adjustments that management believes are necessary for the fair presentation of their financial condition and results of operations for the periods presented.

 

Reclassifications

 

Certain amounts presented in previously issued financial statements have been reclassified in these financial statements. During 2020, development expense of $122,763 was recorded in marketing expense in the statement of operations and has been reclassified to general and administrative expenses to be consistent with the current period presentation.

 

Revenue Recognition

 

On January 1, 2018, we adopted the new accounting standard ASC 606, Revenue from Contracts with Customers, and all of the related amendments (“new revenue standard”). We recorded the change, which was immaterial, related to adopting the new revenue standard using the modified retrospective method. Under this method, we recognized the cumulative effect of initially applying the new revenue standard as an adjustment to the opening balance of retained earnings. This results in no restatement of prior periods, which continue to be reported under the accounting standards in effect for those periods. We expect the impact of the adoption of the new revenue standard to continue to be immaterial on an ongoing basis. We have applied the new revenue standard to all contracts as of the date of initial application and as such, have used the following criteria described below in more detail for each business unit:

 

Identify the contract with the customer.

Identify the performance obligations in the contract.

Determine the transaction price.

Allocate the transaction price to performance obligations in the contract.

Recognize revenue when or as we satisfy a performance obligation. 

 

Reserves are recorded as a reduction in net sales and are not considered material to our consolidated statements of operations for the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020. In addition, we invoice our customers for taxes assessed by governmental authorities such as sales tax and value added taxes, where applicable. We present these taxes on a net basis.

 

The Company’s revenue generation for the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020 came from the following sources disaggregated by services and products, which sources are explained in detail below.

 

 

 

For the year ended

December 31, 2021

 

 

For the year ended

December 31, 2020 

 

TPT SpeedConnect

 

$7,579,003

 

 

$9,958,770

 

Blue Collar

 

 

1,545,721

 

 

 

1,051,120

 

TPT MedTech

 

 

155,919

 

 

 

30,484

 

Other (1)

 

 

179,757

 

 

 

14,405

 

Total Services Revenues

 

$9,460,400

 

 

$11,054,779

 

TPT MedTech – Product Revenue

 

 

566,689

 

 

 

-

 

K Telecom – Product Revenue

 

 

2,490

 

 

 

39,391

 

Total Product Revenues

 

$569,179

 

 

$39,391

 

Total Revenue

 

$10,029,579

 

 

$11,094,170

 

 

 

(1)

Includes international sales for the year ended December 31, 2021 of $165,834 related to TPT Asia.

 

 
F-11

Table of Contants

 

TPT SpeedConnect: ISP and Telecom Revenue

 

TPT SpeedConnect is a rural Internet provider operating in 10 Midwestern States under the trade name SpeedConnect. TPT SC’s primary business model is subscription based, pre-paid monthly reoccurring revenues, from wireless delivered, high-speed internet connections. In addition, the company resells third-party satellite and DSL internet and IP telephony services. Revenue generated from sales of telecommunications services is recognized as the transaction with the customer is considered closed and the customer receives and accepts the services that were the result of the transaction. There are no financing terms or variable transaction prices. Due date is detailed on monthly invoices distributed to customer. Services billed monthly in advance are deferred to the proper period as needed. Deferred revenue are contract liabilities for cash received before performance obligations for monthly services are satisfied. Deferred revenue for TPT SpeedConnect at December 31, 2021 and 2020 are $421,643 and $292,847, respectively. Certain of our products require specialized installation and equipment. For telecom products that include installation, if the installation meets the criteria to be considered a separate element, product revenue is recognized upon delivery, and installation revenue is recognized when the installation is complete. The Installation Technician collects the signed quote containing terms and conditions when installing the site equipment at customer premises.

 

Revenue for installation services and equipment is billed separately from recurring ISP and telecom services and is recognized when equipment is delivered and installation is completed. Revenue from ISP and telecom services is recognized monthly over the contractual period, or as services are rendered and accepted by the customer.

 

The overwhelming majority of our revenue continues to be recognized when transactions occur. Since installation fees are generally small relative to the size of the overall contract and because most contracts are for two years or less, the impact of not recognizing installation fees over the contract is immaterial.

 

Blue Collar: Media Production Services 

 

Blue Collar creates original live action and animated content productions and has produced hundreds of hours of material for the television, theatrical, home entertainment and new media markets. Blue Collar designs branding and marketing campaigns and has had agreements with some of the world’s largest companies including PepsiCo, Intel, HP, WalMart and many other Fortune 500 companies. Additionally, they create motion picture, television and home entertainment marketing campaigns for studios including Sony, DreamWorks, Twentieth Century Fox, Universal Studios, Paramount Studios, and Warner Brothers. With regard to revenue recognition, Blue Collar receives an agreement from each client to perform defined work. Some agreements are written, some are verbal. Work may include creation of marketing materials and/or content creation. Some work may be short term and take weeks to create and some work may be longer and take months to create. There are instances where customer agreements segregate identifiable obligations (like filming on site vs. film editing and final production) with separate transaction pricing. The performance obligation is generally satisfied upon delivery of such film or production products, at which time revenue is recognized. There are no financing terms or variable transaction prices.

 

TPT MedTech: Medical Testing Revenue

 

TPT MedTech operates in the Point of Care Testing (“POCT”) market by primarily offering mobile medical testing facilities and software equipped for mobile devices to monitor and manage personalized healthcare.  Services used from our mobile medical testing facilities are billing through credit cards at the time of service.  Revenue is generated from our software platform as users sign up for our mobile healthcare monitor and management application and tests are performed.  If medical testing is in one our own owned facility, the usage of the software application is included in the testing fees.  If the testing is in a non-owned outside contracted facility, fees are generated from the usage of the software application on a per test basis and billed monthly.

 

TPT MedTech also offers various products.  One is to build and sell its mobile testing facilities called QuikLABs designed for mobile testing.  This is used by TPT MedTech for its own testing services.  Another is to build customized mobile gyms for exercising.  This is sold to third parties.  Another is medical equipment, one of which is a sanitizing unit called SANIQuik which is used as a safe and flexible way to sanitize providing an additional routine to hand washing and facial coverings.  The SANIQuik has not yet been approved for sale in the United States but has in some parts of the European community.  Revenues from these products are recognized when a product is delivered, the sales transaction considered closed and accepted by a customer.  When deposits are received for which a product has not been delivered, it is recognized as deferred revenue.  Deferred revenue as of December 31, 2021 and 2020 was $41,000 and $41,000, respectively. There are no financing terms or variable transaction prices for either of these products.

 

 
F-12

Table of Contants

 

SDM: Ecommerce, Email Marketing and Web Design Services

 

SDM generates revenue by providing ecommerce, email marketing and web design solutions to small and large commercial businesses, complete with monthly software support, updates and maintenance. Services are billed monthly. There are no financing terms or variable transaction prices. Platform infrastructure support is a prepaid service billed in monthly recurring increments. The services are billed a month in advance and due prior to services being rendered. The revenue is deferred when invoiced and booked in the month the service is provided. There is no deferred revenue at December 31, 2021 and 2020. Software support services (including software upgrades) are billed in real time, on the first of the month. Web design service revenues are recognized upon completion of specific projects. Revenue is booked in the month the services are rendered and payments are due on the final day of the month. There are usually no contract revenues that are deferred until services are performed.

 

K Telecom: Prepaid Phones and SIM Cards Revenue

 

K Telecom generates revenue from reselling prepaid phones, SIM cards, and rechargeable minute traffic for prepaid phones to its customers (primarily retail outlets). Product sales occur at the customer’s locations, at which time delivery occurs and cash or check payment is received. The Company recognizes the revenue when they receive payment at the time of delivery. There are no financing terms or variable transaction prices.

 

Copperhead Digital: ISP and Telecom Revenue

 

Copperhead Digital operated as a regional internet and telecom services provider operating in Arizona under the trade name Trucom.  Although there are currently no customers and it will take capital to reopen this revenue stream, Copperhead Digital operated as a wireless telecommunications Internet Service Provider (“ISP”) facilitating both residential and commercial accounts. Copperhead Digital’s primary business model was subscription based, pre-paid monthly reoccurring revenues, from wireless delivered, high-speed internet connections. In addition, the company resold third-party satellite and DSL internet and IP telephony services. Revenue generated from sales of telecommunications services was recognized as the transaction with the customer is considered closed and the customer received and accepted the services that were the result of the transaction. There are no financing terms or variable transaction prices. Due date was detailed on monthly invoices distributed to customer. Services billed monthly in advance were deferred to the proper period as needed. Deferred revenue was contract liabilities for cash received before performance obligations for monthly services are satisfied. Certain of its products required specialized installation and equipment. For telecom products that included installation, if the installation met the criteria to be considered a separate element, product revenue was recognized upon delivery, and installation revenue was recognized when the installation was complete. The Installation Technician collected the signed quote containing terms and conditions when installing the site equipment at customer premises.

 

Revenue for installation services and equipment was billed separately from recurring ISP and telecom services and was recognized when equipment was delivered, and installation was completed. Revenue from ISP and telecom services was recognized monthly over the contractual period, or as services were rendered and accepted by the customer.

 

The overwhelming majority of revenue was recognized when transactions occurred. Since installation fees were generally small relative to the size of the overall contract and because most contracts were for a year or less, the impact of not recognizing installation fees over the contract was immaterial.

 

Cost of Sales

 

Cost of sales includes all of the costs and expenses directly related to the production of goods and services included in revenues.

 

Share-based Compensation

 

The Company is required to measure and recognize compensation expense for all share-based payment awards (including stock options) made to employees and directors based on estimated fair value. Compensation expense for equity-classified awards is measured at the grant date based on the fair value of the award and is recognized as an expense in earnings over the requisite service period.

 

The Company records compensation expense related to non-employees that are awarded stock in conjunction with selling goods or services and recognizes compensation expenses over the vesting period of such awards.

 

Income Taxes

 

Deferred tax assets and liabilities are recognized for the future tax consequences attributable to differences between the financial statement carrying amounts of existing assets and liabilities and their respective tax bases. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured using enacted tax rates expected to apply to taxable income in the year in which those temporary differences are expected to be recovered or settled. The effect on deferred tax assets and liabilities of a change in tax rates is recognized in our income tax provision in the period of enactment.

 

We recognize deferred tax assets to the extent that we believe that these assets are more likely than not to be realized. In making such a determination, we consider all available positive and negative evidence, including future reversal of existing taxable temporary differences, projected future taxable income, tax-planning strategies, and results of recent operations, including taxable income in carryback periods. If we determine that we would be able to realize our deferred tax assets in the future in excess of their net recorded amount, we would make an adjustment to the deferred tax asset valuation allowance, which would reduce our income tax provision.

 

 
F-13

Table of Contants

 

We account for uncertain tax positions using a “more-likely-than-not” recognition threshold. We evaluate uncertain tax positions on a quarterly basis and consider various factors, including, but not limited to, changes in tax law, the measurement of tax positions taken or expected to be taken in tax returns, the effective settlement of matters subject to audit, new audit activity and changes in facts or circumstances related to a tax position.

 

It is our policy to record costs associated with interest and penalties related to tax in the selling, general and administrative line of the consolidated statements of operations.

 

Cash and Cash Equivalents

 

The Company considers all investments with a maturity date of three months or less when purchased to be cash equivalents. There are no cash equivalents as of December 31, 2021 and 2020.

 

Accounts Receivable

 

We establish an allowance for potential uncollectible accounts receivable. All accounts receivable 60 days past due are considered uncollectible unless there are circumstances that support collectability. Those circumstances are documented. As of December 31, 2021 and 2020, the allowance for uncollectible accounts receivable was $225,000 and $762,815, respectively. Receivables are charged off when collection efforts cease.

 

Property and Equipment

 

Property and equipment are stated at cost or fair value if acquired as part of a business combination. Depreciation is computed by the straight-line method and is charged to operations over the estimated useful lives of the assets. Maintenance and repairs are charged to expense as incurred. The carrying amount of accumulated depreciation of assets sold or retired are removed from the accounts in the year of disposal and any resulting gain or loss in s included in results of operations. The estimated useful lives of property and equipment are telecommunications network - 5 years, telecommunications equipment - 7 to 10 years, and computers and office equipment - 3 years.

 

Goodwill

 

Goodwill relates to amounts that arose in connection with our various business combinations and represents the difference between the purchase price and the fair value of the identifiable tangible and intangible net assets when accounted for using the acquisition method of accounting. Goodwill is not amortized, but it is subject to periodic review for impairment.

 

We test goodwill balances for impairment on an annual basis as of December 31st or whenever impairment indicators arise. We utilize several reporting units in evaluating goodwill for impairment using a quantitative assessment, which uses a combination of a guideline public company market-based approach and a discounted cash flow income-based approach. The quantitative assessment considers whether the carrying amount of a reporting unit exceeds its fair value, in which case an impairment charge is recorded to the extent the reporting unit’s carrying value exceeds its fair value. Based on our impairment testing, we recorded impairment charges of $663,434 and $853,366 of goodwill during the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively.

 

Intangible Assets

 

Our intangible assets consist primarily of customer relationships, developed technology, favorable leases, trademarks and the film library. The majority of our intangible assets were recorded in connection with our various business combinations. Our intangible assets are recorded at fair value at the time of their acquisition.  Intangible assets are amortized over their estimated useful life on a straight-line basis. Estimated useful lives are determined considering the period the assets are expected to contribute to future cash flows. We evaluate the recoverability of our intangible assets periodically and take into account events or circumstances that warrant revised estimates of useful lives or that indicate impairment exists. Based on our recoverability testing, we recorded impairment charges of $330,508 during the year ended December 31, 2021.

 

 

F-14

Table of Contants

   

Business Acquisitions

 

Our business acquisitions have historically been made at prices above the fair value of the assets acquired and liabilities assumed, resulting in goodwill or some identifiable intangible asset. Significant judgment is required in estimating the fair value of intangible assets and in assigning their respective useful lives. The fair value estimates are based on available historical information and on future expectations and assumptions deemed reasonable by management but are inherently uncertain.

 

We generally employ the income method to estimate the fair value of intangible assets, which is based on forecasts of the expected future cash flows attributable to the respective assets. Significant estimates and assumptions inherent in the valuations reflect a consideration of other marketplace participants and include the amount and timing of future cash flows (including expected growth rates and profitability), the underlying product life cycles, economic barriers to entry, a brand’s relative market position and the discount rate applied to the cash flows. Unanticipated market or macroeconomic events and circumstances may occur, which could affect the accuracy or validity of the estimates and assumptions.

 

Net assets acquired are recorded at their fair value and are subject to adjustment upon finalization of the fair value analysis. 

 

Long-Lived Assets 

 

We periodically review the carrying amount of our depreciable long-lived assets for impairment which include property and equipment and intangible assets. An asset is considered impaired when estimated future cash flows are less than the carrying amount of the asset. In the event the carrying amount of such asset is not considered recoverable, the asset is adjusted to its fair value. Fair value is generally determined based on discounted future cash flow.  As of December 31, 2020, we adjusted the net book values of the equipment of Copperhead Digital as it became doubtful given the decrease in customers bases that the estimated future cash flows would recover the net book values.  We recorded impairment expenses $1,849,630 for the year ended December 31, 2020.

 

Leases

 

In February 2016, the FASB issued ASU 2016-02, Leases (Topic 842) and subsequent amendments to the initial guidance: ASU 2017-13, ASU 2018-10, ASU 2018-11, ASU 2018-20 and ASU 2019-01 (collectively, Topic 842). Topic 842 requires lessees to classify leases as either finance or operating leases and to record a right-of-use asset and a lease liability for all leases with a term greater than 12 months regardless of the lease classification. We adopted Topic 842 using the effective date, January 2019, as the date of our initial application of the standard. Consequently, financial information for the comparative periods has been updated. Our finance and operating lease commitments are subject to the new standard and we recognize as finance and operating lease liabilities and right-of-use assets.

 

Basic and Diluted Net Loss Per Share

 

The Company computes net income (loss) per share in accordance with ASC 260, “Earning per Share””. ASC 260 requires presentation of both basic and diluted earnings per share (“EPS”) on the face of the income statement. Basic EPS is computed by dividing net income (loss) available to common shareholder (numerator) by the weighted average number of shares outstanding (denominator) during the period. Diluted EPS gives effect to all dilutive potential common shares outstanding during the period using the treasury stock method and convertible preferred stock using the if-converted method. In computing diluted EPS, the average stock price for the period is used in determining the number of shares assumed to be purchased from the exercise of stock options or warrants. Diluted EPS excludes all dilutive potential shares if their effect is anti-dilutive. As of December 31, 2021 and 2020, the Company had shares that were potentially common stock equivalents as follows:

 

 

 

2021

 

 

2020

 

Convertible Promissory Notes

 

 

429,623,112

 

 

 

175,316,748

 

Series A Preferred Stock (1)

 

 

1,349,817,125

 

 

 

1,243,987,624

 

Series B Preferred Stock

 

 

2,588,693

 

 

 

2,588,693

 

Series D Preferred Stock

 

 

25,297,722

 

 

 

-

 

Stock Options and warrants

 

 

111,000,000

 

 

 

4,333,333

 

 

 

 

1,918,326,652

 

 

 

1,426,226,398

 

_____________________ 

(1)

Holder of the Series A Preferred Stock which is Stephen J. Thomas, is guaranteed 60% of the then outstanding common stock upon conversion. The Company would have to authorize additional shares for this to occur as only 1,250,000,000 shares were authorized as of December 31, 2021 and 2,500,000,000 as of April 6, 2022.

 

Concentration of Credit Risk, Off-Balance Sheet Risks and Other Risks and Uncertainties

 

Financial instruments that potentially subject us to concentration of credit risk primarily consist of cash and cash equivalents and accounts receivable. We invest our excess cash primarily in high quality securities and limit the amount of our credit exposure to any one financial institution. We do not require collateral or other securities to support customer receivables; however, we perform on-going credit evaluations of our customers and maintain allowances for potential credit losses.

 

As of December 31, 2021 and 2020, two customer accounts receivable balances were 45 % and 78%, respectively, of our aggregate accounts receivable from revenues.

 

 
F-15

Table of Contants

 

Financial Instruments and Fair Value of Financial Instruments

 

Our primary financial instruments at December 31, 2021 and 2020 consisted of cash equivalents, accounts receivable, accounts payable and debt. We apply fair value measurement accounting to either record or disclose the value of our financial assets and liabilities in our financial statements. Fair value is defined as the exchange price that would be received for an asset or paid to transfer a liability (an exit price) in the principal or most advantageous market for the asset or liability in an orderly transaction between market participants on the measurement date. A fair value hierarchy requires an entity to maximize the use of observable inputs, where available, and minimize the use of unobservable inputs when measuring fair value.

 

Described below are the three levels of inputs that may be used to measure fair value:

 

Level 1 Quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities.

 

Level 2 Observable inputs other than Level 1 prices, such as quoted prices for similar assets or liabilities; quoted prices in markets that are not active; or other inputs that are observable or can be corroborated by observable market data for substantially the full term of the assets or liabilities.

 

Level 3 Unobservable inputs that are supported by little or no market activity and that are significant to the fair value of the assets or liabilities.

 

We consider our derivative financial instruments as Level 3. The balances for our derivative financial instruments as of December 31, 2021 are the following:

 

Derivative Instrument

 

Fair Value

 

Fair value of EMA, First Fire, and Cavalry Financial Convertible Promissory Notes

 

$3,057,026

 

Fair value of Warrants issued with the derivative instruments

 

 

985,884

 

 

 

$4,042,910

 

 

Research and Development

 

Our research and development programs focus on telecommunications products and services. Research and development costs are expensed as incurred. Any payments received from external parties to fund our research and development activities reduce the recorded research and development expenses.

 

Advertising Costs

 

Advertising costs are expensed as incurred. The Company incurred advertising costs of zero for the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively.

 

Derivative Financial Instruments

 

Derivative financial instruments, as defined in ASC 815, “Accounting for Derivative Financial Instruments and Hedging Activities”, consist of financial instruments or other contracts that contain a notional amount and one or more underlying (e.g. interest rate, security price or other variable), require no initial net investment and permit net settlement. Derivative financial instruments may be free-standing or embedded in other financial instruments. Further, derivative financial instruments are initially, and subsequently, measured at fair value and recorded as liabilities or, in rare instances, assets.

 

The Company does not use derivative financial instruments to hedge exposures to cash-flow, market or foreign-currency risks. However, the Company has issued financial instruments including convertible promissory notes payable with features that were either (i) not afforded equity classification, (ii) embody risks not clearly and closely related to host contracts, or (iii) may be net-cash settled by the counterparty. As required by ASC 815, in certain instances, these instruments are required to be carried as derivative liabilities, at fair value, in our financial statements. 

 

The Company estimates the fair values of derivative financial instruments using the Monte Carlo model. Estimating fair values of derivative financial instruments requires the development of significant and subjective estimates (such as volatility, estimated life and interest rates) that may, and are likely to, change over the duration of the instrument with related changes in internal and external market factors. In addition, option-based techniques are highly volatile and sensitive to changes in the trading market price of our common stock, which has a high-historical volatility. Since derivative financial instruments are initially and subsequently carried at fair values, the Company’s operating results will reflect the volatility in these estimate and assumption changes.

 

 
F-16

Table of Contants

 

The Company issued convertible promissory notes which are convertible into common stock, at holders’ option, at a discount to the market price of the Company’s common stock. The Company has identified the embedded derivatives related to these notes relating to certain anti-dilutive (reset) provisions. These embedded derivatives included certain conversion features. The accounting treatment of derivative financial instruments requires that the Company record fair value of the derivatives as of the inception date of debenture and to fair value as of each subsequent reporting date.

 

Sequencing Policy

 

Under ASC 815-40-35, the Company has adopted a sequencing policy whereby, in the event that reclassification of contracts from equity to assets or liabilities is necessary pursuant to ASC 815 due to the Company's inability to demonstrate it has sufficient authorized shares as a result of certain securities with a potentially indeterminable number of shares, shares will be allocated on the basis of the earliest issuance date of potentially dilutive instruments with the earliest grants receiving the first allocation of shares. Pursuant to ASC 815, issuance of securities to the Company's employees or directors is not subject to the sequencing policy.

 

COVID-19

 

In December 2019, COVID-19 emerged and has subsequently spread worldwide. The World Health Organization has declared COVID-19 a pandemic resulting in federal, state and local governments and private entities mandating various restrictions, including travel restrictions, restrictions on public gatherings, stay at home orders and advisories and quarantining of people who may have been exposed to the virus. After close monitoring and responses and guidance from federal, state and local governments, in an effort to mitigate the spread of COVID-19, around March 18, 2020 for a period of time, the Company closed its Blue Collar office in Los Angeles and its TPT SpeedConnect offices in Michigan, Idaho and Arizona.  Most employees were working remotely, however this is not possible with certain employees and all subcontractors that work for Blue Collar. The Company continues to monitor developments, including government requirements and recommendations at the national, state, and local level to evaluate possible extensions to all or part of such closures.

 

The Company has taken advantage of the stimulus offerings and received $1,402,700 in PPP loans.  All of these PPP loans were forgiven in the year ended December 31, 2021.  The Company is also in the process of trying to raise debt and equity financing, some of which may have to be used for working capital shortfalls if revenues continue to decline. 

 

The Company is also in the process of raising debt and equity financing. Through December 31, 2021, the Company raised $855,094 from sales of Common Stock and Series D Preferred Stock. Some of this was by way of its agreement with White Lion where they agreed to provide the Company of up to $5,000,000 through a registration statement that was filed with the SEC.   In addition, subsequent to December 31, 2021, the Company entered into convertible promissory notes for a total of $543,500.

 

Recently Adopted Accounting Pronouncements

 

In June 2018, the FASB issued ASU No. 2018-07, Improvements to Nonemployee Share-Based Payment Accounting, which amends ASC 718, Compensation – Stock Compensation. This ASU requires that most of the guidance related to stock compensation granted to employees be followed for non-employees, including the measurement date, valuation approach, and performance conditions. The expense is recognized in the same period as though cash were paid for the good or service. The effective date is the first quarter of fiscal year 2020, with early adoption permitted, including in interim periods. The ASU has been adopted using a modified-retrospective transition approach. The adoption is not considered to have a material effect on the consolidated financial statements.

 

Management has reviewed other recently issued accounting pronouncements and have determined there are not any that would have a material impact on the condensed consolidated financial statements.

 

NOTE 2 – ACQUISITIONS

 

The Fitness Container, LLC (DBA Air Fitness)

 

On June 1, 2020, the Company signed an agreement for the acquisition of a majority interest in San Diego based manufacturing company, The Fitness Container, LLC dba “Air Fitness” (www.airefitness.com), for 500,000 shares of common stock in TPT, vesting and issuable after the common stock reaches at least a $1.00 per share closing price in trading, a $500,000 promissory note payable primarily out of future capital raising and a 10% gross profit royalty from sales of drive through lab operations for the first year. Air Fitness, in which TPT owns 75% is a California LLC founded in 2014 focused on custom designing, manufacturing, and selling high-end turnkey outdoor fitness studios and mobile medical testing labs. Air Fitness has contracted with YMCAs, Parks and Recreation departments, Universities and Country Clubs which are currently using its mobile gyms.  Air Fitness’ existing and future clients will be able to take advantage of TPT’s upcoming Broadband, TV and Social Media platform to offer virtual classes utilizing the company’s mobile gyms. The agreement included an employment agreement for Mario Garcia, former principal owner, which annual employment is to be at $120,000 plus customary employee benefits.  This agreement was closed August 1, 2020.

 

 
F-17

Table of Contants

 

The Company evaluated this acquisition in accordance with ASC 805-10-55-4 to discern whether the assets and operations of the assets purchased met the definition of a business. The company concluded that there are processes and sufficient inputs into outputs.  Accordingly, the Company accounted for this transaction as a business combination and allocated the purchase price as follows: 

 

Consideration given at fair value:

 

 

 

Note payable, net of discount

 

$340,000

 

Accounts payable

 

 

157,252

 

Non-controlling interest

 

 

113,333

 

 

 

$610,585

 

 

 

 

 

 

Assets acquired at fair value:

 

 

 

 

Cash

 

$460

 

Accounts receivable

 

 

39,034

 

 

 

$39,494

 

Goodwill

 

$571,091

 

 

Had the acquisition of Air Fitness occurred on January 1, 2020, condensed proforma results of operations for the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020 would be as follows: 

 

 

 

2021

 

 

2020

 

Revenue

 

$10,029,579

 

 

$11,191,709

 

Cost of Sales

 

 

7,802,175

 

 

 

7,270,166

 

Gross Profit

 

$2,227,404

 

 

$3,921,543

 

Expenses

 

 

(8,905,220 )

 

 

(12,305,652 )

Other income (expense)

 

 

2,582,309

 

 

 

85,071

 

Net Loss

 

$(4,095,507 )

 

$(8,299,039 )

Loss per share

 

$(0.00 )

 

$(0.01 )

 

Actual revenue for Air Fitness for the year ended December 31, 2020 was $0.

 

TPT Strategic Merger with Southern Plains

 

On August 1, 2020, InnovaQor (name changed to TPT Strategic, Inc.), a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company, entered into a Merger Agreement with the publicly traded company Southern Plains Oil Corp. (OTC PINK: SPLN prior to Merger Agreement).

 

During 2020, TPT Strategic authorized a Series A Super Majority Preferred Stock valued at $350,000 by management and issued to a third party in exchange for legal services.  Effective September 30, 2020, the Series A Super Majority Preferred Stock was exchanged with TPT for a note payable of $350,000 payable in cash or common stock.    As such, as of September 30, 2020, the Company, for accounting purposes, took control of the merged TPT Strategic and reflected in its consolidated balance sheet the non-controlling interest of $219,058 in the liabilities under a license agreement valued at $3,500,000.  This $3,500,000 was recorded as a Note Payable and expensed on InnovaQor’s books.  During the year ended December 31, 2021, the license agreement was cancelled and the non controlling interest reversed.

 

TPT Strategic Merger with Education System Management

 

On June 22, 2021, TPT Strategic and the Company signed a merger agreement with Education Systems Management, LLC (“EDSM”) to create a merged public entity. TPT Strategic will become a non controlling interest to TPTW after the merger and after fund raising efforts at an estimated 28%.  Both TPT Strategic and the Company will enter into a software development agreement for the development of a standalone backend and front-end telemedicine technology platform which is not to exceed $3.5M in cost.  It is also the intent that current TPT shareholders will receive TPT Strategic stock of 2.5M common shares as a dividend after the merger is complete and appropriate shares are registered with the SEC under a registration rights agreement. Currently, EDSM has approximately $4 million in unaudited annual revenue and is profitable.  Closing was expected on or before August 1, 2021, or as agreed by all parties.  The parties have verbally agreed to close as soon as possible and are working towards this.

 

NOTE 3 – GOING CONCERN

 

The accompanying consolidated financial statements have been prepared assuming that the Company will continue as a going concern.

 

Cash flows generated from operating activities were not enough to support all working capital requirements for the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020. Financing activities described below have helped with working capital and other capital requirements.

 

 
F-18

Table of Contants

 

We incurred $4,095,507 and $8,119,268, respectively, in losses, and we used $995,093 and $489,573, respectively, in cash for operations for the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020. We calculate the net cash used by operating activities by decreasing, or increasing in case of gain, our let loss by those items that do not require the use of cash such as depreciation, amortization, promissory note issued for research and development, note payable issued for legal fees, derivative expense or gain, gain on extinguishment of debt, loss on conversion of notes payable, impairment of goodwill and long-loved assts and share-based compensation which totaled to a net $(1,170,451) for 2021 and $5,378,277 for 2020. 

 

In addition, we report increases and reductions in liabilities as uses of cash and deceases assets and increases in liabilities as sources of cash, together referred to as changes in operating assets and liabilities.  For the year ended December 31, 2021, we had a net increase in our assets and liabilities of $4,270,865 primarily from an increase in accounts payable from lag of payments for accounts payable for cash flow considerations and an increase in the balances from our operating lease liabilities.  For the year ended December 31, 2020 we had a net increase to our assets and liabilities of $2,251,418 for similar reasons.

 

Cash flows from financing activities were $1,169,810 and $817,608 for the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively.  For the year ended December 30, 2021, these cash flows were generated from the sale of Series D Preferred Stock, common stock subscriptions of $610,502, proceeds from convertible notes, loans and advances of $3,900,400 offset by payment on convertible loans, advances and factoring agreements of $3,502,592 and payments on convertible notes and amounts payable – related parties of $64,480.  For the year ended December 31, 2020, cash flows from financing activities primarily came from proceeds from the sale of interest in QuikLABS of $460,000, convertible notes, loans and advances of $1,753,204 offset by payments on convertible loans, advances and factoring agreements of $1,169,330.

 

Cash flows provided by (used in) investing activities were $324,040 and $(500,898), respectively, for the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020 primarily related to the acquisition of property and equipment and the purchase of intangibles.

 

These factors raise substantial doubt about the ability of the Company to continue as a going concern for a period of one year from the issuance of these financial statements. The financial statements do not include any adjustments that might result from the outcome of this uncertainty.

 

In December 2019, COVID-19 emerged and has subsequently spread worldwide. The World Health Organization has declared COVID-19 a pandemic resulting in federal, state and local governments and private entities mandating various restrictions, including travel restrictions, restrictions on public gatherings, stay at home orders and advisories and quarantining of people who may have been exposed to the virus. After close monitoring and responses and guidance from federal, state and local governments, in an effort to mitigate the spread of COVID-19, around March 18, 2020 for a period of time, the Company closed its Blue Collar office in Los Angeles and its TPT SpeedConnect offices in Michigan, Idaho and Arizona.  Most employees were working remotely, however this is not possible with certain employees and all subcontractors that work for Blue Collar. The Company continues to monitor developments, including government requirements and recommendations at the national, state, and local level to evaluate possible extensions to all or part of such closures.

 

The Company has taken advantage of the stimulus offerings and received $1,402,700 in PPP loans.  All of these PPP loans were forgiven in the year ended December 31, 2021.  The Company is also in the process of trying to raise debt and equity financing, some of which may have to be used for working capital shortfalls if revenues continue to decline. 

 

In order for us to continue as a going concern for a period of one year from the issuance of these financial statements, we will need to obtain additional debt or equity financing and look for companies with cash flow positive operations that we can acquire. There can be no assurance that we will be able to secure additional debt or equity financing, that we will be able to acquire cash flow positive operations, or that, if we are successful in any of those actions, those actions will produce adequate cash flow to enable us to meet all our future obligations. Most of our existing financing arrangements are short-term. If we are unable to obtain additional debt or equity financing, we may be required to significantly reduce or cease operations.

 

 
F-19

Table of Contants

 

NOTE 4 – PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT

 

Property and equipment and related accumulated depreciation as of December 31, 2021 and 2020 are as follows:

 

 

 

2021

 

 

2020

 

Property and equipment:

 

 

 

 

 

 

Telecommunications fiber and equipment

 

$2,686,905

 

 

$2,530,167

 

Film production equipment

 

 

-

 

 

 

369,903

 

Medical equipment

 

 

209,499

 

 

 

133,329

 

Office furniture and equipment

 

 

77,859

 

 

 

86,899

 

Leasehold improvements

 

 

-

 

 

 

18,679

 

Total Property ad equipment

 

$2,974,263

 

 

$3,138,977

 

Accumulated depreciation

 

 

(1,325,241)

 

 

(993,380)

Property and equipment, net

 

$1,649,022

 

 

$2,145,597

 

 

Depreciation expense was $682,111 and $1,054,702 for the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively.

 

Approximately $200,000 of property and equipment, included herein, were financed through a financing lease.   See Note 9.

 

We periodically review the carrying amount of our depreciable long-lived assets for impairment which include property and equipment and intangible assets. An asset is considered impaired when estimated future cash flows are less than the carrying amount of the asset. In the event the carrying amount of such asset is not considered recoverable, the asset is adjusted to its fair value. Fair value is generally determined based on discounted future cash flow.  As of December 31, 2020, we adjusted the net book values of the equipment of Copperhead Digital as it became doubtful given the decrease in customers bases that the estimated future cash flows would recover the net book values.  We recorded impairment expenses of $1,849,630 for the year ended December 31, 2020.

 

The Company recognized a gain of $485,404 during the year ended December 31, 2021 primarily from a theft of equipment that occurred..  The gain represented the cash received from insurance carrier over the net book value on the books at the time of the theft.

 

NOTE 5 – DEBT FINANCING ARRANGEMENTS

 

Financing arrangements as of December 31, 2021 and 2020 are as follows:

 

 

 

2021

 

 

2020

 

Loans and advances (1)

 

$941,242

 

 

$2,517,200

 

Convertible notes payable (2)

 

 

1,162,606

 

 

 

1,711,098

 

Factoring agreements (3)

 

 

723,754

 

 

 

635,130

 

Debt – third party

 

$2,827,602

 

 

$4,863,428

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Line of credit, related party secured by assets (4)

 

$3,043,390

 

 

3,043,390

 

Debt– other related party, net of discounts (5)

 

 

7,450,000

 

 

 

7,423,334

 

Convertible debt – related party (6)

 

 

902,781

 

 

 

922,481

 

Shareholder debt (7)

 

 

49,452

 

 

 

93,072

 

Debt – related party

 

$11,445,623

 

 

$11,482,277

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total financing arrangements

 

$14,273,225

 

 

$16,345,705

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Less current portion:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Loans, advances and factoring agreements – third party

 

$(1,446,571 )

 

$(2,308,753 )

Convertible notes payable third party

 

 

(1,162,606 )

 

 

(1,711,098

Debt – related party, net of discount

 

 

(10,542,842 )

 

 

(10,559,796 )

Convertible notes payable– related party

 

 

(902,781 )

 

 

(922,481 )

 

 

 

(14,054,800 )

 

 

(15,502,128 )

Total long term debt

 

$218,425

 

 

$843,577

 

_____________________________ 

(1) The terms of $40,000 of this balance are similar to that of the Line of Credit which bears interest at adjustable rates, 1 month LIBOR plus 2%, 2.1% as of December 31, 2021, and is secured by assets of the Company, was due August 31, 2020, as amended, and included 8,000 stock options as part of the terms which options expired December 31, 2019 (see Note 7). 

 

 
F-20

Table of Contants

 

$360,000 is a bank loan dated May 28, 2019 which bears interest at Prime plus 6%, 9.25% as of December 31, 2021 and, as amended,  is interest only through May 1 2022 at which time the monthly payment of principal and interest of $15,000 is required until the due date of May 1, 2024. The bank loan is collateralized by assets of the Company.

 

On June 4, 2019, the Company consummated a Securities Purchase Agreement with Odyssey Capital Funding, LLC. (“Odyssey”) for the purchase of a $525,000 Convertible Promissory Note (“Odyssey Convertible Promissory Note”). The Odyssey Convertible Promissory Note was due June 3, 2020, paid interest at the rate of 12% (24% default) per annum and gave the holder the right from time to time, and at any time during the period beginning six months from the issuance date to convert all of the outstanding balance into common stock of the Company limited to 4.99% of the outstanding common stock of the Company. The conversion price was 55% multiplied by the average of the two lowest trading prices for the common stock during the previous 20 trading days prior to the applicable conversion date. The Odyssey Convertible Promissory Note could be prepaid in full at 125% to 145% up to 180 days from origination. Through June 3, 2020, Odyssey converted $49,150 of principal and $4,116 of accrued interest into 52,961,921 shares of common stock of the Company. On June 8, 2020, Odyssey agreed to convert the remaining principal and accrued interest balance on the Odyssey Convertible Promissory Note of $475,850 and $135,000, respectively, to a term loan payable in six months in the form of a balloon payment, earlier if the Company has a funding event, bearing simple interest on the unpaid balance of 0% for the first three months and then 10% per annum thereafter.  This loan is in default.  The Company is negotiating with Odyssey for repayment.

 

Effective September 30, 2020, we entered into a Purchase Agreement by which we agreed to purchase the 500,000 outstanding Series A Preferred shares of InnovaQor, Inc., our majority owned subsidiary, in an agreed amount of $350,000 in cash or common stock, if not paid in cash, at the five day average price preceding the date of the request for effectiveness after the filing of a registration statement on Form S-1. This was modified December 28 and 29, 2020, to provide for registration of 7,500,000 common shares for resale at the market price. Any balance due on notes will be calculated after an accounting for the net sales proceeds from sale of the stock by February 28, 2021 and may be paid in cash or stock thereafter. The Series A Preferred shares are being purchased from the Michael A. Littman, Atty. Defined Benefit Plan.     The $350,000 is included as a Note Payable as of December 31, 2020 and bears no interest. During the year ended December 31, 2021, it was determined the there was a deficiency of approximately $185,000 from net sales proceeds which is accounted for in accounts payable.                             

 

The remaining balances generally bear interest at approximately 10%, have maturity dates that are due on demand or are past due, are unsecured and are classified as current in the balance sheets.

 

(2) During 2017, the Company issued convertible promissory notes in the amount of $67,000 (comprised of $62,000 from two related parties and $5,000 from a former officer of CDH), all which were due May 1, 2020 and bear 6% annual interest (12% default interest rate). The convertible promissory notes are convertible, as amended, at $0.25 per share. These convertible promissory notes were not repaid May 1, 2020, and are delinquent.  The Company is working to renegotiate these promissory notes.

 

During 2019, the Company consummated Securities Purchase Agreements dated March 15, 2019, April 12, 2019, May 15, 2019,  June 6, 2019 and August 22, 2019 with Geneva Roth Remark Holdings, Inc. (“Geneva Roth”) for the purchase of convertible promissory notes in the amounts of $68,000, $65,000, $58,000, $53,000 and $43,000 (“Geneva Roth Convertible Promissory Notes”). The Geneva Roth Convertible Promissory Notes are due one year from issuance, pays interest at the rate of 12% (principal amount increases 150%-200% and interest rate increases to 24% under default) per annum and gives the holder the right from time to time, and at any time during the period beginning 180 days from the origination date to the maturity date or date of default to convert all or any part of the outstanding balance into common stock of the Company limited to 4.99% of the outstanding common stock of the Company. The conversion price is 61% multiplied by the average of the two lowest trading prices for the common stock during the previous 20 trading days prior to the applicable conversion date. The Geneva Roth Convertible Promissory Notes may be prepaid in whole or in part of the outstanding balance at 125% to 140% up to 180 days from origination. Geneva Roth converted a total of $244,000 of principal and $8,680 of accrued interest through December 31, 2021 from its various Securities Purchase Agreements into 125,446,546 shares of common stock of the Company leaving no outstanding principal balances as of December 31, 2021. On February 13, 2020, the August 22, 2019 Securities Purchase Agreement was repaid for $63,284, including a premium and accrued interest.

 

On March 25, 2019, the Company consummated a Securities Purchase Agreement dated March 18, 2019 with Auctus Fund, LLC. (“Auctus”) for the purchase of a $600,000 Convertible Promissory Note (“Auctus Convertible Promissory Note”). The Auctus Convertible Promissory Note is due December 18, 2019, pays interest at the rate of 12% (24% default) per annum and gives the holder the right from time to time, and at any time during the period beginning 180 days from the origination date or at the effective date of the registration of the underlying shares of common stock, which the holder has registration rights for, to convert all of the outstanding balance into common stock of the Company limited to 4.99% of the outstanding common stock of the Company. The conversion price is the lessor of the lowest trading price during the previous 25 trading days prior the date of the Auctus Convertible Promissory Note or 50% multiplied by the average of the two lowest trading prices for the common stock during the previous 25 trading days prior to the applicable conversion date. Auctus converted $33,180 of principal and $142,004 of accrued interest into 376,000,000 shares of common stock of the Company prior to December 31, 2020. 2,000,000 warrants were issued in conjunction with the issuance of this debt. See

 

 
F-21

Table of Contants

 

Pursuant to claims by Auctus that the Company had not complied with terms of the Auctus Convertible Promissory Note, the Company and Auctus entered into a settlement agreement dated October 13, 2021 where by the Company paid $763,231.97 and allowed Auctus to exercise its right to exercise 15,000,000 warrants to purchase 15,000,000 shares of common stock. As such, the balance owning to Auctus as of December 31, 2021 is zero.  The Company recognized a gain on debt extinguishment of $7,068,339 when this Auctus Convertible Promissory Note was paid off in large part because of the related derivative liability on the books at the time of the settlement.  See Note 8.

 

June 6, 2019, the Company consummated a Securities Purchase Agreement with JSJ Investments Inc. (“JSJ”) for the purchase of a $112,000 Convertible Promissory Note (“JSJ Convertible Promissory Note”). The JSJ Convertible Promissory Note is due June 6, 2020, pays interest at the rate of 12% per annum and gives the holder the right from time to time, and at any time during the period beginning 180 days from the origination date to convert all of the outstanding balance into common stock of the Company limited to 4.99% of the outstanding common stock of the Company. The conversion price is the lower of the market price, as defined, or 55% multiplied by the average of the two lowest trading prices for the common stock during the previous 20 trading days prior to the applicable conversion date. The JSJ Convertible Promissory Note may be prepaid in full at 135% to 150% up to 180 days from origination. JSJ converted $43,680 of principal into 18,500,000 shares of common stock of the Company prior to September 30, 2021. In addition, on February 25, 2020 the Company repaid for $97,000, including a premium and accrued interest, for all remaining principal and accrued interest balances as of that day. 333,333 warrants were issued in conjunction with the issuance of this debt. During the year ended December 31, 2021, the Company paid JSJ $6,666 to eliminate all outstanding warrants held by JSJ. 

 

On June 11, 2019, the Company consummated a Securities Purchase Agreement with EMA Financial, LLC. (“EMA”) for the purchase of a $250,000 Convertible Promissory Note (“EMA Convertible Promissory Note”). The EMA Convertible Promissory Note is due June 11, 2020, pays interest at the rate of 12% (principal amount increases 200% and interest rate increases to 24% under default) per annum and gives the holder the right from time to time to convert all of the outstanding balance into common stock of the Company limited to 4.99% of the outstanding common stock of the Company. The conversion price is 55% multiplied by the lowest traded price for the common stock during the previous 25 trading days prior to the applicable conversion date. The EMA Convertible Promissory Note may be prepaid in full at 135% to 150% up to 180 days from origination. Prior to December 31, 2020, EMA converted $35,366 of principal into 147,700,000 shares of common stock of the Company. 1,000,000 warrants were issued in conjunction with the issuance of this debt. See Note 8.

 

On October 6, 2021, TPT Global Tech, Inc. and FirstFire Global Opportunities Fund, LLC. entered into a convertible promissory note totaling $1,087,000 and a securities purchase agreement (“FirstFire Note”). The FirstFire Note has an original issue discount of 8% and bears interest at 10%, with a default rate of 24%, and is convertible into shares of the Company’s common stock.  There is a mandatory conversion in the event a Nasdaq Listing prior to nine months from funding for which the Holder’s principal and interest balances will be converted at a price equal to 25% discount to the opening price on the first day the Company trades on Nasdaq. There is also a voluntary conversion of all principal and accrued interest at the discretion of the Holder at the lower of (1) 75% of the two lowest trade prices during the fifteen consecutive trading day period ending on the trading day immediately prior to the applicable conversion date or (2) discount to market based on subsequent financings with other investors. Subsequent debt issuances have lowered this price to $0.025 per share, adjusted to $.0075 subsequent to December 31, 2021.  The Holder was given registration rights. The FirstFire Note may be prepaid in whole or in part of the outstanding balances at 115% prior to maturity. 225,000,000 common shares of the Company have been reserved with the transfer agent for possible conversion and exercise of warrants.  Warrants to purchase 55,000,000 shares of common stock at 110% of the opening price on the first day the Company trades on the Nasdaq exchange were issued to the Holder. Details of the FirstFire Note and securities purchase agreement can be found in the Form 8-K and exhibits filed on October 19, 2021.

 

On October 13, 2021, TPT Global Tech, Inc. and Cavalry Investment Fund LP entered into a convertible promissory note totaling $271,250 and a securities purchase agreement (“Cavalry Investment Note”). The Cavalry Investment Note has an original issue discount of 8% and bears interest at 10%, with a default rate of 24%, and is convertible into shares of the Company’s common stock.  There is a mandatory conversion in the event a Nasdaq Listing prior to nine months from funding for which the Holder’s principal and interest balances will be converted at a price equal to 25% discount to the opening price on the first day the Company trades on Nasdaq. There is also a voluntary conversion of all principal and accrued interest at the discretion of the Holder at the lower of (1) 75% of the two lowest trade prices during the fifteen consecutive trading day period ending on the trading day immediately prior to the applicable conversion date or (2) discount to market based on subsequent financings with other investors. Subsequent debt issuances have lowered this price to $0.025 per share, adjusted to $.0075 subsequent to December 31, 2021. The Holder was given registration rights. The Cavalry Investment Note may be prepaid in whole or in part of the outstanding balances at 115% prior to maturity. 56,250,000 common shares of the Company have been reserved with the transfer agent for possible conversion and exercise of warrants.  Warrants to purchase 13,750,000 shares of common stock at 110% of the opening price on the first day the Company trades on the Nasdaq exchange were issued to the Holder. Details of the Cavalry Investment Note and securities purchase agreement can be found in the Form 8-K and exhibits filed on October 19, 2021.

 

 
F-22

Table of Contants

 

On October 13, 2021, TPT Global Tech, Inc. and Cavalry Fund I, LP entered into a convertible promissory note totaling $815,250 and a securities purchase agreement (“Cavalry Fund I Note”). The Cavalry Fund I Note has an original issue discount of 8% and bears interest at 10%, with a default rate of 24%, and is convertible into shares of the Company’s common stock.  There is a mandatory conversion in the event a Nasdaq Listing prior to nine months from funding for which the Holder’s principal and interest balances will be converted at a price equal to 25% discount to the opening price on the first day the Company trades on Nasdaq. There is also a voluntary conversion of all principal and accrued interest at the discretion of the Holder at the lower of (1) 75% of the two lowest trade prices during the fifteen consecutive trading day period ending on the trading day immediately prior to the applicable conversion date or (2) discount to market based on subsequent financings with other investors. Subsequent debt issuances have lowered this price to $0.0075 per share.  The Holder was given registration rights. The Cavalry Fund I Note may be prepaid in whole or in part of the outstanding balances at 115% prior to maturity. 168,750,000 common shares of the Company have been reserved with the transfer agent for possible conversion and exercise of warrants.  Warrants to purchase 41,250,000 shares of common stock at $110% of the opening price on the first day the Company trades on the Nasdaq exchange were issued to the Holder. Details of the Cavalry Fund I Note and securities purchase agreement can be found in the Form 8-K and exhibits filed on October 19, 2021.

 

The Company is in default under its derivative financial instruments and received notice of such from EMA for not reserving enough shares for conversion and for not having filed a Form S-1 Registration Statement with the Securities and Exchange Commission. It was the intent of the Company to pay back all derivative securities prior to the due dates but that has not occurred in case of EMA. As such, the Company is currently in negotiations with EMA and relative to extending the due date and changing terms on the Note.  The Company has been named in a lawsuit by EMA for failing to comply with a Securities Purchase Agreement entered into in June 2019.  See Note 9 Other Commitments and Contingencies.

 

On February 14, 2020, the Company agreed to a Secured Promissory Note with a third party for $90,000. The Secured Promissory Note was secured by the assets of the Company and was due June 14, 2020 or earlier in case the Company is successful in raising other monies and carried an interest charge of 10% payable with the principal. The Secured Promissory Note was also convertible at the option of the holder into an equivalent amount of Series D Preferred Stock. The Secured Promissory Note also included a guaranty by the CEO of the Company, Stephen J. Thomas III. This Secured Promissory Note was paid off in June 2020, including $9,000 of interest in June and $1,000 in July 2020.

 

(3) $101,244 of the Factoring Agreements is with full recourse, due February 29, 2020, as amended, was established in June 2016 with a company that is controlled by a shareholder and is personally guaranteed by an officer of the Company. This Factoring Agreement is such that the Company pays a discount of 2% per each 30-day period for each advance received against accounts receivable or future billings. The Company was advanced funds from this Factoring Agreement for which $101,244 and $101,244 in principal remained unpaid as of December 31, 2021 and December 31, 2020, respectively.

 

On July 23, 2021, the Company entered into an Agreement for the Purchase and Sale of Future Receipts (“Lendora Factoring Agreement”). The balance to be purchased and sold is $299,800 for which the Company received $190,000, net of fees. Under the Lendora Factoring Agreement, the Company is to pay $18,737.5 per week for 16 weeks at an effective interest rate of approximately 36% annually. The Lendora Factoring Agreement includes a guaranty by the CEO of the Company, Stephen J. Thomas III.

 

On July 23, 2021, the Company entered into a consolidation agreement for the Purchase and Sale of Future Receipts with Lendora Capital (“Lendora Consolidation Agreement”). The balance to be purchased and sold gave consideration for all then outstanding factoring agreements such as the NewCo Factoring Agreements, the NewCo Factoring Agreement #3 and the Lendora Factoring Agreement and amounted to $1,522,984 for which the Company had outstanding balances totaling $967,496. Payments under this Lendora Consolidation Agreement supersedes all other factoring agreement payments and includes $ 31,728.85 per week, at an effective interest rate of approximately 36% annually, for 48 weeks. The Lendora Consolidation Agreement includes a guaranty by the CEO of the Company, Stephen J. Thomas III.

 

The Following factoring agreements were consolidated through the Lendora Consolidation Agreement or previously paid off:

 

On May 8, 2019, the Company entered into a factoring agreement with Advantage Capital Funding (“2019 Factoring agreement”). $500,000, net of expenses, was funded to the Company with a promise to pay $18,840 per week for 40 weeks until a total of $753,610 is paid which occurred in February 2020.

 

On February 21, 2020, the Company entered into an Agreement for the Purchase and Sale of Future Receipts (“2020 Factoring Agreement”). The balance to be purchased and sold is $716,720 for which the Company received $500,000, net of fees. Under the 2020 Factoring Agreement, the Company was to pay $14,221 per week for 50 weeks at an effective interest rate of approximately 43% annually. However, due to COVID-19 the payments under the 2020 Factoring Agreement were reduced temporarily, to between $9,000 and $11,000 weekly.  All deferred payments have been paid.

 

 
F-23

Table of Contants

 

On November 13, 2020, the Company entered into an Agreement for the Purchase and Sale of Future Receipts (“2020 NewCo Factoring Agreement”). The balance to be purchased and sold is $326,400 for which the Company received $232,800, net of fees. Under the 2020 NewCo Factoring Agreement, the Company was to pay $11,658 per week for 28 weeks at an effective interest rate of approximately 36% annually. The 2020 NewCo Factoring Agreement has been paid back in total.

 

On December 11, 2020, the Company entered into an Agreement for the Purchase and Sale of Future Receipts with Samson MCA LLC  (“Samson  Factoring Agreement”). The balance to be purchased and sold is $162,500 for which the Company received $118,625, net of fees. Under the Samson Factoring Agreement, the Company was to pay $8,125 per week for 20 weeks at an effective interest rate of approximately 36%. The Samson Factoring Agreement has been paid back in total.

 

On December 11, 2020, the Company entered into a consolidation agreement for the Purchase and Sale of Future Receipts with QFS Capital (“QFS Factoring Agreement”). The balance to be purchased and sold is $976,918 for which the Company receives weekly payments of $29,860 for 20 weeks and then $21,978 for 4 weeks and then $11,669 in the last week of receipts all totaling $696,781 net of fees.  During the same time, the Company is required to pay weekly $23,087 for 42 weeks at an effective interest rate of approximately 36% annually. The QFS Factoring Agreement was consolidated through the Lendora Consolidation Agreement.

 

On June 7 and June 14, 2021, the Company entered into two Agreements for the Purchase and Sale of Future Receipts (“NewCo Factoring Agreements”). The balance to be purchased and sold is $199,500 each for which the Company received $144,750 each, net of fees. Under the NewCo Factoring Agreement, the Company is to pay $5,542 each per week for 36 weeks at an effective interest rate of approximately 36% annually. The NewCo Factoring Agreements were consolidated through the Lendora Consolidation Agreement.

 

On June 28, 2021, the Company entered into an Agreement for the Purchase and Sale of Future Receipts (“NewCo Factoring Agreement #3”). The balance to be purchased and sold is $133,000 for which the Company received $100,000. Under the NewCo Factoring Agreement, the Company is to pay $3,695 per week for 36 weeks at an effective interest rate of 36% annually. The NewCo Factoring Agreement #3 was consolidated through the Lendora Consolidation Agreement.

 

(4) The Line of Credit originated with a bank and was secured by the personal assets of certain shareholders of Copperhead Digital. During 2016, the Line of Credit was assigned to the Copperhead Digital shareholders, who subsequent to the Copperhead Digital acquisition by TPTG became shareholders of TPTG, and the secured personal assets were used to pay off the bank. The Line of Credit bears a variable interest rate based on the 1 Month LIBOR plus 2.0%, 2.1% as of December 31, 2021, is payable monthly, and is secured by the assets of the Company. 1,000,000 shares of Common Stock of the Company have been reserved to accomplish raising the funds to pay off the Line of Credit. Since assignment of the Line of Credit to certain shareholders, which balance on the date of assignment was $2,597,790, those shareholders have loaned the Company $445,600 under the similar terms and conditions as the line of credit but most of which were also given stock options totaling $85,120 which expired as of December 31, 2019 (see Note 8) and was due, as amended, August 31, 2020.  The Company is in negotiations to refinance this Line of Credit.

 

During the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018, those same shareholders and one other have loaned the Company money in the form of convertible loans of $136,400 and $537,200, respectively, described in (2) and (6).

 

(5) $350,000 represents cash due to the prior owners of the technology acquired in December 2016 from the owner of the Lion Phone which is due to be paid as agreed by the Company and the former owners of the Lion Phone technology and has not been determined.

 

$4,000,000 represents a promissory note included as part of the consideration of ViewMe Live technology acquired in 2017, later agreed to as being due and payable in full, with no interest with $2,000,000 from debt proceeds and the remainder from proceeds from a second Company public offering.

 

$1,000,000 represents a promissory note which was entered into on May 6, 2020 for the acquisition of Media Live One Platform from Steve and Yuanbing Caudle for the further development of software. This was expensed as research and development in the year ended December 31, 2020. This $1,000,000 promissory note is non-interest bearing, due after funding has been received by the Company from its various investors and other sources. Mr. Caudle is a principal with the Company’s ViewMe technology.

 

On September 1, 2018, the Company closed on its acquisition of Blue Collar. Part of the acquisition included a promissory note of $1,600,000 and interest at 3% from the date of closure. The promissory note is secured by the assets of Blue Collar.

 

$500,000 represents a Note Payable related to the acquisition of 75% of Air Fitness, payable six months from the date of the note or as agreed by the Company out of future capital raising efforts and does not accrue interest.

 

 
F-24

Table of Contants

 

(6) During 2016, the Company acquired SDM which consideration included a convertible promissory note for $250,000 due February 29, 2019, as amended, does not bear interest, unless delinquent in which the interest is 12% per annum, and is convertible into common stock at $1.00 per share. The SDM balance is $181,981 as of December 31, 2020. As of March 1, 2020, this convertible promissory note is delinquent.

 

During 2018, the Company issued convertible promissory notes in the amount of $537,200 to related parties and $10,000 to a non-related party which bear interest at 6% (11% default interest rate), are due 30 months from issuance and are convertible into Series C Preferred Stock at $1.00 per share.  $19,400 of these notes were repaid during the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020.

 

(7) The shareholder debt represents funds given to TPTG or subsidiaries by officers and managers of the Company as working capital. There are no written terms of repayment or interest that is being accrued to these amounts and they will only be paid back, according to management, if cash flows support it. They are classified as current in the balance sheets.

 

See Lease financing arrangement in Note 9.

 

NOTE 6 – DERIVATIVE FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS

 

The Company previously adopted the provisions of ASC subtopic 825-10, Financial Instruments (“ASC 825-10”). ASC 825-10 defines fair value as the price that would be received from selling an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date. When determining the fair value measurements for assets and liabilities required or permitted to be recorded at fair value, the Company considers the principal or most advantageous market in which it would transact and considers assumptions that market participants would use when pricing the asset or liability, such as inherent risk, transfer restrictions, and risk of nonperformance. ASC 825-10 establishes a fair value hierarchy that requires an entity to maximize the use of observable inputs and minimize the use of unobservable inputs when measuring fair value.

 

The derivative liability as of December 31, 2021, in the amount of $4,042,910 has a level 3 classification under ASC 825-10.

 

The following table provides a summary of changes in fair value of the Company’s Level 3 financial liabilities as of December 31, 2021. 

 

 

 

Debt Derivative Liabilities

 

Balance, December 31, 2019

 

$8,836,514

 

Change in derivative liabilities from conversion of notes payable

 

 

(1,144,290 )

Change in derivative liabilities from the Odyssey conversion to a term loan

 

 

(1,286,762 )

Change in fair value of derivative liabilities at end of period – derivative expense

 

 

(1,140,323 )

Balance, December 31, 2020

 

$5,265,139

 

Change in derivative liabilities from new notes payable

 

 

1,902,897

 

Change in derivative liabilities from payoff of notes payable

 

 

(6,662,027 )

Change in fair value of derivative liabilities at end of period – derivative expense

 

 

3,536,901

 

Balance, December 31, 2021

 

$4,042,910

 

 

Convertible notes payable and warrant derivatives – The Company issued convertible promissory notes which are convertible into common stock, at holders’ option, at a discount to the market price of the Company’s common stock. The Company has identified the embedded derivatives related to these notes relating to certain anti-dilutive (reset) provisions. These embedded derivatives included certain conversion features. The accounting treatment of derivative financial instruments requires that the Company record fair value of the derivatives as of the inception date of debenture and to fair value as of each subsequent reporting date.

 

As of December 31, 2021, the Company marked to market the fair value of the debt derivatives and determined a fair value of $4,042,910 ($3,057,026 from the convertible notes and $985,884 from the warrants) in Note 6. The Company recorded an expense of $3,536,901 and gain of $1,140,323 from change in fair value of debt derivatives for the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively. The fair value of the embedded derivatives was determined using Monte Carlo simulation method based on the following assumptions: (1) dividend yield of 0%, (2) expected volatility of 115.4% to 298.6%, (3) weighted average risk-free interest rate of 0.06% to 1.26% (4) expected life of 0.25 to 4.79 years, and (5) the quoted market price of $0.011 for the Company’s common stock.

 

See Financing lease arrangements in Note 9.

 

 
F-25

Table of Contants

 

NOTE 7 - INCOME TAXES

 

The following table sets forth the components of the Company’s income tax expense (benefit) for the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020:

 

Current:

 

2021

 

 

2020

 

Federal State and local

 

$-

 

 

-

 

Total Current

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

Deferred:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Federal State and local benefit

 

(860,056)

 

 

(1,705,046 )

Net operating loss, net of state tax effect

 

 

(30,540)

 

 

(60,546 )

Meals and entertainment

 

 

10,134

 

 

 

4,459

 

Stock based expenses

 

 

46,769

 

 

 

87,706

 

Impairment

 

 

208,728

 

 

 

567,629

 

Amortization

 

 

143,243

 

 

 

153,497

 

Derivative expense

 

 

(742,749

 

 

239,468

 

Gain on extinguishment

 

 

(1,808,903)

 

 

-

 

Change in allowance

 

 

3,033,374

 

 

 

712,833

 

Total Benefit

 

$-

 

 

-

 

 

The following table sets forth a reconciliation of the Company’s income tax expense (benefit) as the federal statutory rate to recorded income tax expense (benefit) for the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020:

 

 

 

2021

 

 

2020

 

Income tax at Federal statutory rate

 

 

21%

 

 

21%

Change in valuation allowance

 

(21%)

 

 

(21%)

 

Stock based compensation

 

(0%)

 

 

(0%)

 

Net operating loss, net of state tax effect

 

(1%)

 

 

(1%)

 

Other

 

(1%)

 

 

(1%)

 

Total

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

The following table sets forth the components of the Company’s deferred income taxes as of December 31, 2021 and 2020:

 

Current deferred tax assets (liabilities):

 

2021

 

 

2020

 

Valuation allowance

 

$-

 

 

-

 

Total current deferred tax asset (liability)

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Noncurrent deferred tax assets (liabilities):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Derivative (gain) expense

 

2,073,432

 

 

 

1,330,683

 

Intangible assets amortization

 

 

1,253,096

 

 

 

956,355

 

Net operating loss carry forwards

 

 

5,725,115

 

 

 

2,752,287

 

Stock base compensation

 

 

1,878,003

 

 

 

1,743,527

 

Other

 

 

(1,679,863 )

 

 

99,034

 

Less; Valuation allowance

 

$(9,249,782 )

 

(6,881,886 )

Total noncurrent deferred tax asset (liability)

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total deferred tax asset (liability)

 

$-

 

 

-

 

 

The Company has approximately $27,000,000 and $13,000,000 of net operating loss carry forwards as of December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively, which expire in varying amounts, if unused. Because of the change in ownership of more than 50% of the Company in accordance with Section 382 of the IRS Code, these net operating loss carry forwards may be significantly limited to use in future periods.

 

 
F-26

Table of Contants

 

NOTE 8 - STOCKHOLDERS' DEFICIT

 

Preferred Stock

 

As of December 31, 2021, we had authorized 100,000,000 shares of Preferred Stock, of which certain shares had been designated as Series A Preferred Stock, Series B Preferred Stock, Series C Preferred Stock and Series D Preferred Stock.

 

Series A Convertible Preferred Stock

 

The Company designated 1,000,000 shares of Preferred Stock as Series A Preferred Stock.  In February 2015, the Board of Directors authorized the issuance of 1,000,000 shares of Series A Preferred Stock to Stephen Thomas, Chairman, CEO and President of the Company, valued at $3,117,000 for compensation expense.  These shares are outstanding as of December 31, 2020.

 

The Series A Preferred Stock has a par value of $.001, is redeemable at the Company’s option at $100 per share, is senior to any other class or series of outstanding Preferred Stock or Common Stock and does not bear dividends. The Series A Preferred Stock has a liquidation preference immediately after any Senior Securities, as defined and amended, of an amount equal to amounts payable owing, including contingency amounts where Holders of the Series A have personally guaranteed obligations of the Company. Holders of the Series A Preferred Stock shall, collectively have the right to convert all of their Series A Preferred Stock when conversion is elected into that number of shares of Common Stock of the Company, determined by the following formula: 60% of the issued and outstanding Common Shares as computed immediately after the transaction for conversion. For further clarification, the 60% of the issued and outstanding common shares includes what the holders of the Series A Preferred Stock may already hold in common shares at the time of conversion. The Series A Preferred Stock, collectively, shall have the right to vote as if converted prior to the vote to a number of shares equal to 60% of the outstanding Common Stock of the Company.

 

During the year ended December 31, 2020, the Series A Preferred Stock was reclassified as mezzanine equity as a result of the Company not having enough authorized common shares to be able to issue common shares upon their conversion.

 

Series B Convertible Preferred Stock

 

In February 2015, the Company designated 3,000,000 shares of Preferred Stock as Series B Convertible Preferred Stock. 

 

The Series B Preferred Stock was designated in February 2015, has a par value of $.001, is not redeemable, is senior to any other class or series of outstanding Preferred Stock, except the Series A Preferred Stock, or Common Stock and does not bear dividends. The Series B Preferred Stock has a liquidation preference immediately after any Senior Securities, as defined and currently the Series A Preferred Stock, and of an amount equal to $2.00 per share. Holders of the Series B Preferred Stock have a right to convert all or any part of the Series B Preferred Shares and will receive and equal number of common shares at the conversion price of $2.00 per share. The Series B Preferred Stockholders have a right to vote on any matter with holders of Common Stock and shall have a number of votes equal to that number of Common Shares on a one-to- one basis.

 

There are 2,588,693 shares of Series B Convertible Preferred Stock outstanding as of December 31, 2021. During the year ended December 31, 2020, the Series B Preferred Stock was reclassified as mezzanine equity as a result of the Company not having enough authorized common shares to be able to issue common shares upon their conversion.

 

Series C Convertible Preferred Stock

 

In May 2018, the Company designated 3,000,000 shares of Preferred Stock as Series C Convertible Preferred Stock. 

 

The Series C Preferred Stock has a par value of $.001, is not redeemable, is senior to any other class or series of outstanding Preferred Stock, except the Series A and Series B Preferred Stock, or Common Stock and does not bear dividends. The Series C Preferred Stock has a liquidation preference immediately after any Senior Securities, as defined and currently the Series A and B Preferred Stock, and of an amount equal to $2.00 per share. Holders of the Series C Preferred Stock have a right to convert all or any part of the Series C Preferred Shares and will receive an equal number of common shares at the conversion price of $0.15 per share. The Series C Preferred Stockholders have a right to vote on any matter with holders of Common Stock and shall have a number of votes equal to that number of Common Shares on a one-to-one basis.

 

There are no shares of Series C Convertible Preferred Stock outstanding as of December 31, 2021.  There are approximately $688,500 in convertible notes payable convertible into Series C Convertible Preferred Stock which compromise some of the common stock equivalents calculated in Note 1. 

 

 
F-27

Table of Contants

 

Series D Convertible Preferred Stock

 

On July 6, 2020 and September 15, 2021, the Company amended its Series D Designation from January 14, 2020. These Amendments changed the number of shares to 10,000,000 shares of the authorized 100,000,000 shares of the Company's $0.001 par value preferred stock as the Series D Convertible Preferred Stock ("the Series D Preferred Shares.") 

 

Series D Preferred shares have the following features: (i) 6% Cumulative Annual Dividends payable on the purchase value in cash or common stock of the Company at the discretion of the Board and payment is also at the discretion of the Board, which may decide to cumulate to future years; (ii) Any time after 12 months from issuance an option to convert to common stock at the election of the holder @ 75% of the 30 day average market closing price (for previous 30 business days) divided into $5.00. ; (iii) Automatic conversion of the Series D Preferred Stock shall occur without consent of holders upon any national exchange listing approval and the registration effectiveness of common stock underlying the conversion rights. The automatic conversion to common from Series D Preferred shall be @ 75% of the 30 day average market closing price (for previous 30 business days) divided into $5.00, which shall be post-reverse split as may be necessary for any Exchange listing (iv) Registration Rights – the Company has granted Piggyback Registration Rights for common stock underlying conversion rights in the event it files any other Registration Statement (other than an S-1 that the Company may file for certain conversion common shares for the convertible note financing that was arranged and funded in 2019). Further, the Company will file, and pursue to effectiveness, a Registration Statement or offering statement for common stock underlying the Automatic Conversion event triggered by an exchange listing. (v) Liquidation Rights - $5.00 per share plus any accrued unpaid dividends – subordinate to Series A, B, and C Preferred Stock receiving full liquidation under the terms of such series. The Company has redemption rights for the first year following the Issuance Date to redeem all or part of the principal amount of the Series D Preferred Stock at between 115% and 140%.

 

During the year ended December 31, 2021, 46,649 shares of Series D Preferred Share were purchased for $233,244 of which Stephen Thomas, CEO of the Company, acquired 36,649 for $183,244.  The remainder of the shares were purchased by a third party.  

 

As of December 31, 2021, there 46,649 Series D Preferred shares outstanding.

 

Series E Convertible Preferred Stock

 

On November 10, 2021, the Company 10,000,000 shares of the 100,000,000 shares of the Company's $0.001 par value preferred stock as the Series E Convertible Preferred Stock ("the Series E Preferred Shares").

 

Series E Preferred shares have the following features: (i) 6% Cumulative Annual Dividends payable on the purchase value in cash or common stock of the Company at the discretion of the Board and payment is also at the discretion of the Board, which may decide to cumulate to future years; (ii) Any time after 12 months from issuance an option to convert to common stock at the election of the holder @ 75% of the 30 day average market closing price (for previous 30 business days) divided into $5.00. ; (iii) Automatic conversion of the Series D Preferred Stock shall occur without consent of holders upon any national exchange listing approval and the registration effectiveness of common stock underlying the conversion rights. The automatic conversion to common from Series D Preferred shall be @ 75% of the 30 day average market closing price (for previous 30 business days) divided into $5.00, which shall be post-reverse split as may be necessary for any Exchange listing (iv) Registration Rights – the Company has granted Piggyback Registration Rights for common stock underlying conversion rights in the event it files any other Registration Statement (other than an S-1 that the Company may file for certain conversion common shares for the convertible note financing that was arranged and funded in 2019). Further, the Company will file, and pursue to effectiveness, a Registration Statement or offering statement for common stock underlying the Automatic Conversion event triggered by an exchange listing. (v) Liquidation Rights - $5.00 per share plus any accrued unpaid dividends – subordinate to Series A, B, C and D Preferred Stock receiving full liquidation under the terms of such series. The Company has redemption rights for the first year following the Issuance Date to redeem all or part of the principal amount of the Series D Preferred Stock at between 115% and 140%.

 

As of December 31, 2021, there are no Series E Preferred shares outstanding.

 

During the year ended December 31, 2020, the related party holders of approximately $4,700,000 of existing financing arrangements agreed to exchange their debt and accrued interest for 940,800 Series D Preferred Stock through a separate $12 Million Private Placement of Series D Preferred Stock (“$12 Million Private Placement”), conditioned on the Company raising at least $12,000,000.  To date, this condition has not been met.

 

 
F-28

Table of Contants

 

Common Stock

 

As of December 31, 2021, we had authorized 1,250,000,000 shares of Common Stock, of which 923,029,038 common shares are issued and outstanding.  Subsequent to December 31, 2021, the authorized common shares have been increased to 2,500,000,000.

 

Common Stock Issued for Conversion of Debt

 

During the year ended December 31, 2020, the Company issued 679,932,432 of common shares for $232,430 of principal and $104,300 of interest, resulting in a loss on conversion of $775,650.  In addition, the Company issued 1,000,000 common shares in exchange for $58,000 of legal liabilities.

 

Common Stock Issued for Expenses and Liabilities

 

 On March 18, 2019, the Company issued to an Investor a convertible promissory note in the principal amount of $600,000 (the “Auctus Promissory Note”) and Warrant Agreement (the “Auctus Warrant Agreement”) pursuant to that certain securities purchase agreement dated March 18, 2019. (the “Auctus SPA”) with Auctus Fund, LLC (“Auctus”). Pursuant to claims by Auctus that the Company had not complied with terms of the Auctus SPA, the Company and Auctus entered into a settlement agreement dated October 13, 2021 where by the Company would pay $763,232 and allow Auctus to exercise its right to exercise 15,000,000 warrants to purchase 15,000,000 shares of common stock.  The Company recorded $412,500 to Stockholders Equity in relation to the issuance of the 15,000,000 shares under this agreement in October 2021.  The value applied to the issuance of shares was based on the closing market price on the day of issuance.

 

The Company issued 7,500,000 shares of stock to Mr. Littman in accordance with its December 28 and 29, 2020 agreements as described in Note 5.  These shares were included in a Form S-1 filed by the Company on January 15, 2021.  During the year ended December 31, 2021, it was determined in accordance with an underlying agreement, that there was a deficiency of approximately $185,000 from net sales proceeds from sales of the shares and as such, this amount is accounted for in accounts payable as of December 31, 2021.                             

 

On April 5, the Company granted 1,500,000 restricted commons shares to a consultant as a bonus for services rendered.  The Company recorded $44,100 as expense in the statement of operations during the year ended December 31, 2021 which represented the calculation fair value on the date of grant.

 

In addition, in the year ended December 31, 2020, 1,000,000 shares were issued to a consultant as a bonus for IR consulting services performed which the Company recorded $58,000 of compensation expense.  These shares were valued at their fair value on the day they were granted for which the Company recorded $54,000 in the statement of operations as share-based compensation.

 

Stock Purchase Agreement

 

On May 28, 2021, and as amended December 27, 2021, the Company entered into a Common Stock Purchase Agreement (“Purchase Agreement”) and Registration Rights Agreement (“Registration Rights Agreement”) with White Lion Capital, LLC, a Nevada limited liability company (“White Lion”). Under the terms of the Purchase Agreement, White Lion agreed to provide the Company with up to $5,000,000 upon effectiveness of a registration statement on Form S-1 (the “Registration Statement”) filed with the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission (the “Commission”). A Form S-1 was filed on June 30, 2021 regarding this transaction.  Subsequent Amendments to Forms S-1 related to this transaction were filed on July 6, 2021 and July 14, 2021.  The registrations statement was declared effective July 19, 2021.

 

The Company has the discretion to deliver purchase notice to White Lion and White Lion will be obligated to purchase shares of the Company’s common stock, par value $0.001 per share (the “Common Stock”) based on the investment amount specified in each purchase notice. The maximum amount of the Purchase Notice shall be the lesser of: (i) 200% of the Average Daily Trading Volume or (ii) the Investment Limit divided by the highest closing price of the Common Stock over the most recent five (5) Business Days including the respective Purchase Date. Notwithstanding the forgoing, the Investor may waive the Purchase Notice Limit at any time to allow the Investor to purchase additional shares under a Purchase Notice. Pursuant to the Purchase Agreement, White Lion and its affiliates will not be permitted to purchase and the Company may not put shares of the Company’s Common Stock to White Lion that would result in White Lion’s beneficial ownership equaling more than 9.99% of the Company’s outstanding Common Stock. The price of each purchase share shall be equal to eighty-five percent (85%) of the Market Price (as defined in the Purchase Agreement). Purchase Notices may be delivered by the Company to White Lion until the earlier of twelve (12) months (until December 31, 2022, as amended) or the date on which White Lion has purchased an aggregate of $5,000,000 worth of Common Stock under the terms of the Purchase Agreement.

 

Under the Registration Rights Agreement with White Lion, the Company has given purchase notices for 29,000,000 shares of common stock and has received proceeds of $610,502, net of expenses.

  

 
F-29

Table of Contants

 

Subscription Payable

 

As of December 31, 2021, the Company has recorded $5,610 in stock subscription payable, which equates to the fair value on the date of commitment, of the Company’s commitment to issue the following common shares:

 

Unissued shares for TPT consulting agreements

 

 

625,000

 

Shares receivable under terminated acquisition agreement

 

 

(3,096,181 )

Net commitment

 

 

(2,471,181 )

 

During the years ended December 31, 2018, 16,667 of common shares were subscribed to for a note payable on the balance sheet of $2,0002,000 of these shares were issued during the year ended December 31, 2020.

 

During the year ended December 31, 2020, the Company signed consulting agreements related to their activities with TPT Global Tech and TPT MedTech with three third parties for which we agreed to issue 4,450,000 shares of restricted common stock.   300,000 of these shares were valued at fair value and expensed in the statement of operations for $16,200.  The other 4,150,000 shares were value at their value of $275,975 which is being amortized over 10 months of service starting on the date of the agreement of September 1, 2020.  $135,402 and $110,390 has been amortized into the statement of operations as of December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively.

 

In 2018, Arkady Shkolnik and Reginald Thomas (family member of CEO) were added as members of the Board of Directors. In accordance with agreements with the Company for his services as a director, Mr. Shkolnik is to receive $25,000 per quarter and 5,000,000 shares of restricted common stock valued at approximately $692,500 vesting quarterly over twenty-four months. The quarterly cash payments of $25,000 will be paid in unrestricted common shares if the Company has not been funded adequately to make such payments. Mr. Thomas is to receive $10,000 per quarter and 1,000,000 shares of restricted common stock valued at approximately $120,000 vesting quarterly over twenty-four months. The quarterly payment of $10,000 may be suspended by the Company if the Company has not been adequately funded. As of December 31, 2020, $215,500 and $75,000 has been accrued as accounts payable in the balance sheet for Mr. Shkolnik and Mr. Thomas, respectively. For the year ended December 31, 2021 and 2020, $0 and $236,978, respectively, have been expensed under these agreements.  Both the 5,000,000 and 1,000,000 shares granted were issued during the year ended December 31, 2020.

 

Effective November 1, 2017, the Company entered into an agreement to acquire Holly wood Rivera, LLC and HRS Mobile LLC (“HRS”). In March 2018, the HRS acquisition was rescinded and 3,096,181 shares of common stock which were issued as consideration are being returned by the recipients. As such, as of December 31, 2021 the shares for the HRS transaction are reflected as subscriptions receivable based on their par value.

 

Stock Options

 

 

 

Options Outstanding 

 

 

Vested 

 

 

Vesting Period 

 

 

Exercise Price Outstanding and Exercisable 

 

 

Expiration Date 

 

December 31, 2019

 

 

3,000,000

 

 

 

3,000,000

 

 

12 to 18 months

 

 

$0.10

 

 

3-1-20 to 3-21-21 

 

Expired

 

 

(2,000,000 )

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2020

 

 

1,000,000

 

 

 

1,000,000

 

 

12 months

 

 

$0.10

 

 

3-21-21 

 

Expired

 

 

(1,000,000 )

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2021

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

During the year ended December 31, 2018, the Company entered into consulting arrangements primarily for legal work and general business support that included the issuance of stock options to purchase 3,000,000 options to purchase common shares at $0.10 per share. 3,000,000 of these have expired. The Black-Scholes options pricing model was used to value the stock options. The inputs included the following:

 

(1)

 Dividend yield of 0%

(2)

 expected annual volatility of 307% - 311%

(3)

 discount rate of 2.2% to 2.3%

(4)

 expected life of 2 years, and

(5)

 estimated fair value of the Company’s common $0.125 to $0.155 per share.

 

 
F-30

Table of Contants

 

Warrants Issued with Convertible Promissory Notes

 

As of December 31, 2021, there were 111,000,000 warrants outstanding that expire in five years or in the year ended December 31, 2026.  As part of the Convertible Promissory Notes payable – third party issuance in Note 5, the Company issued 3,333,333 warrants to 3,333,333 common shares of the Company at 70% of the current market price.  Current market price means the average of the three lowest trading prices for our common stock during the ten-trading day period ending on the latest complete trading day prior to the date of the respective exercise notice.  However, if a required registration statement, registering the underlying shares of the Convertible Promissory Notes, is declared effective on or before June 11, 2019 to September 11, 2019, then, while such Registration Statement is effective, the current market price shall mean the lowest volume weighted average price for our common stock during the ten-trading day period ending on the last complete trading day prior to the conversion date.   Since issuance of the 3,333,333 originally issued, 2,333,333 of the warrants have been bought back or exercised.

 

During the year ended December 31, 2021, the Company issued warrants in conjunction with the issuance of the FirstFire Note, the Cavalry Investment Note and the Cavalry Fund I Note agreements.  Warrants to purchase 110,000,000 shares of common stock at 110% of the opening price on the first day the Company trades on the Nasdaq exchange were issued to these note holders.

 

The warrants issued under these convertible promissory notes were considered derivative liabilities valued at $985,880 of the total $4,042,910 derivative liabilities as of December 31, 2021. See Note 5.

 

Common Stock Reservations

 

The Company has internally reserved 1,000,000 shares of Common Stock of the Company for the purpose of raising funds to be used to pay off debt described in Note 5.

 

We have reserved 20,000,000 shares of Common Stock of the Company to grant to certain employee and consultants as consideration for services rendered and that will be rendered to the Company.

 

Non-Controlling Interests

 

QuikLAB Mobile Laboratories

 

In July and August 2020, the Company formed Quiklab 1 LLC, QuikLAB 2, LLC, QuikLAB 3, LLC and QuikLAB 4, LLC.  QuikLAB 4, LLC was subsequently dissolved.  It was the intent to use these entities as vehicles into which third parties would invest and participate in owning QuikLAB Mobile Laboratories.  As of December 31, 2021, Quiklab 1 LLC, QuikLAB 2, LLC and QuikLAB 3, LLC have received an investment of $470,000, of which Stephen Thomas and Rick Eberhardt, CEO and COO of the Company, have invested $100,000 in QuikLAB 2, LLC.  During the year ended December 31, 2021, one investor entered into an agreement at their request, to have their investment returned.  10,000 of this investment was returned with the remaining $60,000 being reclassified to an accounts payable in the balance sheet as of December 31, 2021.

 

The third party investors and Mr. Thomas and Mr. Eberhart, will benefit from owning 20% of QuikLAB Mobile Laboratories specific to their investments.  The Company owns the other 80% ownership in the QuickLAB Mobile Laboratories.  The net loss attributed to the non-controlling interests from the QuikLAB Mobile Laboratories included in the statement of operations for the year ended December 31, 2021 and 2020 is $58,613 and $30,536, respectively.

 

Other Non-Controlling Interests

 

InnovaQor, Air Fitness and TPT Asia are other non-controlling interests in which the Company owns 94%, 75% and 78%, respectively.  There is very little activity in any of these entities.  The net loss attributed to these non-controlling interests included in the statement of operations for the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020 is 26,230 and $16,881, respectively.

 

InnovaQor did a reverse merger with Southern Plains of which there ended up being a non-controlling interest ownership of 6% as of December 31, 2020.  As a result, $219,058 in the non-controlling interest in liabilities of a license agreement valued at $3,500,000 was reflected in the consolidated balance sheet as of December 31, 2020, which was reversed in the years ended December 31, 2021 when the license agreement was cancelled between all parties.

 

 
F-31

Table of Contants

 

NOTE 9 - COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES

 

Accounts Payable and Accrued Expenses

 

Accounts payable:

 

2021

 

 

2020

 

Related parties (1)

 

$2,294,570

 

 

$1,507,418

 

General operating

 

 

4,788,291

 

 

 

3,797,069

 

Accrued interest on debt (2)

 

 

1,546,889

 

 

 

1,328,939

 

Credit card balances

 

 

169,035

 

 

 

173,972

 

Accrued payroll and other expenses

 

 

211,668

 

 

 

296,590

 

Taxes and fees payable

 

 

642,640

 

 

 

641,012

 

Unfavorable lease liability

 

 

-

 

 

 

121,140

 

Total

 

$9,653,093

 

 

$7,866,140

 

_____________

(1)

Relates to amounts due to management and members of the Board of Directors according to verbal and written agreements that have not been paid as of period end.

 

(2)

Portion relating to related parties is $924,612 and $679,380 for December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively.

 

Operating lease obligations

 

The Company adopted Topic 842 on January 1, 2019. The Company elected to adopt this standard using the optional modified retrospective transition method and recognized a cumulative-effect adjustment to the consolidated balance sheet on the date of adoption. Comparative periods have not been restated. With the adoption of Topic 842, the Company’s consolidated balance sheet now contains the following line items: Operating lease right-of-use assets, Current portion of operating lease liabilities and Operating lease liabilities, net of current portion.

 

As all the existing leases subject to the new lease standard were previously classified as operating leases by the Company, they were similarly classified as operating leases under the new standard. The Company has determined that the identified operating leases did not contain non-lease components and require no further allocation of the total lease cost. Additionally, the agreements in place did not contain information to determine the rate implicit in the leases, so we used our estimated incremental borrowing rate as the discount rate. Our weighted average discount rate is 10.0% and the weighted average lease term of 4.9 years.

 

We have various non-cancelable lease agreements for certain of our tower locations with original lease periods expiring between 2022 and 2044. Our lease terms may include options to extend or terminate the lease when it is reasonably certain we will exercise that option. Certain of the arrangements contain escalating rent payment provisions. Our Idaho main office lease and an equipment lease described below and leases with an initial term of twelve months have not been recorded on the consolidated balance sheets. We recognize rent expense on a straight-line basis over the lease term.

 

As of December 31, 2021 and 2020, operating lease right-of-use assets and liabilities arising from operating leases were $4,259,758 and $4,732,459, respectively. During the year ended December 31, 2021, cash paid for amounts included for the measurement of lease liabilities was $2,815,943 and the Company recorded lease expense in the amount of $2,581,528 in cost of sales.

 

The Company entered into an operating lease agreement for location rights for certain QuikLABS.  The operating lease agreement start October 1, 2020 and goes for three years at $9,798 per month.  The Company entered an operating agreement to lease colocation space for 5 years.  This operating agreement starts October 1, 2020 for $7,140 per month.  In addition, the Company entered into office space for Blue Collar which started April 2021 and runs for 3 years beginning at an average of $4,150 for the first six months, $8,300 for twelve months, $8,549 for the next twelve months and $8,805 for the following twelve months.

 

 
F-32

Table of Contants

 

The following is a schedule showing the future minimum lease payments under operating leases by years and the present value of the minimum payments as of December 31, 2021. 

 

2022

 

$4,239,881

 

2023

 

 

1,435,216

 

2024

 

 

1,173,068

 

2025

 

 

741,035

 

2026

 

 

190,846

 

Thereafter

 

 

73,032

 

Total operating lease liabilities

 

 

7,853,079

 

Amount representing interest

 

 

(899,050 )

Total net present value

 

$6,964,028

 

 

Office lease used by CEO

 

During the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020, the Company entered into a lease of 12 months or less for living space which is occupied by Stephen Thomas, Chairman, CEO and President of the Company. Mr. Thomas lives in the space and uses it as his corporate office. The Company has paid $30,000 and $30,000 in rent and utility payments for this space for the year ended December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively.

 

Financing lease obligations

 

Future minimum lease payments are as follows:

 

2022

 

$966,759

 

2023

 

 

-

 

2024

 

 

-

 

2025

 

 

-

 

2026

 

 

-

 

Thereafter

 

 

-

 

Total financing lease liabilities

 

 

966,759

 

Amount representing interest

 

 

-

 

Total future payments (1)(2)

 

$966,759

 

 ____________________

(1) Included is a Telecom Equipment Lease is with an entity owned and controlled by shareholders of the Company and was due August 31, 2020, as amended.

 

(2) Also included are leases under Xroads Equipment Agreements with a third party that allows the Company to pay between $12,000 per month, including interest, starting July 2022. until paid with a $1 value acquisition price at the termination of the leases. These leases are delinquent for non payment.

 

Other Commitments and Contingencies

 

Employment Agreements

 

The Company has employment agreements with certain employees of SDM, K Telecom and Air Fitness. The agreements are such that SDM, K Telecom and Air Fitness, on a standalone basis in each case, must provide sufficient cash flow to financially support the financial obligations within the employment agreements.

 

On May 6, 2020, the Company entered into an agreement to employ Ms. Bing Caudle as Vice President of Product Development of the Media One Live platform for an annual salary of $250,000 for five years, including customary employee benefits. The payment is guaranteed for five years whether or not Ms. Caudle is dismissed with cause.

 

Litigation

 

On March 18, 2019, the Company issued to an Investor a convertible promissory note in the principal amount of $600,000.00 (the “Auctus Promissory Note”) and Warrant Agreement (the “Auctus Warrant Agreement”) pursuant to that certain securities purchase agreement dated March 18, 2019 (the “Auctus SPA”) with Auctus Fund, LLC (“Auctus”). Pursuant to claims by Auctus that the Company had not complied with terms of the Auctus SPA, the Company and Auctus entered into a settlement agreement dated October 13, 2021 where by the Company would pay $763,231.97 and allow Auctus to exercise its right to exercise 15,000,000 warrants to purchase 15,000,000 shares of common stock.  Auctus agreed to limit the sale of common shares of the Company to 2,000,000 during each respective calendar week. The Company recognized a gain on debt extinguishment of $7,068,339 when this Auctus Promissory Note was paid off in large part because of the related derivative liability on the books at the time of the settlement.

 

We have been named in a lawsuit by EMA Financial, LLC (“EMA”) for failing to comply with a Securities Purchase Agreement entered into in June 2019.   More specifically, EMA claims the Company failed to honor notices of conversion, failed to establish and maintain share reserves, failed to register EMA shares and by failed to assure that EMA shares were Rule 144 eligible within 6 months.  EMA has claimed in excess of $7,614,967 in relief.  The Company has filed a motion in response for which EMA has filed a motion to dismiss.   The Company does not believe at this time that any negative outcome would result in more than the $786,355 it has recorded on its balance sheet as of December 31, 2021.

 

 
F-33

Table of Contants

 

A lawsuit was filed in Michigan by the one of the former owners of SpeedConnect, LLC, John Ogren.   Mr. Ogren claimed he was owed back wages related to the acquisition agreement wherein the Company acquired the assets of SpeedConnect, LLC and kept him on through a consulting agreement. The Company’s position was that he ultimately resigned in writing and was not due any back wages.  In August 2021, Mr. Ogren was awarded $334,908 in back wages by an Arbitrator.  This amount has been included in accounts payable as of September 30, 2021 and expensed in the statement of operations as other expenses for the year ended December 31, 2021.  Mr. Ogren and the Company have agreed to a settlement whereby the Company would pay $120,000 within 14 days of a written agreement with four monthly payments of $20,000 starting on December 5, 2021 through March 2, 2022. This debt was completely paid off subsequent to December 31, 2021. The balance owing as of December 31, 2021 was $60,000 included in accounts payable.

 

We have been named in a lawsuit by a collection law firm on behalf of Pinnacle Towers LLC and Crown Atlantic Company Inc., against TPT Global Tech, Inc.  The claim derives from an outstanding debt by incurred by Copperhead Digital.  The lawsuit is over unpaid rent that should have been paid by Copperhead Digital but was not paid.  The Company believes it has several defenses to this claim and is in the process of communicating with opposing counsel for dismissal of the claims which amount to $386,030.62 plus interest, costs and attorney fees.  The Company has accounted for approximately $600,000 in payables on its consolidated balance sheet as of December 31, 2021 for this subsidiary payable.

 

Lawsuits are being threatened by vendors in relation to tower lease payments in accordance with tower lease agreements that were entered into by SpeedConnect.  The claims are currently being investigated and the amount in controversy being claimed is approximately $3,500,000. The Company has approximately $1,200,000 in accounts payable for these threatened claims as of December 31, 2021.  The claims appear to include lease agreements that have been terminated and future payments not yet due, among other issues.  As such, the parties are trying to come up with resolutions for these claims.

 

The Company has been named in a lawsuit, Robert Serrett vs. TruCom, Inc., by a former employee who was terminated by management in 2016. The employee was working under an employment agreement but was terminated for breach of the agreement. The former employee is suing for breach of contract and is seeking around $75,000 in back pay and benefits. We recently learned that Mr. Serrett received a default judgement in Texas on May 15, 2018 for $70,650 plus $3,500 in attorney fees and 5% interest and court costs.  However, he has made no attempt that we are aware of to obtain a sister state judgment in Arizona, where Trucom resides, or to try and enforce the judgement and collect.  Management believes it has good and meritorious defenses and does not belief the outcome of the lawsuit will have any material effect on the financial position of the Company. 

 

We are not currently involved in any litigation that we believe could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition or results of operations. There is no action, suit, proceeding, inquiry or investigation before or by any court, public board, government agency, self-regulatory organization or body pending or, to the knowledge of the executive officers of our company or any of our subsidiaries, threatened against or affecting our company, our common stock, any of our subsidiaries or of our companies or our subsidiaries’ officers or directors in their capacities as such, in which an adverse decision could have a material adverse effect. We anticipate that we (including current and any future subsidiaries) will from time to time become subject to claims and legal proceedings arising in the ordinary course of business. It is not feasible to predict the outcome of any such proceedings and we cannot assure that their ultimate disposition will not have a materially adverse effect on our business, financial condition, cash flows or results of operations.

 

Customer Contingencies

 

The Company has collected $338,725 from one customer in excess of amounts due from that customer in accordance with the customer’s understanding of the appropriate billings activity. The customer has filed a written demand for repayment by the Company of these amounts. Management believes that the customer agreement allows them to keep the amounts under dispute. Given the dispute, the Company has reflected the amounts in dispute as a customer liability on the consolidated balance sheet as of December 31, 2021 and 2020.

 

Stock Contingencies

 

The Company has convertible debt, preferred stock, options and warrants outstanding for which common shares would be required to be issued upon exercise by the holders.  As of December 31, 2021, the following shares would be issued:

 

 

 

2021

 

Convertible Promissory Notes

 

 

429,623,112

 

Series A Preferred Stock (1)

 

 

1,349,817,125

 

Series B Preferred Stock

 

 

2,588,693

 

Series D Preferred Stock

 

 

25,297,722

 

Stock Options and warrants

 

 

111,000,000

 

 

 

 

1,918,326,652

 

_____________________

(1) Holder of the Series A Preferred Stock which is Stephen J. Thomas, is guaranteed 60% of the then outstanding common stock upon conversion. The Company would have to authorize additional shares for this to occur as only 1,500,000,000 shares were authorized as of December 31, 2021 and 2,500,000,000 as of April 6, 2022.

 

 

 
F-34

Table of Contants

 

During the fourth quarter of 2020, the related party holders of approximately $4,700,000 of existing financing arrangements agreed to exchange their debt and accrued interest for Series D Preferred Stock through a separate $12 Million Private Placement, conditioned on the Company raising at least $12,000,000 in a separate Form 1-A Offering. 

 

Part of the consideration in the acquisition of Air Fitness was the issuance of 500,000 restricted common shares of the Company vesting and issuable after the common stock reaches at least a $1.00 per share closing price in trading.  To date, this has not occurred but may happen in the future upon which the Company will issue 500,000 common shares to the non-controlling interest owners of Air Fitness.

 

NOTE 10 – RELATED PARTY ACTIVITY

 

Accounts Payable and Accrued Expenses

 

There are amounts outstanding due to related parties of the Company of $2,294,570 and $1,507,418, respectively, as of December 31, 2021 and 2020 related to amounts due to employees, management and members of the Board of Directors according to verbal and written agreements that have not been paid as of period end which are included in accounts payable and accrued expenses on the balance sheet. See Note 9.

 

As is mentioned in Note 8, Reginald Thomas was appointed to the Board of Directors of the Company in August 2018. Mr. Thomas is the brother to the CEO Stephen J. Thomas III. According to an agreement with Mr. Reginald Thomas, he is to receive $10,000 per quarter and 1,000,000 shares of restricted common stock valued at approximately $120,000 vesting quarterly over twenty-four months. The quarterly payment of $10,000 may be suspended by the Company if the Company has not been adequately funded.

 

Leases

 

See Note 9 for office lease used by CEO.

 

Debt Financing and Amounts Payable

 

As of December 31, 2021, there are amounts due to management/shareholders of $49,452 included in notes payable – related party, of which $45,302 is payable from the Company to Stephen J. Thomas III, CEO of the Company.  See note 5.

 

Revenue Transactions and Accounts Receivable

 

During the year ended December 31, 2020, Blue Collar provided production services to an entity controlled by the Blue Collar CEO (355 LA, LLC or “355”) for which it recorded revenues of $385,988355 was formed in October 2019 by the CEO of Blue Collar for the purpose of production of certain additional footage for a 355 customer.  355 has opportunity to engage with other production relationships outside of using Blue Collar. 

 

Other Agreements

 

On April 17, 2018, the CEO of the Company, Stephen Thomas, signed an agreement with New Orbit Technologies, S.A.P.I. de C.V., a Mexican corporation, (“New Orbit”), majority owned and controlled by Stephen Thomas, related to a license agreement for the distribution of TPT licensed products, software and services related to Lion Phone and ViewMe Live within Mexico and Latin America (“License Agreement”). The License Agreement provides for New Orbit to receive a fully paid-up, royalty-free, non-transferable license for perpetuity with termination only under situations such as bankruptcy, insolvency or material breach by either party and provides for New Orbit to pay the Company fees equal to 50% of net income generated from the applicable activities. The transaction was approved by the Company’s Board of Directors in June 2018. There has been no activity on this agreement.

 

 
F-35

Table of Contants

 

NOTE 11 – GOODWILL AND INTANGIBLE ASSETS

 

Goodwill and intangible assets are comprised of the following:

 

December 31, 2021

 

 

 

Gross carrying amount

 

 

Accumulated Amortization

 

 

Net Book Value

 

 

Useful Life

 

Customer Base

 

$697,238

 

 

 

(310,359 )

 

$386,879

 

 

3-10

 

Developed Technology

 

 

4,595,600

 

 

 

(2,127,599 )

 

 

2,468,001

 

 

 

9

 

Film Library

 

 

957,000

 

 

 

(249,300 )

 

 

707,700

 

 

 

11

 

Trademarks and Tradenames

 

 

132,000

 

 

 

(38,339 )

 

 

93,661

 

 

 

12

 

Total intangible assets, net

 

$6,381,838

 

 

 

(2,725,597 )

 

$3,656,241

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Goodwill

 

$104,657

 

 

 

-

 

 

104,657

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2020

 

 

 

Gross carrying amount

 

 

Accumulated Amortization

 

 

Net Book Value

 

 

Useful Life

 

Customer Base

 

$938,000

 

 

 

(207,771 )

 

$730,229

 

 

3-10

 

Developed Technology

 

 

4,595,600

 

 

 

(1,616,975 )

 

 

2,978,625

 

 

 

9

 

Film Library

 

 

957,000

 

 

 

(177,100 )

 

 

779,900

 

 

 

11

 

Trademarks and Tradenames

 

 

132,000

 

 

 

(26,731 )

 

 

105,269

 

 

 

12

 

Favorable leases

 

 

95,000

 

 

 

(50,880 )

 

 

44,120

 

 

 

3

 

Other

 

 

76,798

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

76,798

 

 

 

 

 

Total intangible assets, net

 

$6,794,398

 

 

 

(2,079,457 )

 

$4,714,941

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Goodwill

 

$768,091

 

 

 

-

 

 

$768,091

 

 

 

 

 

 

Amortization expense was $728,192 and $730,940 for year ended December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively. 

 

There was no impairment considered necessary as of December 31, 2020 for intangibles. There was, however, impairment expense to intangibles of $330,508 for TPT SpeedConnect for the year ended December 31, 2021

 

In addition, there was impairment expense to Goodwill of $663,434 for Air Fitness and TPT SpeedConnect for the year ended December 31, 2021 and of $853,366 to Goodwill for Blue Collar during the years ended December 31, 2020.

 

Remaining amortization of the intangible assets is as following for the next five years and beyond:

 

2022

 

$662,079

 

2023

 

 

662,079

 

2024

 

 

662,079

 

2025

 

 

662,079

 

2026

 

 

662,079

 

Thereafter

 

 

345,846

 

 

 

$3,656,241

 

 

NOTE 12 – SEGMENT REPORTING

 

ASC 280, “Segment Reporting”, establishes standards for reporting information about operating segments on a basis consistent with the Company's internal organizational structure as well as information about geographical areas, business segments and major customers in financial statements for details on the Company's business segments.

 

The Company's chief operating decision maker (“CODM”) has been identified as the CEO who reviews the financial information of separate operating segments when making decisions about allocating resources and assessing performance of the group. Based on management's assessment, the Company considers its most significant segments for 2021 and 2020 are those in which it is providing Broadband Internet through TPT SpeedConnect and Media Production services through Blue Collar Medical Testing services through TPT MedTech and QuikLABs.

 

 
F-36

Table of Contants

 

The following table presents summary information by segment for the twelve months ended December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively:

 

2021

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

TPT SpeedConnect

 

 

Blue Collar

 

 

TPT

MedTech and QuikLABS

 

 

Corporate and other

 

 

Total

 

Revenue

 

$7,579,002

 

 

 

1,545,721

 

 

 

504,595

 

 

 

400,261

 

 

$10,029,579

 

Cost of revenue

 

$(5,676,202 )

 

 

(1,005,431 )

 

 

(792,061 )

 

 

(328,481 )

 

$(7,802,175 )

Net income (loss)

 

$(1,446,635 )

 

 

491,513

 

 

 

(1,318,921 )

 

 

(1,821,464 )

 

$(4,095,507 )

Total assets

 

$6,568,405

 

 

 

1,380,636

 

 

 

198,037

 

 

 

2,530,347

 

 

$10,677,425

 

Depreciation and amortization

 

$(621,774 )

 

 

(111,336 )

 

 

(40,170 )

 

 

(637,023 )

 

$(1,410,303 )

Impairment/gain on debt extinguishment

 

$391,567

 

 

 

747,137

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

6,338,293

 

 

$7,476,997

 

Derivative gain (expense)

 

$-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

(3,536,901 )

 

$(3,536,901 )

Interest expense

 

$(1,058,986 )

 

 

(38,798 )

 

 

-

 

 

 

(1,539,348 )

 

$(2,637,132 )

 

2020

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

TPT SpeedConnect

 

 

Blue Collar

 

 

TPT

MedTech and QuikLABS

 

 

Corporate and other

 

 

Total

 

Revenue

 

$9,958,770

 

 

 

1,051,120

 

 

 

30,484

 

 

 

53,796

 

 

$11,094,170

 

Cost of revenue

 

$(6,367,474)

 

 

(437,936)

 

 

(68,884)

 

 

(319,199)

 

$(7,193,493)

Net income (loss)

 

$983,673

 

 

 

(166,110)

 

 

(747,485)

 

 

(8,189,346)

 

$(8,119,268)

Total assets

 

$7,010,444

 

 

 

370,554

 

 

 

11,850

 

 

 

5,443,840

 

 

$12,836,688

 

Depreciation and amortization

 

$(531,254)

 

 

(111,336)

 

 

(3,583)

 

 

(1,139,470)

 

$(1,785,643)

Impairment/gain on debt extinguishment

 

$-

 

 

 

(853,366)

 

 

-

 

 

 

(1,849,630)

 

$(2,702,996)

Derivative gain (expense)

 

$-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

1,140,323

 

 

$1,140,323

 

Interest expense

 

$(242,693)

 

 

(36,507)

 

 

(800)

 

 

(1,251,733)

 

$(1,531,733)

 

NOTE 13 – SUBSEQUENT EVENTS

 

Subsequent to December 31, 2021, the authorized common shares of the Company has been increased to 2,500,000,000.

 

On January 31, 2022, TPT Global Tech, Inc. and Talos Victory Fund, LLC entered into a convertible promissory note totaling $271,750 and a securities purchase agreement (“Talos Note”). The Talos Note is due twelve months from funding, has an original issue discount of 8% and interest rate at 10% per annum (default, as defined, at 16%). There is an optional conversion in the event a Nasdaq Listing prior to nine months from funding for which the Holder’s principal and interest balances will be converted at a price equal to 25% discount to the opening price on the first day the Company trades on Nasdaq. There is also a voluntary conversion of all principal and accrued interest at the discretion of the Holder at $0.0075. The Holder was given registration rights. The Talos Note may be prepaid in whole or in part of the outstanding balances at 100% prior to maturity unless the Holder chooses to convert their balances into common stock which they have three days to do so. 73,372,499 common shares of the Company have been reserved with the transfer agent for possible conversion and exercise of warrants. Warrants, expiring five years from issuance, were issued to exercise up to 9,058,333 warrants to purchase 9,058,333 common shares at $0.015 per share provided, however, that if the Company consummates an uplist offering on or before July 6, 2022 then the exercise price shall be 110% of the offering price at which the uplist offering is made.  Details of the Talos Note and securities purchase agreement can be found in the Form 8-K and exhibits filed on February 8, 2022.

 

On January 31, 2022, TPT Global Tech, Inc. and Blue Lake Partners, LLC entered into a convertible promissory note totaling $271,750 and a securities purchase agreement (“Blue Lake Note”). The Blue Lake Note is due twelve months from funding, has an original issue discount of 8% and interest rate at 10% per annum (default, as defined, at 16%). There is an optional conversion in the event a Nasdaq Listing prior to nine months from funding for which the Holder’s principal and interest balances will be converted at a price equal to 25% discount to the opening price on the first day the Company trades on Nasdaq. There is also a voluntary conversion of all principal and accrued interest at the discretion of the Holder at $0.0075. The Holder was given registration rights. The Blue Lake Note may be prepaid in whole or in part of the outstanding balances at 100% prior to maturity unless the Holder chooses to convert their balances into common stock which they have three days to do so. 73,372,499 common shares of the Company have been reserved with the transfer agent for possible conversion and exercise of warrants. Warrants, expiring five years from issuance, were issued to exercise up to 9,058,333 warrants to purchase 9,058,333 common shares at $0.015 per share provided, however, that if the Company consummates an uplist offering on or before July 6, 2022 then the exercise price shall be 110% of the offering price at which the uplist offering is made. Details of the Blue Lake Note and securities purchase agreement can be found in the Form 8-K and exhibits filed on February 8, 2022.

 

 
F-37

Table of Contants

 

On April 1, 2022, the Company entered into a Future Receivable Sale and Purchase Agreement (“Mr Advance Agreement”) with Mr. Advance LLC (”MR.A”). The balance to be purchased and sold is $411,000 for which the Company received $270,715, net of fees. Under the Mr Advance Agreement, the Company is to pay $8,935 per week for 46 weeks at an effective interest rate of approximately 36% annually.

    

On April 1, 2022, the Company entered into a Future Receipts Sale and Purchase Agreement (“CLOUDFUND Agreement”) with CLOUDFUND LLC (”CLOUDFUND”). The balance to be purchased and sold is $411,000 for which the Company received $272,954, net of fees. Under the CLOUDFUND Agreement, the Company is to pay $8,935 per week for 46 weeks at an effective interest rate of approximately 36% annually.

  

Subsequent to December 31, 2021, holders of financing arrangements with the Company totaling $10,417,602 agreed to either forgive their balances owing to them by the Company or exchange their financing amounts outstanding as of March 31, 2022 for shares of Series E Preferred Stock of the Company. As such, 1,929,566 shares of Series E Preferred Stock were issued in exchange for $9,647,832 in outstanding financing arrangements and $769,770 was forgiven and will be recognized as a contribution to Mezzanine Equity. These amounts were calculated through March 31, 2022

  

Subsequent events were reviewed through the date the financial statements were issued.

 

 
F-38

Table of Contants

 

ITEM 9. CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE.

 

None.

 

ITEM 9A. CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES.

 

EVALUATION OF DISCLOSURE CONTROLS & PROCEDURES

 

Disclosure controls and procedures are controls and other procedures that are designed to ensure that information required to be disclosed in our reports filed or submitted under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 is recorded, processed, summarized and reported, within the time period specified in the SEC's rules and forms. Disclosure controls and procedures include, without limitation, controls and procedures designed to ensure that information required to be disclosed in our reports filed or submitted under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 is accumulated and communicated to management including our principal executive officer and principal financial officer as appropriate, to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosure.

 

In connection with this annual report, as required by Rule 15d-15 under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, we have carried out an evaluation of the effectiveness of the design and operation of our company's disclosure controls and procedures. Under the supervision of our Board of Directors, our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, acting as our principal executive officer and principal financial officer respectively, we conducted an evaluation of the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2021 based on the framework in Internal Control - Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission. Based on our evaluation under the framework in Internal Control - Integrated Framework (2013), our management concluded that our internal control over financial reporting was not effective as of December 31, 2021. Subject to the inherent limitations noted in this Part II, Item 9A as of December 31, 2021, our disclosure controls and procedures were not effective due to the existence of material weaknesses in our internal controls over financial reporting as discussed below. It is management's responsibility to establish and maintain adequate internal control over financial reporting.

 

This annual report does not include an attestation report of our independent registered public accounting firm regarding our internal control over financial reporting. Management's report on internal control over financial reporting was not subject to attestation by our independent registered public accounting firm pursuant to the rules of the SEC because we are neither an accelerated filer nor a larger accelerated filer.

 

We have implemented a framework used by management to evaluate the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting, which incorporates a quarterly review by our Board of Directors of the recording of transactions and whether questions of accuracy and authorization may arise as the accounting may be reviewed by our auditors.

 

Our Management's assessment of the effectiveness of internal controls over financial reporting as of the end of the most recent fiscal year, including a statement as to whether or not internal control over financial reporting is effective is contained in the section immediately following this paragraph.

 

MANAGEMENT'S REPORT ON INTERNAL CONTROL OVER FINANCIAL REPORTING

 

It is Management's responsibility to establish and maintain adequate internal control over financial reporting. The matters involving internal controls and procedures that our Company's management considered to be material weaknesses and may have been ineffective under the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board were: (1) lack of a functioning audit committee and lack of a majority of outside directors on our board of directors, resulting in ineffective oversight in the establishment and monitoring of required internal controls and procedures; (2) inadequate segregation of duties consistent with control objectives; (3) insufficient written policies and procedures for accounting and financial reporting with respect to the requirements and application of US GAAP and SEC disclosure requirements; and (4) ineffective controls over period end financial disclosure and reporting processes.

 

Management has assessed the effectiveness of its internal controls over financial reporting at the end of the most recent fiscal year and has determined several weaknesses and has determined that its internal controls are not effective due, in part, to lack of full-time financial accounting professionals.

 

Management believes that the material weaknesses and ineffectiveness set forth in items (2), (3) and (4) above did not have an affect on our Company's financial results. However, management believes that the lack of a functioning audit committee and lack of a majority of outside directors on our Company's board of directors, resulting in ineffective oversight in the establishment and monitoring of required internal controls and procedures may result in our Company's financial statements for the future years being subject to error and inaccurate if controls, procedures, and professional financial officers are not maintained.

 

 
71

Table of Contants

 

We are committed to improving our financial organization. As part of this commitment, we intend to create a position to segregate duties consistent with control objectives and intend to increase our personnel resources and technical accounting expertise within the accounting function when funds are available to our Company: i) Appointing one or more outside directors to our board of directors who shall be appointed to the audit committee of our Company resulting in a fully functioning audit committee who will undertake the oversight in the establishment and monitoring of required internal controls and procedures; and ii) preparing and implementing sufficient written policies and checklists which will set forth procedures for accounting and financial reporting with respect to the requirements and application of US GAAP and SEC disclosure requirements.

 

Management believes that the appointment of one or more outside directors, who shall be appointed to a fully functioning audit committee, will remedy the lack of a functioning audit committee and a lack of a majority of outside directors on our Company's Board. In addition, management believes that preparing and implementing sufficient written policies and checklists will remedy the following material weaknesses (i) insufficient written policies and procedures for accounting and financial reporting with respect to the requirements and application of US GAAP and SEC disclosure requirements; and (ii) ineffective controls over period end financial close and reporting processes. Further, management believes that the hiring of additional personnel who have the technical expertise and knowledge will result proper segregation of duties and provide more checks and balances within the department. Additional personnel will also provide the cross training needed to support our Company if personnel turn over issues within the department occur. This coupled with the appointment of additional outside directors will greatly decrease any control and procedure issues our Company may encounter in the future.

 

Due to insufficient funds during the year ended December 31, 2021, the Company has been unable to implement many of the remedies to the ineffective oversight. The Company will continue to implement the changes as laid out above as soon as funds are available to the Company.

 

We will continue to monitor and evaluate the effectiveness of our internal controls and procedures and our internal controls over financial reporting on an ongoing basis and are committed to taking further action and implementing additional enhancements or improvements, as necessary and as funds allow.

 

ITEM 9B. OTHER INFORMATION.

 

None.

 

ITEM 9C. DISCLOSURE REGARDING FOREIGN JURISDICTIONS THAT PREVENT INSPECTIONS.

 

Not applicable.

 

 
72

Table of Contants

 

PART III

 

ITEM 10. DIRECTORS, EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND CORPORATE GOVERNANCE.

 

The following table sets forth information as to persons who currently serve as our directors or executive officers, including their ages as of April 6, 2022.

 

Name

Age

Position

Term

Stephen J. Thomas, III

58

President, Chief Executive Officer and Chairman of the Board

Annual

Richard Eberhardt

64

Chief Operating Officer and Director

Annual

Arkady Shkolnik

58

Director

Annual

Reginald Thomas

57

Director

Annual

John F. Wharton

64

Director

Annual

Gary Cook

64

Chief Financial Officer

Annual

 

Our officers are elected by the board of directors at the first meeting after each annual meeting of our stockholders and hold office until their successors are duly elected and qualified under our bylaws.

 

The directors named above will serve until the next annual meeting of our stockholders. Thereafter, directors will be elected for one-year terms at the annual stockholders' meeting. Officers will hold their positions at the pleasure of the board of directors absent any employment agreement. There is no arrangement or understanding between our directors and officers and any other person pursuant to which any director or officer was or is to be selected as a director or officer.

 

BIOGRAPHICAL INFORMATION

 

Stephen J. Thomas, III – President, Chief Executive Officer and Chairman of the Board

 

Mr. Thomas was appointed President, CEO and Chairman of the Board of TPT Global Tech, Inc. on August 11, 2014. Previously, Mr. Thomas was Manager of TPT Group, LLC (2015-2017) and Director of TPT Group, Inc. (2011-2014). Mr. Thomas was founder, CEO and Director of Trans Pacific Telecom, Inc. from 2000-2011 and prior to that was president and CEO of New Orbit Communications (1999-2001). In 2002, as CEO of Trans Pacific Telecom Group, Mr. Thomas was featured on CBS MarketWatch for winning “Product of the Year Award for 2002” VIVOware at the Internet Telephony Conference and Expo an event focused on voice, video, fax and data convergence. During his employment with New Orbit, Mr. Thomas worked extensively throughout Latin America, gaining extensive expertise and resources in the international telecom marketplace. Mr. Thomas has also served as Director of Network Optimization/Validation for WorldxChange Communications, one of the largest privately held facilities-based telecommunications company with headquarters in San Diego, California and international operations all over the globe. His responsibilities included Cost Assurance for expenses. As a matter of disclosure, in 2005 Mr. Thomas was an ISP equipment provider to Access Point Africa (“APA”). APA allowed its license to expire in Sierra Leone, and as a result APA and several individuals were alleged to have violated the Sierra Leone Telecommunications Act by operating an unlicensed internet access point. Mr. Thomas was charged as well as for the offense which bears a fine of up to $3,000 but the charge is unresolved at this time, but he intends to resolve it in the next several months.

 

Mr. Thomas attended Northeastern University majoring in Finance and Management (1984 to 1987).

 

Richard Eberhardt- Executive Vice- President and Director

 

Mr. Eberhardt was appointed Executive Vice-President and Director of TPT Global Tech, Inc. on October 10, 2014. Mr. Eberhardt resigned as Executive Vice-President on December 15, 2020 and was simultaneously appointed as Chief Operating Officer. Mr. Eberhardt also serves as Chief Executive Officer of Copperhead Digital Holdings, LLC, a wholly-owned subsidiary of TPT Global, Inc. Previously, Mr. Eberhardt served CEO/COO of Pacific Bio Medical, a Durable Medical Equipment provider, located in Phoenix, Arizona (2008-2012). From 2012-2015, Mr. Eberhardt served as Consultant and Sales Director for two telecommunications companies, Fathom Voice and Ipitomy located in Indiana and Florida, respectively. Founding member of a telecommunications firm, WorldxChange, located in San Diego, CA. (1989-2001) With WorldxChange, he researched, designed, and implemented start-up business sales and marketing models resulting in wholesale, commercial, and consumer revenue channels. He opened and operated offices in approximately 23 countries. He created and managed channels with 25K+ agents and $15M in monthly revenue.

 

We believe his management experience is valuable to our company because he is an experienced sales and business development executive with strong business acumen and more than thirty years of experience leading sales and marketing operations. He has managed growth and revenue expansion through effective management of accounts and consultative sales approach that aligns the interests of all parties.

 

 
73

Table of Contants

 

He has sought, and negotiated, partnerships and asset management agreements across multiple channels, including wholesale telecom providers (AT&T, Verizon, Global Crossing, and Worldcom). He has managed structured methodologies that combined strengths of marketing, sales, and operations to reduce redundancies, improve order-processing times, and streamline business flow. He has experience in reviving product lines with rebranding and repackaging, as well as created communications bundles, and incentive programs to maximize existing client penetration and drive vertical growth.

 

Arkady Shkolnik – Director

 

Mr. Shkolnik was appointed a Director of TPT Global Tech, Inc. on August 15, 2018. Mr. Shkolnik has over 25 years of senior-level management experience in the Semiconductor, Wireless and Telecommunications industry. He is currently VP EMEA of Sales with Qualcomm (2010 – present). In addition to being a leader at Qualcom, Mr. Shkolnik served on the Board of Advisors at Zeevo Technology, Inc, (2009 to 2012) leading up to their acquisition by Broadcom and brings extensive experience in global business development, sales, marketing, product management and strategic account management to TPT Global’s already diverse board. From 2006 until 2010, Mr. Shkolnik was Vice President, EMEA Sales & Business Development of PacketVideo Corporation. Previous experience includes Executive Vice President, Sales & Business Development of Quorum Systems (2005-2006), Vice President, Sales & Business Development of Broadcom (acquired by Widcomm) from 2000-2005, and Director of Sales, North America Wireless ASIC Business Unit at Philips Semiconductors/VLSI Technology from 1991-2000.

 

Mr. Shkolnik has developed and managed strategic OEM and semiconductor relationships globally. Aligning sales and marketing functions with corporate objectives, he has negotiated and secured over ~100 License, Technology and CSA agreements with customers such as Samsung, LG, Sony, Panasonic, HTC, BlackBerry, Microsoft, IBM, HP, Dell, Compaq, Logitech, TDK, Acer, TI, Philips, STM, Broadcom, CSR, Toyota, Panasonic, ZTE, and others.

 

Mr. Shkolnik attended Temple University where he received a Bachelor of Applied Science (B.A.Sc.), Electrical and Electronics Engineering Skills & Endorsements (1984).

 

Reginald Thomas – Director

 

Mr. Thomas was appointed a Director of TPT Global Tech, Inc. on August 15, 2018. He has over 20 years of experience working for technology companies where he is an accomplished business leader driving world class customer and partner experiences though the delivery of innovative software products and solutions for leading global companies.  Specific results include:

 

Cisco: (July 2018 - present) As Partner Delivery Executive he supports 3 of Cisco’s largest Multi-National Partners- IBM US IBM Canada, and Presidio. He aligned these Partners go to market strategy with Cisco’s shifting business strategy to influence more than $15M in services sales in the last 14 months.

 

Cisco: (2007 - 2017) As the Sr. Product Manager he owned Cisco’s Services Portal strategy, the UX Strategy, the build, and adoption of Cisco’s Services Portal. Under his direction it grew from 2 to 24 integrated service offers delivering a seamless customer and partner experience.

 

Openwave: (2001 - 2007) IT Director of Program Management- through his leadership he designed the foundation for the Program Management Office that managed the upgrades to mission critical databases requiring the management of highly technical resources; multiple applications delivery from concept to development, companywide roll outs for ERP systems, and Merger & Acquisition consolidation.

 

Lucent /Avaya: (1997 - 2001) E- Commerce Product and Strategy Lead where he had global responsibility for Lucent’s online Partner Portal. He e- enabled Lucent to transition $10M of Distributor order revenue to a seamless online experience realizing significant savings in the cost per order.

 

Mr. Thomas graduated from the University of Connecticut in 1988 with a BS in Business.

 

John (General) F. Wharton -Director

 

Effective August 31, 2021, the Board of Directors of the Company appointed Major General John F. Wharton (“General Wharton”), former Commanding General of U.S Army Research, Development and Engineering Command who has been leading the Company’s Global Defense Division, as a director of the Company. Concurrently, General Wharton was appointed as Chairman of the Company’s subsidiary, TPT Global Defense Systems, LLC.

 

 
74

Table of Contants

 

General Wharton has served the Nation for more than three decades and has extensive experience in leadership, technology, acquisition, and logistics. He retired from active military duty on September 30, 2016. He is currently a public and private sector advisor to numerous industries, universities, and governments.  In his last military assignment, he was responsible for 75% ($6.2 billion) of the Army's annual R&D budget and led more than 13,000 scientists, engineers and support personnel.

 

General Wharton has been providing guidance and expertise for TPT’s Global Defense Division and has already been actively helping the Company across internal industry verticals in his capacity as a member of the Global Tech Advisory Board. His work with the Company’s telecoms, satellite, 5G and radar technologies units as well as his proactive involvement and contacts have resulted in expanded opportunities for domestic and international government contracts across geographies ranging from Europe, the Middle East, India, Africa and the Caribbean posturing TPT for future growth. 

 

General Wharton graduated from the United States Military Academy in West Point, New York in 1981. In addition, his education includes the Quartermaster Basic and Advanced Courses, the Inspector General's Course, the Command and General Staff College. He also holds a Master of Science degree in national security and strategic studies from the Naval War College.

 

Gary Cook – Chief Financial Officer

 

Mr. Cook was appointed Chief Financial Officer of TPT Global Tech, Inc. on November 1, 2017. Mr. Cook has served as Chief Financial Officer, Secretary or Treasurer for several small to medium size public and private companies in various industries for over 25 years including providing Chief Financial Officer services for several companies on a contract basis (2008-2017), in addition to full time employment with eVision USA.com, Inc. (1996-2002), Cognigen Networks, Inc. (2003-2008), and SolaRover, Inc. (2009-2015). Prior to this, Mr. Cook worked in the auditing department for KPMG in both the New Orleans, LA and Denver, CO offices for 12 years. 

 

His experience includes companies from start-ups to multimillion-dollar international operating companies in the internet marketing, software development, medical device, alternative energy, telecommunications, securities broker/dealer, private equity and manufacturing industries. While working with KPMG, Mr. Cook worked in other industries such as oil & gas, oil & gas services, cable, theatre exhibition, mining, banking, construction and not-for-profit. 

 

Mr. Cook has a broad experience in accounting, finance, human resources, legal, insurance, contracts, banking relations, shareholder relations, internal controls, SEC matters, financial reporting and other corporate administrative and governance matters for both private and public companies. Mr. Cook has held Series 7, 24, 27 and 63 licenses from FINRA, successor to the NASD. 

 

Mr. Cook attended and graduated from Brigham Young University between 1979 and 1982. He is a certified public accountant and licensed with the State of Colorado.

 

KEY EMPLOYEES OF SUBSIDIARIES

 

Steve Caudle - CEO Cloud Services

 

Steve Caudle has been in the technology field for 31 years and brings significant operations and technology development experiences to TPT Global Tech, Inc. Mr. Caudle began his career at the IBM “Think Tank” and Fairchild/National Semiconductor located in Silicon Valley California. Steve then moved on to work for the Department of Defense for eighteen years and specialized in code writing and software applications. Steve moved to the private sector and was the Chief Information Officer (CIO) at North Face Corporation and then moved to become the Executive VP of ZDTV (renamed TechTV) and then became C-NET now owned by CBS.

 

Robert Haas, CEO of Levi Strauss, contracted Mr. Caudle as an executive consultant where he was placed in charge of relocating their data center from San Francisco, California to Dallas, Texas (1988).

 

Subsequently, Mr. Caudle joined ESST, where he was the CIO. ESST was a public company. Steve Caudle then joined Mr. Fred Chan, CEO of ESST in starting a new company called Vialta, Inc. Mr. Caudle was again the CIO and the number two person in charge of Vialta. Vialta designed DVD laser decoder chips that were used in many DVD players in the world. Vialta grew the company from 3 employees to over 4,000 in just five months and over $1.2 billion in revenue while he was there.

 

Upon leaving Vialta, Mr. Caudle started his own software development company called Matrixsites. Matrixsites has developed software and applications for a variety of companies such as Federal Express, Wells Fargo Bank, Bank of America, Apple, Pixar, ITV Guide and China Mobile.

 

 
75

Table of Contants

 

Mr. Caudle received his Bachelor of Science Degree in Electrical Engineering from San Jose State University in 1977 and holds one U.S. Patent.

 

Mark Rowen- CEO Media Division

 

Mark Rowen is a seasoned executive with over 25 years in the film and television business. In 2000, Mr. Rowen founded Blue Collar Productions, Inc., an entity with which we entered into an acquisition agreement in November 2017 and amended in February 2018, where he remains President today. Blue Collar is a leader in the creation of original live action and animated content and has produced hundreds of hours of material for the television, theatrical, home entertainment and new media markets. Mr. Rowen works closely with all of the major television networks, cable channels and film studios to produce home entertainment products.

 

Mr. Rowen also works with a wide array of notable filmmakers including Steven Spielberg, Ron Howard, Brett Ratner and James Cameron to name a few. Mr. Rowen also has very close working relationships with actors including Tom Hanks, Brad Pitt, Julia Roberts, Robert Downey, Jr., Denzel Washington, Ryan Gosling, Sofia Vergara, Mariska Hargitay and many others.

 

Prior to starting Blue Collar Productions, Mr. Rowen functioned as the head of home entertainment production for DreamWorks SKG from 1997 to 2000. He also serves as the President of Long Leash Entertainment, an aggregator of entertainment based intellectual property and creator of high-end entertainment content.

 

Mr. Rowen is a graduate of the University of California, Los Angeles. He is also actively involved in charitable organizations including Stand Up 2 Cancer, The Joyful Heart Foundation, Save The Children, and other philanthropic endeavors in the arts.

 

CONFLICTS OF INTEREST – GENERAL.

 

Our directors and officers are, or may become, in their individual capacities, officers, directors, controlling shareholders and/or partners of other entities engaged in a variety of non-profit and for-profit organizations. Thus, there exist potential conflicts of interest including, among other things, time, efforts and corporation opportunity, involved in participation with such other business entities.

 

CONFLICTS OF INTEREST – CORPORATE OPPORTUNITIES

 

Presently no requirement contained in our Articles of Incorporation, Bylaws, or minutes which requires our officers and directors to disclose business opportunities which come to their attention. Our officers and directors do, however, have a fiduciary duty of loyalty to us to disclose to us any business opportunities which come to their attention, in their capacity as an officer and/or director or otherwise. Excluded from this duty would be opportunities which the person learns about through his involvement as an officer and director of another company. We have no intention of merging with or acquiring an affiliate, associate person or business opportunity from any affiliate or any client of any such person.

 

COMMITTEES OF THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS

 

We are managed under the direction of its board of directors.

 

EXECUTIVE COMMITTEE

 

We do not have an executive committee, at this time.

 

AUDIT COMMITTEE

 

We do not have an audit committee, at this time.

 

ANNUAL MEETING

 

The annual meeting of stockholders is anticipated in the Fall of 2022 and will include the election of directors. The annual meeting will be held at our principal office or at such other place as permitted by the laws of the State of Florida and on such date as may be fixed from time to time by resolution of our board of directors.

 

PREVIOUS "BLANK CHECK" OR "SHELL" COMPANY INVOLVEMENT

 

No members of our management have been involved in previous "blank-check" or "shell" companies.

 

 
76

Table of Contants

 

INVOLVEMENT IN LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

 

No executive Officer or Director of our Company has been convicted in any criminal proceeding (excluding traffic violations) or is the subject of a criminal proceeding that is currently pending.

 

No executive Officer or Director of our Company is the subject of any pending legal proceedings.

 

No Executive Officer or Director of our Company is involved in any bankruptcy petition by or against any business in which they are a general partner or executive officer at this time or within two years of any involvement as a general partner, executive officer, or Director of any business.

 

ITEM 11. EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION.

 

Summary of Executives and Director Compensation Table

 

The following table sets forth the compensation paid to our officers from the years ended December 31, 2021, 2020, 2019, and 2018.

 

SUMMARY EXECUTIVES COMPENSATION TABLE

In Dollars

 

Name & Position

 

Year

 

Salary

($)

 

 

Bonus

($)

 

 

Stock awards

($)

 

 

Option awards

($)

 

 

Non-equity incentive plan compensation

($)

 

 

Non-qualified deferred compensation earnings

($)

 

 

All other compensation

($)

 

 

Total

($) (2)

 

Stephen J. Thomas, III CEO and President

 

2021

 

 

270,000

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(1)

 

 

270,000

(2)

 

 

2020

 

 

262,083

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(1)

 

 

262,083

(2)

 

 

2019

 

 

175,000

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(1)

 

 

175,000

(2)

 

 

2018

 

 

98,790

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(1)

 

 

98,790

(2)

Richard Eberhardt, COO

 

2021

 

 

170,000

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

10,704

(3)

 

 

180,704

(2)

 

 

2020

 

 

169,250

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

169,250

(2)

 

 

2019

 

 

110,242

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

110,242

(2)

 

 

2018

 

 

21,115

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

21,115

(2)

Gary Cook, CFO

 

2021

 

 

200,000

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

200,000

(2)

 

 

2020

 

 

219,167

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

219,167

(2)

 

 

2019

 

 

112,150

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

112,150

(2)

 

 

2018

 

 

45,100

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

45,100

(2)

Stacie Stricker, Secretary and Controller (4)

 

2021

 

 

35,000

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

35,000

(2)

 

 

2020

 

 

135,000

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

135,000

(2)

 

 

2019

 

 

80,750

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

80,750

(2)

 

 

2018

 

 

52,850

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

52,850

(2)

______________________ 

(2)

The Company entered into a lease for living space which is occupied by Stephen Thomas, Chairman, CEO and President of the Company. Mr. Thomas lives in the space and uses it as his corporate office. The Company has paid approximately $30,000, $30,000 and $30,857 in rent and utility payments for the year ended December 31, 2021, and the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively. No portion of the payments on this lease have been included in amounts shown in compensation to Mr. Stephen Thomas and has approximated $30,000 to $40,000 a year in 2015-2018.

 

 

(3)

These amounts do not include compensation that has been accrued on the books of the Company in accordance with employment agreements and other previous contract work performed but has not been paid because of the lack of cash flows. Accrued but unpaid compensation as of December 31, 2021 is as follows: Stephen J. Thomas, III - $0; Richard Eberhardt - $161,644; and Gary Cook - $164,696.

 

 

(4)

Represents a monthly car allowance paid by the Company.

 

 

(5)

Ms. Stricker resigned as an employee of the Company in March 2021.

 

 
77

Table of Contants

 

Employment Contracts and Termination of Employment and Change-in-Control Arrangements

 

The initial term for our three executive employees employment agreements have expired and they are now working under an extended period which primarily calls for a 30-day notice for any changes or termination.  The Board is working to revise the executive employment agreements.  Below is a summary of current terms for our three executives which is, for the most part, an extension of their prior employment agreements, as well as those consulting agreements for the outside directors. The prior employment agreements were approved by our board based upon recommendations conducted by the board.

 

Name

 

Position

 

Annual Compensation

 

Stephen J. Thomas, III (1)

 

Chief Executive Officer

 

$250,000

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Richard Eberhardt (2)

 

Chief Operating Officer

 

$150,000

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Gary Cook (3)

 

Chief Financial Officer

 

$200,000

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Arkady Shkolnik (4)

 

Director

 

$100,000

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Reginald Thomas (5)

 

Director

 

$40,000

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

John F. Wharton (6)

 

Director

 

$180,000

 

 _____________________________

(1) Pursuant to an employment agreement dated November 1, 2017, and now is in an extended period, Mr. Thomas receives a base salary of $250,000 per year. In addition to the base salary, Mr. Thomas is eligible to receive performance bonuses as to be determined by our Board of Directors. The agreement had a three-year term that ended on October 31, 2020 and now is in an extended period.

 

Upon an affirmative vote of not less than two-thirds of the Board of Directors, the employment may be terminated without further liability on the part of our Company. Cause is considered to be an act or acts of serious dishonesty fraud, or material and deliberate injury related to our business, including personal enrichment at the expense of our Company. If there is a termination for cause the benefits of any bonus for the period preceding termination would be forfeit.

 

In addition, the agreement provides for Mr. Thomas to be able to terminate the agreement for Good Reason. Good Reason is considered to be (1) an adverse change in his status or position as CEO, (2) a reduction in base salary, or (3) action by us that adversely affected his participation in the benefits.

 

(2) Pursuant to an employment agreement dated November 1, 2017, and now is in an extended period, Mr. Eberhardt receives a base salary of $150,000 per year. In addition to the base salary, Mr. Eberhardt is eligible to receive performance bonuses as to be determined by our Board of Directors. The agreement had a three-year term that ended on October 31, 2020 and now is in an extended period.

 

Upon an affirmative vote of not less than two-thirds of the Board of Directors, the employment may be terminated without further liability on the part of our Company. Cause is considered to be an act or acts of serious dishonesty fraud, or material and deliberate injury related to our business, including personal enrichment at the expense of our Company. If there is a termination for cause the benefits of any bonus for the period preceding termination would be forfeit.

 

In addition, the agreement provides for Mr. Eberhardt to be able to terminate the agreement for Good Reason. Good Reason is considered to be (1) an adverse change in his status or position as CEO, (2) a reduction in base salary, or (3) action by us that adversely affected his participation in the benefits.

 

(3) Pursuant to an employment agreement dated November 1, 2017, and now is in an extended period, Mr. Cook receives a base salary of $200,000 per year for which currently he devotes no less than 60% of his full-time. In addition to the base salary, Mr. Cook is eligible to receive performance bonuses as to be determined by our Board of Directors. The agreement had a three-year term that ended on October 31, 2020 and now is in an extended period.

 

Upon an affirmative vote of not less than two-thirds of the Board of Directors, the employment may be terminated without further liability on the part of our Company. Cause is considered to be an act or acts of serious dishonesty fraud, or material and deliberate injury related to our business, including personal enrichment at the expense of our Company. If there is a termination for cause the benefits of any bonus for the period preceding termination would be forfeit.

 

 
78

Table of Contants

 

In addition, the agreement provides for Mr. Cook to be able to terminate the agreement for Good Reason. Good Reason is considered to be (1) an adverse change in his status or position as CEO, (2) a reduction in base salary, or (3) action by us that adversely affected his participation in the benefits.

 

(4) In accordance with an Independent Director Agreement with the Company for his services as a director, Mr. Shkolnik is to receive $25,000 per quarter and 5,000,000 shares of restricted common stock valued at approximately $687,500 vesting quarterly over twenty-four months. The quarterly cash payments of $25,000 will be paid in unrestricted common shares if the Company has not been funded adequately to make such payments.

 

(5) In accordance with an Independent Director Agreement with the Company for his services as director, Mr. Thomas is to receive $10,000 per quarter and 1,000,000 shares of restricted common stock valued at approximately $119,000 vesting quarterly over twenty-four months. The quarterly payment of $10,000 may be suspended by the Company if the Company has not been adequately funded.

 

(6) In accordance with an agreement with General Wharton, the Company is to pay General Wharton $8,000 per month for months one and two, $10,000 per months for months three and four and $15,000 per month thereafter starting August 1, 2021 for a term of three years with mutual agreement of additional years.  Either General Wharton or the Company can terminate the agreement upon notice of three months by either party.  In addition, General Wharton is to receive 3,000,000 shares of common stock of the Company vested over two years, fully vested, as defined, for a major contract or funding event that he generates.

 

Compensation Committee Interlocks and Insider Participation

 

Our board of directors in our entirety acts as the compensation committee for TPT Global Tech, Inc.

 

BOARD OF DIRECTORS COMPENSATION

 

All of our officers and/or directors will continue to be active in other companies. All officers and directors have retained the right to conduct their own independent business interests.

 

The term of office for each Director is one (1) year, or until his/her successor is elected at our annual meeting and qualified. The term of office for each of our Officers is at the pleasure of the Board of Directors.

 

The Board of Directors has no nominating, auditing committee or a compensation committee. Therefore, the selection of person or election to the Board of Directors was neither independently made nor negotiated at arm's length.

 

At this time, our Directors do not receive cash compensation for serving as members of our Board of Directors.

 

Only our outside Directors receive cash compensation for serving as members of our Board of Directors.

 

(REMAINDER OF PAGE LEFT BLANK INTENTIONALLY)

 

 
79

Table of Contants

 

The following table sets forth certain information concerning compensation paid to our directors for services as directors, but not including compensation for services as officers reported in the "Summary Executives’ Compensation Table" during the years ended December 31, 2021, 2020, 2019, and 2018:

 

Name

 

Year

 

Fees earned or paid in cash

($)

 

 

Stock awards ($)

 

 

Option awards

 ($)

 

 

Non-equity incentive plan compensation

($)

 

 

Non-qualified deferred compensation earnings

($)

 

 

All other compensation

 ($)

 

 

Total

($)

 

Stephen J. Thomas, III (1)

 

2021

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2020

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2019

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2018

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Richard Eberhardt (2)

 

2021

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2020

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2019

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2018

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Arkady Shkolnik (3)

 

2021

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2020

 

 

100,000

 

 

 

201,979

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

301,979

 

 

 

2019

 

 

100,000

 

 

 

346,250

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

446,250

 

 

 

2018

 

 

37,500

 

 

 

144,271

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

181,771

 

Reginald Thomas (3)

 

2021

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2020

 

 

40,000

 

 

 

35,000

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

75,000

 

 

 

2019

 

 

40,000

 

 

 

60,000

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

100,000

 

 

 

2018

 

 

15,000

 

 

 

25,000

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

40,000

 

John F. Wharton (4)

 

2021

 

 

30,000

 

 

 

8,875

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

38,875

 

________

(1)

Mr. Thomas is also an officer and as such he receives the compensation as disclosed in the Executive Compensation Table.

(2)

Mr. Eberhardt is also an officer and as such he receives the compensation as disclosed in the Executive Compensation Table.

(3)

In August 2018, a majority of the outstanding voting shares of the Company voted through a consent resolution to support a consent resolution of the Board of Directors of the Company to add two new directors to the Board. As such, Arkady Shkolnik and Reginald Thomas were added as members of the Board of Directors. The total members of the Board of Directors after this addition is four. In accordance with agreements with the Company for his services as a director, Mr. Shkolnik is to receive $25,000 per quarter and 5,000,000 shares of restricted common stock valued at approximately $687,500 vesting quarterly over twenty-four months. The quarterly cash payments of $25,000 will be paid in unrestricted common shares if the Company has not been funded adequately to make such payments. Mr. Thomas is to receive $10,000 per quarter and 1,000,000 shares of restricted common stock valued at approximately $119,000 vesting quarterly over twenty-four months. The quarterly payment of $10,000 may be suspended by the Company if the Company has not been adequately funded.  Both the 5,000,000 and 1,000,000 shares granted were issued during the year ended December 31, 2020 and are no longer reflected in subscriptions payable as of December 31, 2021 or December 31, 2020. 

(4)

General Wharton was appointed a Director effective August 1, 2021. In accordance with an agreement with General Wharton, the Company is to pay General Wharton $8,000 per month for months one and two, $10,000 per months for months three and four and $15,000 per month thereafter starting August 1, 2021 for a term of three years with mutual agreement of additional years.  Either General Wharton or the Company can terminate the agreement upon notice of three months by either party.  In addition, General Wharton is to receive 3,000,000 shares of common stock of the Company vested over two years, fully vested, as defined, for a major contract or funding event that he generates.

 

 
80

Table of Contants

 

Limitation on Liability and Indemnification

 

We are a Florida corporation. The Florida Revised Statutes provide that the articles of incorporation of a Florida corporation may contain a provision eliminating or limiting the personal liability of a director to the corporation or our stockholders for monetary damages for breach of fiduciary duty as a director, except that any such provision may not eliminate or limit the liability of a director (i) for any breach of the director’s duty of loyalty to the corporation or our stockholders, (ii) acts or omissions not in good faith or which involve intentional misconduct or a knowing violation of law, (iii) acts specified in Section 78 (concerning unlawful distributions), or (iv) any transaction from which a director directly or indirectly derived an improper personal benefit. Our articles of incorporation contain a provision eliminating the personal liability of directors to our company’ or our stockholders for monetary damages to the fullest extent provided by the Florida Revised Statutes.

 

The Florida Revised Statutes provides that a Florida corporation must indemnify a person who was wholly successful, on the merits or otherwise, in defense of any threatened, pending, or completed action, suit, or proceeding, whether civil, criminal, administrative, or investigative and whether formal or informal (a “Proceeding”), in which he or she was a party because the person is or was a director, against reasonable expenses incurred by him or her in connection with the Proceeding, unless such indemnity is limited by the corporation’s articles of incorporation. Our articles of incorporation do not contain any such limitation.

 

The Florida Revised Statutes provide that a Florida corporation may indemnify a person made a party to a Proceeding because the person is or was a director against any obligation incurred with respect to a Proceeding to pay a judgment, settlement, penalty, fine (including an excise tax assessed with respect to an employee benefit plan) or reasonable expenses incurred in the Proceeding if the person conducted himself or herself in good faith and the person reasonably believed, in the case of conduct in an official capacity with the corporation, that the person’s conduct was in the corporation’s best interests and, in all other cases, his or her conduct was at least not opposed to the corporation’s best interests and, with respect to any criminal proceedings, the person had no reasonable cause to believe that his or her conduct was unlawful. Our articles of incorporation and bylaws allow for such indemnification. A corporation may not indemnify a director in connection with any Proceeding by or in the right of the corporation in which the director was adjudged liable to the corporation or, in connection with any other Proceeding charging that the director derived an improper personal benefit, whether or not involving actions in an official capacity, in which Proceeding the director was judged liable on the basis that he or she derived an improper personal benefit. Any indemnification permitted in connection with a Proceeding by or in the right of the corporation is limited to reasonable expenses incurred in connection with such Proceeding.

 

The Florida Revised Statutes, unless otherwise provided in the articles of incorporation, a Florida corporation may indemnify an officer, employee, fiduciary, or agent of the corporation to the same extent as a director and may indemnify such a person who is not a director to a greater extent, if not inconsistent with public policy and if provided for by our bylaws, general or specific action of our board of directors or stockholders, or contract. Our articles of incorporation provide for indemnification of our directors, officers, employees, fiduciaries and agents to the full extent permitted by Florida law.

 

Our articles of incorporation also provide that we may purchase and maintain insurance on behalf of any person who is or was a director or officer of our company or who is or was serving at our request as a director, officer or agent of another enterprise against any liability asserted against him or her and incurred by him or her in any such capacity or arising out of his or her status as such, whether or not we would have the power to indemnify him or her against such liability.

 

EQUITY COMPENSATION PLAN INFORMATION

 

Key Employees Stock Compensation Plan

 

Effective October 14, 2017, we adopted the 2017 TPT Global Tech, Inc. Stock Option and Award Incentive Plan (the "Plan"). The Plan provides for grants of nonqualified stock options and other stock awards, including warrants, to designated employees, officers, directors, advisors and independent contractors. A maximum of 20,000,000 shares of our common stock were reserved for options and other stock awards under the Plan. We have the ability to issue either options or warrants under the Plan.

 

OPTION/WARRANT GRANTS IN THE LAST FISCAL YEAR

 

On October 14, 2017, the Board of Directors and majority stockholders of TPT approved the 2017 TPT Global Tech, Inc. Stock Option and Award Incentive Plan (“the 2017 Plan.”) There are 20,000,000 shares of our common stock reserved under the 2017 Plan.

 

As of December 31, 2021, we had no options outstanding to purchase shares of common stock of the Company.

 

During the year ended December 31, 2021, 110,000,000 warrants were issued to purchase 110,000,000 shares of common stock in conjunction with financing arrangements entered into. See Note 8 of the consolidated financial statements.

   

 
81

Table of Contants

 

Option/Warrant Grants In The Last Fiscal Year

 

On October 14, 2017, the Board of Directors and majority stockholders of TPT approved the 2017 TPT Global Tech, Inc. Stock Option and Award Incentive Plan (“the 2017 Plan.”) There are 20,000,000 shares of our common stock reserved under the 2017 Plan.

 

As of April 6, 2022, the Company has 111,000,000 warrants outstanding that expire in five years or in the year ended December 31, 2026 aside from those issued under the convertible notes of 128,116,666.  As part of the Convertible Promissory Notes payable – third party issuance in Note 5, the Company issued 3,333,333warrants to purchase 3,333,333 common shares of the Company at 70% of the current market price, of which 1,000,000 warrants remained outstanding.  Current market price means the average of the three lowest trading prices for our common stock during the ten-trading day period ending on the latest complete trading day prior to the date of the respective exercise notice.

 

During the year ended December 31, 2021, the Company issued warrants in conjunction with the issuance of the FirstFire Note, the Cavalry Investment Note and the Cavalry Fund I Note agreements.  Warrants to purchase 110,000,000 shares of common stock at 110% of the opening price on the first day the Company trades on the Nasdaq exchange were issued to these note holders.

 

Outstanding Equity Awards At Fiscal Year End

 

The following table sets forth certain information concerning outstanding equity awards held by our appointed executive officers for year ended December 31, 2021 (the "Named Executive Officers"):

 

 

 

Option Awards

 

 

Stock awards

 

Name

 

Number of securities underlying unexercised options (#) exercisable

 

 

Number of securities underlying unexercised options (#) unexercisable

 

 

Equity incentive plan awards: Number of securities underlying unexercised unearned options

(#)

 

 

Option exercise price

($)

 

 

Option expiration date

 

 

Number of shares or units of stock that have not vested

(#)

 

 

Market value of shares of units of stock that have not vested

($)

 

 

Equity incentive plan awards: Number of unearned shares, units or other rights that have not vested (#)

 

 

Equity incentive plan awards: Market or payout value of unearned shares, units or others rights that have not vested

($)

 

Stephen J. Thomas, III, CEO and Chairman (1)

 

 

--

 

 

 

--

 

 

 

--

 

 

 

--

 

 

 

--

 

 

 

--

 

 

 

--

 

 

 

--

 

 

 

--

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Richard Eberhardt, Executive VP

 

 

--

 

 

 

--

 

 

 

--

 

 

 

--

 

 

 

--

 

 

 

--

 

 

 

--

 

 

 

--

 

 

 

--

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Gary Cook, CFO

 

 

--

 

 

 

--

 

 

 

--

 

 

 

--

 

 

 

--

 

 

 

--

 

 

 

--

 

 

 

--

 

 

 

--

 

______________________

 

(1)

Does not contemplate the Series A Preferred Stock held 100% by Stephen J. Thomas, III which guarantees the holder to 60% of the outstanding common stock in shares when converted and 60% of any vote prior to or after conversion. As of December 31, 2021, approximately 1,349,817,125 additional common shares would be issued if Mr. Thomas were to convert his Series A Preferred Stock holdings to common stock. The Company would have to authorize more shares as there are only 2,500,000,000 shares authorized currently.

 

ITEM 12. SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT AND RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS.

 

The following table sets forth information regarding beneficial ownership of our common stock as of April 6, 2022 by:

 

 

·

each of our directors and the named executive officers;

 

 

 

 

·

all of our directors and executive officers as a group; and

 

 

 

 

·

each person or group of affiliated persons known by us to be the beneficial owner of more than 5% of our outstanding shares of common stock.

 

 
82

Table of Contants

 

Beneficial ownership and percentage ownership are determined in accordance with the rules of the Securities and Exchange Commission and includes voting or investment power with respect to shares of stock.  This information does not necessarily indicate beneficial ownership for any other purpose.

 

Unless otherwise indicated, such as the case with voting percentages, and subject to applicable community property laws, to our knowledge, each stockholder named in the following table possesses sole voting and investment power over their shares of common stock, except for those jointly owned with that person’s spouse.  Percentage of beneficial ownership before the offering is based on 923,029,038 shares of common stock outstanding as of April 6, 2022.

 

OFFICERS AND DIRECTORS 

 

 Title of Class

 

Name and Address of Beneficial Owner (1)

 

Amount and Nature of Beneficial Owner

 

Percent of Class Outstanding Common Shares (2)

 

Number of Common Shares & Warrants if fully exercised

 

Percent of Class including Warrants

(6)

 

Percent of Class including all classes of voting stock (7)

 

Common Stock

 

Stephen J. Thomas, III,

Chairman, President, Chief Executive Officer and Director

 

 

13,890,573

(3)

 

 

1.50

%

 

 

13,890,573

 

 

 

1.50

%

 

60

%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Common Stock

 

Richard Eberhardt, Director and Executive Vice President

 

 

17,000,000

 

 

 

1.84

%

 

 

17,000,000

 

 

 

1.84

%

 

0.75

%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Common Stock

 

Arkady Shkolnik, Director

 

 

5,000,000

(4)

 

 

.54

%

 

 

5,000,000

 

 

 

.54

%

 

.22

%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Common Stock

 

Reginald Thomas, Director

 

 

1,165,000

(4)

 

 

.13

%

 

 

1,165,000

 

 

 

.13

%

 

.05

%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Common Stock

 

John F. Wharton, Director

 

 

1,000,000

(5)

 

 

.08

%

 

 

1,000,000

 

 

 

.08

%

 

.04

%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Common Stock

 

Gary Cook, Chief Financial Officer

 

 

5,006,281

 

 

 

.54

%

 

 

5,006,281

 

 

 

.54

%

 

.22

%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Common shares

 

All Directors and Executive Officers as a Group (6 persons)

 

 

43,061,854

 

 

 

4.64

%

 

 

42,811,854

 

 

 

4.64

%

 

61.28

%

___________________

 

(1)

The Address for the above individuals and entities is c/o 501 West Broadway, Suite 800, San Diego, CA 92101.

 

(2)

Based upon 923,029,038 shares issued and outstanding as of April 6, 2022.

 

(3)

Based upon 923,029,038 shares issued and outstanding as of April 6, 2022. Does not contemplate the Series A Preferred Stock held 100% by Stephen J. Thomas, III which guarantees the holder to 60% of the outstanding common stock in shares when converted and 60% of any vote prior to or after conversion. As of December 31, 2021, approximately 1,349,817,125 additional common shares would be issued if Mr. Thomas were to convert his Series A Preferred Stock holdings to common stock. 

 

(4)

In August 2018, the Company added two new directors to the Board. Arkady Shkolnik and Reginald Thomas were added as members of the Board of Directors. The total members of the Board of Directors after this addition is four. In accordance with agreements with the Company for his services as a director, Mr. Shkolnik received 5,000,000 shares of restricted common stock and Mr. Thomas received 1,000,000 shares of restricted common stock.

 

(5)

Effective August 1, 2021 the Company added another director to the Board, General John F. Wharton who is to receive 3,000,000 shares of common stock of the Company vested over two years.

 

(6)

Assuming full exercise of any stock options or warrants.

 

(7)

Calculated using voting shares from all classes of common and preferred voting shares.

 

 
83

Table of Contants

 

GREATER THAN 5% STOCKHOLDERS

 

 Title of Class

 

Name and Address of Beneficial Owner (1)

 

Amount and Nature of Beneficial Owner

 

Percent of Class Outstanding Common Shares (2)

 

Number of Common Shares & Warrants if fully exercised

 

Percent of Class including Warrants

(4)

 

Percent of Class including all classes of voting stock (5)

 

Common Stock

 

Stephen J. Thomas, III,

Chairman, President, Chief Executive Officer and Director

 

 

13,890,573

(3)

 

 

1.50

%

 

 

13,890,573

 

 

 

1.50

%

 

60

%

___________

 

(1)

The Address for the above individuals and entities is c/o 501 West Broadway, Suite 800, San Diego, CA 92101.

 

(2)

Based upon 923,029,038 shares issued and outstanding as of April 6, 2022.

 

(3)

Does not contemplate the Series A Preferred Stock held 100% by Stephen J. Thomas, III which guarantees the holder to 60% of the outstanding common stock in shares when converted and 60% of any vote prior to or after conversion. As of December 31, 2021, approximately 1,349,817,125 additional common shares would be issued if Mr. Thomas were to convert his Series A Preferred Stock holdings to common stock.   The Company would have to authorize more shares as there are only 2,500,000,000 shares authorized currently.

 

(4)

Assuming full exercise of any stock options or warrants.

 

(5)

Calculated using voting shares from all classes of common and preferred voting shares.

 

Rule 13d-3 under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 governs the determination of beneficial ownership of securities. That rule provides that a beneficial owner of a security includes any person who directly or indirectly has or shares voting power and/or investment power with respect to such security. Rule 13d-3 also provides that a beneficial owner of a security includes any person who has the right to acquire beneficial ownership of such security within sixty days, including through the exercise of any option, warrant or conversion of a security. Any securities not outstanding which are subject to such options, warrants or conversion privileges are deemed to be outstanding for the purpose of computing the percentage of outstanding securities of the class owned by such person. Those securities are not deemed to be outstanding for the purpose of computing the percentage of the class owned by any other person.

 

BENEFICIAL OWNERSHIP OF EACH CLASS OF VOTING SECURITIES

 

The following table reflects the beneficial ownership of each class of voting securities as of December 31, 2021.

 

 

 

Equivalent Voting Shares

 

Equivalent Voting Percentage

 

Voting Rights

Series A Preferred Stock

 

 

1,349,817,125

 

 

 

60.00

%

 

Shall have the right to vote as if converted prior to any vote at 60%.

Series B Preferred Stock

 

 

2,588,693

 

 

 

0.11

%

 

Shall have the right to vote equal to the number of common shares on a one-to-one basis.

Series C Preferred Stock

 

 

— 

 

 

 

— 

 

 

Shall have the right to vote equal to the number of common shares on a one-to-one basis.

Series D Preferred Stock

 

 

25,297,722 

 

 

 

1.10 

 

Shall have the right to vote on an as-converted basis

Common Stock

 

 

923,029,038

 

 

 

38.79

%

 

 

 

 

 

2,300,732,578

 

 

 

100.00

%

 

 

 

 
84

Table of Contants

  

REPORTS TO SECURITIES HOLDERS

 

We provide an annual report that includes audited financial information to our shareholders. We will make our financial information equally available to any interested parties or investors through compliance with the disclosure rules for a small business issuer under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934. We are subject to disclosure filing requirements including filing Form 10K annually and Form 10Q quarterly. In addition, we will file Form 8K and other proxy and information statements from time to time as required. We do not intend to voluntarily file the above reports in the event that our obligation to file such reports is suspended under the Exchange Act. The public may read and copy any materials that we file with the Securities and Exchange Commission, (“SEC”), at the SEC’s Public Reference Room at 100 F Street NE, Washington, DC 20549. The public may obtain information on the operation of the Public Reference Room by calling the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330. The SEC maintains an Internet site (http://www.sec.gov) that contains reports, proxy and information statements, and other information regarding issuers that file electronically with the SEC.

 

ITEM 13. CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS, AND DIRECTOR INDEPENDENCE.

 

Other than the stock transactions discussed herein, we have not entered into any transaction nor are there any proposed transactions in which any of our founders, directors, executive officers, stockholders or any members of the immediate family of any of the foregoing had or are to have a direct or indirect material interest except as follows:

 

There are amounts outstanding due to related parties of the Company of $1,548,941 and $1,339,352, respectively, as of December 31, 2021 and 2020 related to amounts due to employees, management and members of the Board of Directors according to verbal and written agreements that have not been paid as of period end which are included in accounts payable and accrued expenses on the balance sheet. See Note 9.

 

As is mentioned in Note 8, Reginald Thomas was appointed to the Board of Directors of the Company in August 2018. Mr. Thomas is the brother to the CEO Stephen J. Thomas III. According to an agreement with Mr. Reginald Thomas, he is to receive $10,000 per quarter and 1,000,000 shares of restricted common stock valued at approximately $120,000 vesting quarterly over twenty-four months. The quarterly payment of $10,000 may be suspended by the Company if the Company has not been adequately funded.

 

Leases

 

See Note 9 for office lease used by CEO.

 

Debt Financing and Amounts Payable

 

As of December 31, 2021, there are amounts due to management/shareholders of $49,452 included in financing arrangements, of which $45,302 is payable from the Company to Stephen J. Thomas III, CEO of the Company.  See note 5.

 

Revenue Transactions and Accounts Receivable

 

During the year ended December 31, 2020, Blue Collar provided production services to an entity controlled by the Blue Collar CEO (355 LA, LLC or “355”) for which it recorded revenues of $385,988.  355 was formed in October 2019 by the CEO of Blue Collar for the purpose of production of certain additional footage for a 355 customer.  355 has opportunity to engage with other production relationships outside of using Blue Collar. 

 

Other Agreements

 

On April 17, 2018, the CEO of the Company, Stephen Thomas, signed an agreement with New Orbit Technologies, S.A.P.I. de C.V., a Mexican corporation, (“New Orbit”), majority owned and controlled by Stephen Thomas, related to a license agreement for the distribution of TPT licensed products, software and services related to Lion Phone and ViewMe Live within Mexico and Latin America (“License Agreement”). The License Agreement provides for New Orbit to receive a fully paid-up, royalty-free, non-transferable license for perpetuity with termination only under situations such as bankruptcy, insolvency or material breach by either party and provides for New Orbit to pay the Company fees equal to 50% of net income generated from the applicable activities. The transaction was approved by the Company’s Board of Directors in June 2018. There has been no activity on this agreement.

 

 
85

Table of Contants

 

ITEM 14. PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTANT FEES AND SERVICES.

 

We incurred approximately $136,000 in audit fees to our principal independent accountants for professional services rendered in connection with the audit of financial statements for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2021. We incurred approximately $147,500 in audit fees to our principal independent accountants for professional services rendered in connection with the audit of financial statements for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2020.

 

During the fiscal years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020, we incurred $18,500 and $21,100, respectively, in other fees for professional services rendered by our principal independent accountants for all other non-audit services which may include, but not limited to, tax related services, actuarial services or valuation services.

 

(REMAINDER OF PAGE LEFT BLANK INTENTIONALLY)

 

 
86

Table of Contants

 

PART IV

 

ITEM 15. EXHIBITS, FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES.

 

The following exhibits are incorporated into this Form 10-K Annual Report:

 

Exhibit Number

 

Description

 

 

3.1

 

Articles of Incorporation of Chatham International, Inc. (9.30.96)

 

(1)

3.2

 

Articles of Incorporation of Cornerstone Capital, Inc. (12.30.98)

 

(1)

3.3

 

Articles of Amendment of Art, Music & Entertainment, Inc. – name change to Global Assets & Services, Inc. (7.30.01)

 

(1)

3.4

 

Articles of Merger – Global Assets & Services. Inc. and SDE 3, Inc. (1.17.02)

 

(1)

3.5

 

Articles of Amendment of Global Assets & Services, Inc. – name change to Jointland Development, Inc. (12.27.04)

 

(1)

3.6

 

Articles of Amendment of Jointland Development, Inc. – Article IV amendment (4.5.10)

 

(1)

3.7

 

Articles of Amendment of Jointland Development, Inc. – name change to Gold Royalty Corp. (10.19.10)

 

(1)

3.8

 

Articles of Amendment of Gold Royalty Corp. – new name Reuben Cannon Entertainment, Inc. (8.24.12)

 

(1)

3.9

 

Articles of Amendment of Gold Royalty Corp. – new name Ally Pharma US, Inc. (10.31.12)

 

(1)

3.10

 

Articles of Amendment of Ally Pharma US, Inc. – new name TPT Global Tech, Inc.

 

(1)

3.11

 

Articles of Amendment of TPT Global Tech, Inc. – Preferred Stock Series A & B (2.6.15)

 

(1)

3.12

 

Articles of Incorporation of Copperhead Digital Holdings, Inc.

 

(1)

3.13

 

Articles of Organization of Trucom, LLC

 

(1)

3.14

 

Articles of Organization of CityNet Arizona, LLC

 

(1)

3.15

 

Certificate of Amendment of Transactive Intermedia, Inc. – name change to San Diego Media, Inc.

 

(1)

3.16

 

Articles of Organization of K Telecom and Wireless, LLC

 

(1)

3.17

 

Articles of Incorporation of Blue Collar, Inc.

 

(1)

3.18

 

Articles of Organization of Center for Education in TV and Radio LLC

 

(1)

3.19

 

Articles of Amendment to Articles of Organization of Center for Education in TV and Radio LLC name change to Hollywood Riviera Studio, LLC

 

(1)

3.20

 

Articles of Organization of HRS Mobile, LLC

 

(1)

3.21

 

Bylaws of TPT Global Tech, Inc.

 

(1)

3.22

 

Articles of Organization of TPT MedTech, LLC

 

(12)

3.23

 

Articles of Incorporation of InnovaQor, Inc.

 

(12)

3.24

 

Articles of Organization of TPT Federal, LLC

 

(12)

3.25

 

Articles of Organization of Quiklab 1 LLC

 

(13)

3.26

 

Articles of Organization of QuickLAB 2, LLC

 

(13)

3.27

 

Statement of Correction Correcting the Entity Name – QuikLAB 2, LLC

 

(13)

3.28

 

Articles of Organization of QuickLAB 3, LLC

 

(13)

3.29

 

Statement of Correction Correcting the Entity Name – QuikLAB 3, LLC

 

(13)

3.30

 

Articles of Organization of QuickLAB 4, LLC

 

(13)

3.31

 

Statement of Correction Correcting the Entity Name – QuikLAB 4, LLC

 

(13)

4.1

 

Form of Vesting Warrants

 

(1)

4.2

 

Form of Unsecured Convertible Commercial Promissory Note - $250,000

 

(1)

4.3

 

Form of  Commercial Convertible Promissory Notes

 

(1)

4.4

 

2017 TPT Global Tech, Inc. Stock Option And Award Incentive Plan

 

(1)

4.5

 

Series A Designation

 

(1)

4.6

 

Series B Designation

 

(1)

 

 
87

Table of Contants

 

4.7

 

Promissory Note – HRS

 

(2)

4.8

 

Promissory Note – Blue Collar

 

(2)

4.9

 

Promissory Note - Blue Collar - Amendment No. 1 (2.9.18)

 

(3)

4.10

 

Promissory Note - MatrixSites, Inc. (10.31.17)

 

(3)

4.11

 

Series C Designation

 

(3)

4.12

 

Series D Designation

 

(9)

4.13

 

Series D Designation Amendment

 

(12)

10.1

 

Employment Agreement, Stephen J. Thomas, III

 

(1)

10.2

 

Employment Agreement,  Gary Cook

 

(1)

10.3

 

Employment Agreement, Richard Eberhardt

 

(1)

10.4

 

Agreement and Plan of Merger – Ally Pharma US, Inc. and TPT Global, Inc. (9.30.14)

 

(1)

10.5

 

Purchase Agreement Ally Pharma US, Inc. and K Telecom and Wireless and Global Telecom International LLC (8.1.14)

 

(1)

10.6

 

Acquisition and Purchase Agreement between TPT Global Tech, Inc. and Copperhead Digital Holdings, Inc. (1.31.15)

 

(1)

10.7

 

Lease Agreement between Copperhead Digital Holdings, Inc. and Telecom Finance LLC (9.14.10)

 

(1)

10.8

 

Acquisition and Purchase Agreement between TPT Global Tech, Inc. and Port 2 Port, Inc. (9.30.15)

 

(1)

10.9

 

Acquisition and Purchase Agreement between TPT Global Tech, Inc. and San Diego Media, Inc. (9.30.16)

 

(1)

10.10

 

Amendment #1 to Acquisition & Purchase Agreement between TPT Global Tech, Inc. and San Diego Media, Inc. (12.9.16)

 

(1)

10.11

 

Asset Acquisition Agreement between TPT Global Tech, Inc. and Interest Holders of the Lion Phone Technology (12.15.16)

 

(1)

10.12

 

Acquisition and Purchase Agreement between TPT Global Tech, Inc. and MatrixSites, Inc.

 

(1)

10.13

 

Acquisition and Purchase Agreement between TPT Global Tech, Inc. and Hollywood Riviera LLC, HRS Mobile LLC (11.1.17)

 

(1)

10.14

 

Acquisition and Purchase Agreement between TPT Global Tech, Inc. and Blue Collar Productions, Inc. (11.3.17)

 

(1)

10.15

 

HRS Amendment

 

(2)

10.16

 

Amendment No. 1 – Acquisition and Purchase Agreement between TPT Global Tech, Inc. and Blue Collar Productions, Inc. (2.9.18)

 

(2)

10.17

 

Amendment No. 2 – Acquisition and Purchase Agreement between TPT Global Tech, Inc. and Blue Collar Productions, Inc. (3.29.18)

 

(3) 

10.18

 

Amendment No. 3 - Acquisition and Purchase Agreement between TPT Global Tech, Inc. and Blue Collar Productions, Inc. (3.29.18)

 

(3)

10.19

 

Independent Director Agreement, Arkady Shkolnik

 

(3)

10.20

 

Independent Director Agreement, Reginald Thomas

 

(3)

10.21

 

Product, Software & Services License Agreement – New Orbit Technologies, Inc. (4.17.17)

 

(3)

10.22

 

Rescission, Settlement Agreement and Mutual Release

 

(3)

10.23

 

Security & Pledge Agreement - Blue Collar

 

(4)

10.24

 

Security & Pledge Agreement - Matrixsites

 

(4) 

10.25

 

Securities Purchase Agreement with Geneva Roth Remark Holdings

 

(5)

10.26

 

Securities Purchase Agreement with Auctus Fund, LLC

 

(6)

10.27

 

Convertible Promissory Note with Auctus Fund, LLC

 

(6)

10.28

 

Common Stock Purchase Warrant

 

(6)

10.29

 

Asset Purchase Agreement between TPT Global Tech, Inc. and SpeedConnect , LLC

 

(7)

10.30

 

Agreement for the Purchase and Sale of Future Receipts

 

(8)

10.31

 

Acquisition and Purchase Agreement with Bridge Internet, LLC

 

(10)

10.32

 

Agreement and Plan of Merger – Rennova Health, Inc.

 

(11)

10.33

 

Acquisition and Purchase Agreement between TPT Global Tech, Inc. and The Fitness Container, LLC

 

(13)

10.34

 

Security and Pledge Agreement between TPT Global Tech, Inc. and The Fitness Container, LLC

 

(13)

10.35

 

Secured Promissory Note between TPT Global Tech, Inc. and The Fitness Container, LLC

 

(13)

10.36

 

COVID-19 Parking Lot Testing License Agreement

 

(14)

10.37

 

Letter of Intent between Medytox Diagnostics, Inc., EPIC Reference Labs, Inc. and Rennova Health, Inc. and TPT MedTech, LLC dated August 6, 2020

 

(15)

10.38

 

Interim Management Agreement

 

(15)

10.39

 

Strategic Partnership Agreement

 

(16)

10.40

 

Purchase Agreement

 

(17)

10.41

 

Settlement Agreement

 

(17)

10.42 

 

Commercial Promissory Note with Michael A. Littman Ally, Defined Benefit Plan 

 

(17)

10.43 

 

Security and Pledge Agreement to Michael A. Littman, Defined Benefit Plan 

 

(17)

10.44

 

Amendment and Extension Agreement No. 1 with Michael A. Littman, Atty, Defined Benefit Plan

 

(18)

10.45

 

Addendum to Amendment and Extension Agreement No. 1 with Michael A. Littman, Atty, Defined Benefit Plan

 

(18)

10.46

 

Release and Termination Agreement

 

(18)

 

 

88

Table of Contents

 

 

 

 

 

21.1

List of Subsidiaries 

 

Filed Herewith

 

 

 

 

31.1

Section 302 Certification of Principal Executive Officer

 

Filed Herewith

31.2

Section 302 Certification of Principal Financial/Accounting Officer

 

Filed Herewith

32.1

Section 906 Certification of Principal Executive Officer

 

Filed Herewith

32.2

Section 906 Certification of Principal Financial/Accounting Officer

 

Filed Herewith

 

 

 

 

99.1

Trucom LLC Complete Patent

 

(1)

99.2

Patent Assignment – Ellifson to TruCom LLC(2.11.13)

 

(1)

 

 

 

 

101.INS

Inline XBRL Instance Document - the instance document does not appear in the Interactive Data File because its XBRL tags are embedded within the Inline XBRL document.  

 

Filed Herewith

101.SCH

XBRL Taxonomy Extension Schema Document

 

Filed Herewith

101.CAL

XBRL Taxonomy Extension Calculation Linkbase Document

 

Filed Herewith

101.DEF

XBRL Taxonomy Extension Definition Linkbase Document

 

Filed Herewith

101.LAB

XBRL Taxonomy Extension Label Linkbase Document

 

Filed Herewith

101.PRE

XBRL Taxonomy Extension Presentation Linkbase Document

 

Filed Herewith

104

Cover Page Interactive Data File (formatted as Inline XBRL and contained within Exhibit 101)

 

 

  

(1) Incorporated by reference from the exhibits included in the Company’s Registration Statement on Form S-1 dated December 15, 2017. 

(2) Incorporated by reference from the exhibits included in the Company’s Registration Statement on Form S-1/A dated February 23, 2018. 

(3) Incorporated by reference from the exhibits included in the Company’s Registration Statement on Form S-1/A dated October 1, 2018. 

(4) Incorporated by reference from the exhibits included in the Company’s Registration Statement on Form S-1/A dated November 5, 2018.

(5) Incorporated by reference from the exhibits included in the Company’s Form 8-K dated March 19, 2019.

(6) Incorporated by reference from the exhibits included in the Company’s Form 8-K dated March 25, 2019.

(7) Incorporated by reference from the exhibits included in the Company’s Form 8-K dated April 3, 2019.

(8) Incorporated by reference from the exhibits included in the Company’s Form 8-K dated March 3, 2020.

(9) Incorporated by reference from the exhibits included in the Company’s Form 8-K dated March 10, 2020.

(10) Incorporated by reference from the exhibits included in the Company’s Form 8-K dated March 19, 2020.

(11) Incorporated by reference from the exhibits included in the Company’s Form 8-K dated June 10, 2020.

(12) Incorporated by reference from the exhibits included in the Company’s Form 1-A dated July 2, 2020.

(13) Incorporated by reference from the exhibits included in the Company’s Amended Form 1-A dated August 27, 2020.

(14) Incorporated by reference from the exhibits included in the Company’s Form 8-K dated August 17, 2020.

(15) Incorporated by reference from the exhibits included in the Company’s Form 8-K dated September 9, 2020.

(16) Incorporated by reference from the exhibits included in the Company’s Form 8-K dated September 10, 2020.

(17) Incorporated by reference from the exhibits included in the Company’s Form S-1 dated October 28, 2020.

(18) Incorporated by reference from the exhibits included in the Company’s Form S-1/A dated January 15, 2021.

 

ITEM 16. FORM 10-K SUMMARY

 

Not applicable.

  

 
89

Table of Contants

 

SIGNATURES

 

Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities and Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.

 

TPT GLOBAL TECH, INC.

 

/s/ Stephen J. Thomas, III

 

April 14, 2022

Stephen J. Thomas, III

 

 

(Chief Executive Officer/Principal Executive Officer)

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ Gary L. Cook

 

April 14, 2022

Gary L. Cook

 

 

(Chief Financial Officer/Principal Accounting Officer)

 

 

 

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated.

  

/s/ Stephen J. Thomas, III

 

April 14, 2022

Stephen J. Thomas, III, President, Chief Executive Officer, and Chairman of the Board

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ Gary L. Cook

 

April 14, 2022

Gary L. Cook, Chief Financial Officer

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ Richard Eberhardt

 

April 14, 2022

Richard Eberhardt, Chief Operating Officer and Director

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ Arkady Shkolnik

 

April 14, 2022

Arkady Shkolnik, Director

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ Reginald Thomas

 

April 14, 2022

Reginald Thomas, Director

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ John F. Wharton

 

 April 14, 2022

John F. Wharton, Director

 

 

 

 

90